1 /* Output Dwarf2 format symbol table information from GCC.
2 Copyright (C) 1992, 1993, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002,
3 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4 Contributed by Gary Funck (gary@intrepid.com).
5 Derived from DWARF 1 implementation of Ron Guilmette (rfg@monkeys.com).
6 Extensively modified by Jason Merrill (jason@cygnus.com).
7
8 This file is part of GCC.
9
10 GCC is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
11 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
12 Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) any later
13 version.
14
15 GCC is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
16 WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
17 FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License
18 for more details.
19
20 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
21 along with GCC; see the file COPYING. If not, write to the Free
22 Software Foundation, 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA
23 02110-1301, USA. */
24
25 /* TODO: Emit .debug_line header even when there are no functions, since
26 the file numbers are used by .debug_info. Alternately, leave
27 out locations for types and decls.
28 Avoid talking about ctors and op= for PODs.
29 Factor out common prologue sequences into multiple CIEs. */
30
31 /* The first part of this file deals with the DWARF 2 frame unwind
32 information, which is also used by the GCC efficient exception handling
33 mechanism. The second part, controlled only by an #ifdef
34 DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO, deals with the other DWARF 2 debugging
35 information. */
36
37 #include "config.h"
38 #include "system.h"
39 #include "coretypes.h"
40 #include "tm.h"
41 #include "tree.h"
42 #include "version.h"
43 #include "flags.h"
44 #include "real.h"
45 #include "rtl.h"
46 #include "hard-reg-set.h"
47 #include "regs.h"
48 #include "insn-config.h"
49 #include "reload.h"
50 #include "function.h"
51 #include "output.h"
52 #include "expr.h"
53 #include "libfuncs.h"
54 #include "except.h"
55 #include "dwarf2.h"
56 #include "dwarf2out.h"
57 #include "dwarf2asm.h"
58 #include "toplev.h"
59 #include "varray.h"
60 #include "ggc.h"
61 #include "md5.h"
62 #include "tm_p.h"
63 #include "diagnostic.h"
64 #include "debug.h"
65 #include "target.h"
66 #include "langhooks.h"
67 #include "hashtab.h"
68 #include "cgraph.h"
69 #include "input.h"
70
71 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
72 static void dwarf2out_source_line (unsigned int, const char *);
73 #endif
74
75 /* DWARF2 Abbreviation Glossary:
76 CFA = Canonical Frame Address
77 a fixed address on the stack which identifies a call frame.
78 We define it to be the value of SP just before the call insn.
79 The CFA register and offset, which may change during the course
80 of the function, are used to calculate its value at runtime.
81 CFI = Call Frame Instruction
82 an instruction for the DWARF2 abstract machine
83 CIE = Common Information Entry
84 information describing information common to one or more FDEs
85 DIE = Debugging Information Entry
86 FDE = Frame Description Entry
87 information describing the stack call frame, in particular,
88 how to restore registers
89
90 DW_CFA_... = DWARF2 CFA call frame instruction
91 DW_TAG_... = DWARF2 DIE tag */
92
93 #ifndef DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
94 # ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
95 # define DWARF2_FRAME_INFO \
96 (write_symbols == DWARF2_DEBUG || write_symbols == VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG)
97 # else
98 # define DWARF2_FRAME_INFO 0
99 # endif
100 #endif
101
102 /* Map register numbers held in the call frame info that gcc has
103 collected using DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM to those that should be output in
104 .debug_frame and .eh_frame. */
105 #ifndef DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT
106 #define DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT(REGNO, FOR_EH) (REGNO)
107 #endif
108
109 /* Decide whether we want to emit frame unwind information for the current
110 translation unit. */
111
112 int
dwarf2out_do_frame(void)113 dwarf2out_do_frame (void)
114 {
115 /* We want to emit correct CFA location expressions or lists, so we
116 have to return true if we're going to output debug info, even if
117 we're not going to output frame or unwind info. */
118 return (write_symbols == DWARF2_DEBUG
119 || write_symbols == VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG
120 || DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
121 #ifdef DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
122 || (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
123 && (flag_unwind_tables
124 || (flag_exceptions && ! USING_SJLJ_EXCEPTIONS)))
125 #endif
126 );
127 }
128
129 /* The size of the target's pointer type. */
130 #ifndef PTR_SIZE
131 #define PTR_SIZE (POINTER_SIZE / BITS_PER_UNIT)
132 #endif
133
134 /* Array of RTXes referenced by the debugging information, which therefore
135 must be kept around forever. */
136 static GTY(()) VEC(rtx,gc) *used_rtx_array;
137
138 /* A pointer to the base of a list of incomplete types which might be
139 completed at some later time. incomplete_types_list needs to be a
140 VEC(tree,gc) because we want to tell the garbage collector about
141 it. */
142 static GTY(()) VEC(tree,gc) *incomplete_types;
143
144 /* A pointer to the base of a table of references to declaration
145 scopes. This table is a display which tracks the nesting
146 of declaration scopes at the current scope and containing
147 scopes. This table is used to find the proper place to
148 define type declaration DIE's. */
149 static GTY(()) VEC(tree,gc) *decl_scope_table;
150
151 /* Pointers to various DWARF2 sections. */
152 static GTY(()) section *debug_info_section;
153 static GTY(()) section *debug_abbrev_section;
154 static GTY(()) section *debug_aranges_section;
155 static GTY(()) section *debug_macinfo_section;
156 static GTY(()) section *debug_line_section;
157 static GTY(()) section *debug_loc_section;
158 static GTY(()) section *debug_pubnames_section;
159 static GTY(()) section *debug_pubtypes_section;
160 static GTY(()) section *debug_str_section;
161 static GTY(()) section *debug_ranges_section;
162 static GTY(()) section *debug_frame_section;
163
164 /* How to start an assembler comment. */
165 #ifndef ASM_COMMENT_START
166 #define ASM_COMMENT_START ";#"
167 #endif
168
169 typedef struct dw_cfi_struct *dw_cfi_ref;
170 typedef struct dw_fde_struct *dw_fde_ref;
171 typedef union dw_cfi_oprnd_struct *dw_cfi_oprnd_ref;
172
173 /* Call frames are described using a sequence of Call Frame
174 Information instructions. The register number, offset
175 and address fields are provided as possible operands;
176 their use is selected by the opcode field. */
177
178 enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type {
179 dw_cfi_oprnd_unused,
180 dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num,
181 dw_cfi_oprnd_offset,
182 dw_cfi_oprnd_addr,
183 dw_cfi_oprnd_loc
184 };
185
186 typedef union dw_cfi_oprnd_struct GTY(())
187 {
188 unsigned int GTY ((tag ("dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num"))) dw_cfi_reg_num;
189 HOST_WIDE_INT GTY ((tag ("dw_cfi_oprnd_offset"))) dw_cfi_offset;
190 const char * GTY ((tag ("dw_cfi_oprnd_addr"))) dw_cfi_addr;
191 struct dw_loc_descr_struct * GTY ((tag ("dw_cfi_oprnd_loc"))) dw_cfi_loc;
192 }
193 dw_cfi_oprnd;
194
195 typedef struct dw_cfi_struct GTY(())
196 {
197 dw_cfi_ref dw_cfi_next;
198 enum dwarf_call_frame_info dw_cfi_opc;
199 dw_cfi_oprnd GTY ((desc ("dw_cfi_oprnd1_desc (%1.dw_cfi_opc)")))
200 dw_cfi_oprnd1;
201 dw_cfi_oprnd GTY ((desc ("dw_cfi_oprnd2_desc (%1.dw_cfi_opc)")))
202 dw_cfi_oprnd2;
203 }
204 dw_cfi_node;
205
206 /* This is how we define the location of the CFA. We use to handle it
207 as REG + OFFSET all the time, but now it can be more complex.
208 It can now be either REG + CFA_OFFSET or *(REG + BASE_OFFSET) + CFA_OFFSET.
209 Instead of passing around REG and OFFSET, we pass a copy
210 of this structure. */
211 typedef struct cfa_loc GTY(())
212 {
213 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
214 HOST_WIDE_INT base_offset;
215 unsigned int reg;
216 int indirect; /* 1 if CFA is accessed via a dereference. */
217 } dw_cfa_location;
218
219 /* All call frame descriptions (FDE's) in the GCC generated DWARF
220 refer to a single Common Information Entry (CIE), defined at
221 the beginning of the .debug_frame section. This use of a single
222 CIE obviates the need to keep track of multiple CIE's
223 in the DWARF generation routines below. */
224
225 typedef struct dw_fde_struct GTY(())
226 {
227 tree decl;
228 const char *dw_fde_begin;
229 const char *dw_fde_current_label;
230 const char *dw_fde_end;
231 const char *dw_fde_hot_section_label;
232 const char *dw_fde_hot_section_end_label;
233 const char *dw_fde_unlikely_section_label;
234 const char *dw_fde_unlikely_section_end_label;
235 bool dw_fde_switched_sections;
236 dw_cfi_ref dw_fde_cfi;
237 unsigned funcdef_number;
238 unsigned all_throwers_are_sibcalls : 1;
239 unsigned nothrow : 1;
240 unsigned uses_eh_lsda : 1;
241 }
242 dw_fde_node;
243
244 /* Maximum size (in bytes) of an artificially generated label. */
245 #define MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES 30
246
247 /* The size of addresses as they appear in the Dwarf 2 data.
248 Some architectures use word addresses to refer to code locations,
249 but Dwarf 2 info always uses byte addresses. On such machines,
250 Dwarf 2 addresses need to be larger than the architecture's
251 pointers. */
252 #ifndef DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
253 #define DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE (POINTER_SIZE / BITS_PER_UNIT)
254 #endif
255
256 /* The size in bytes of a DWARF field indicating an offset or length
257 relative to a debug info section, specified to be 4 bytes in the
258 DWARF-2 specification. The SGI/MIPS ABI defines it to be the same
259 as PTR_SIZE. */
260
261 #ifndef DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE
262 #define DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE 4
263 #endif
264
265 /* According to the (draft) DWARF 3 specification, the initial length
266 should either be 4 or 12 bytes. When it's 12 bytes, the first 4
267 bytes are 0xffffffff, followed by the length stored in the next 8
268 bytes.
269
270 However, the SGI/MIPS ABI uses an initial length which is equal to
271 DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE. It is defined (elsewhere) accordingly. */
272
273 #ifndef DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE
274 #define DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 ? 4 : 12)
275 #endif
276
277 #define DWARF_VERSION 2
278
279 /* Round SIZE up to the nearest BOUNDARY. */
280 #define DWARF_ROUND(SIZE,BOUNDARY) \
281 ((((SIZE) + (BOUNDARY) - 1) / (BOUNDARY)) * (BOUNDARY))
282
283 /* Offsets recorded in opcodes are a multiple of this alignment factor. */
284 #ifndef DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
285 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
286 #define DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT (-((int) UNITS_PER_WORD))
287 #else
288 #define DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT ((int) UNITS_PER_WORD)
289 #endif
290 #endif
291
292 /* CIE identifier. */
293 #if HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64
294 #define DWARF_CIE_ID \
295 (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 ? DW_CIE_ID : DW64_CIE_ID)
296 #else
297 #define DWARF_CIE_ID DW_CIE_ID
298 #endif
299
300 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains frame description
301 information for each routine. */
302 static GTY((length ("fde_table_allocated"))) dw_fde_ref fde_table;
303
304 /* Number of elements currently allocated for fde_table. */
305 static GTY(()) unsigned fde_table_allocated;
306
307 /* Number of elements in fde_table currently in use. */
308 static GTY(()) unsigned fde_table_in_use;
309
310 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
311 fde_table. */
312 #define FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT 256
313
314 /* A list of call frame insns for the CIE. */
315 static GTY(()) dw_cfi_ref cie_cfi_head;
316
317 #if defined (DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO) || defined (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
318 /* Some DWARF extensions (e.g., MIPS/SGI) implement a subprogram
319 attribute that accelerates the lookup of the FDE associated
320 with the subprogram. This variable holds the table index of the FDE
321 associated with the current function (body) definition. */
322 static unsigned current_funcdef_fde;
323 #endif
324
325 struct indirect_string_node GTY(())
326 {
327 const char *str;
328 unsigned int refcount;
329 unsigned int form;
330 char *label;
331 };
332
333 static GTY ((param_is (struct indirect_string_node))) htab_t debug_str_hash;
334
335 static GTY(()) int dw2_string_counter;
336 static GTY(()) unsigned long dwarf2out_cfi_label_num;
337
338 #if defined (DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO) || defined (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
339
340 /* Forward declarations for functions defined in this file. */
341
342 static char *stripattributes (const char *);
343 static const char *dwarf_cfi_name (unsigned);
344 static dw_cfi_ref new_cfi (void);
345 static void add_cfi (dw_cfi_ref *, dw_cfi_ref);
346 static void add_fde_cfi (const char *, dw_cfi_ref);
347 static void lookup_cfa_1 (dw_cfi_ref, dw_cfa_location *);
348 static void lookup_cfa (dw_cfa_location *);
349 static void reg_save (const char *, unsigned, unsigned, HOST_WIDE_INT);
350 static void initial_return_save (rtx);
351 static HOST_WIDE_INT stack_adjust_offset (rtx);
352 static void output_cfi (dw_cfi_ref, dw_fde_ref, int);
353 static void output_call_frame_info (int);
354 static void dwarf2out_stack_adjust (rtx, bool);
355 static void flush_queued_reg_saves (void);
356 static bool clobbers_queued_reg_save (rtx);
357 static void dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (rtx, const char *);
358
359 /* Support for complex CFA locations. */
360 static void output_cfa_loc (dw_cfi_ref);
361 static void get_cfa_from_loc_descr (dw_cfa_location *,
362 struct dw_loc_descr_struct *);
363 static struct dw_loc_descr_struct *build_cfa_loc
364 (dw_cfa_location *, HOST_WIDE_INT);
365 static void def_cfa_1 (const char *, dw_cfa_location *);
366
367 /* How to start an assembler comment. */
368 #ifndef ASM_COMMENT_START
369 #define ASM_COMMENT_START ";#"
370 #endif
371
372 /* Data and reference forms for relocatable data. */
373 #define DW_FORM_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 8 ? DW_FORM_data8 : DW_FORM_data4)
374 #define DW_FORM_ref (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 8 ? DW_FORM_ref8 : DW_FORM_ref4)
375
376 #ifndef DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION
377 #define DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION ".debug_frame"
378 #endif
379
380 #ifndef FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL
381 #define FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL "LFB"
382 #endif
383
384 #ifndef FUNC_END_LABEL
385 #define FUNC_END_LABEL "LFE"
386 #endif
387
388 #ifndef FRAME_BEGIN_LABEL
389 #define FRAME_BEGIN_LABEL "Lframe"
390 #endif
391 #define CIE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL "LSCIE"
392 #define CIE_END_LABEL "LECIE"
393 #define FDE_LABEL "LSFDE"
394 #define FDE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL "LASFDE"
395 #define FDE_END_LABEL "LEFDE"
396 #define LINE_NUMBER_BEGIN_LABEL "LSLT"
397 #define LINE_NUMBER_END_LABEL "LELT"
398 #define LN_PROLOG_AS_LABEL "LASLTP"
399 #define LN_PROLOG_END_LABEL "LELTP"
400 #define DIE_LABEL_PREFIX "DW"
401
402 /* The DWARF 2 CFA column which tracks the return address. Normally this
403 is the column for PC, or the first column after all of the hard
404 registers. */
405 #ifndef DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
406 #ifdef PC_REGNUM
407 #define DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (PC_REGNUM)
408 #else
409 #define DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
410 #endif
411 #endif
412
413 /* The mapping from gcc register number to DWARF 2 CFA column number. By
414 default, we just provide columns for all registers. */
415 #ifndef DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM
416 #define DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM(REG) DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (REG)
417 #endif
418
419 /* Hook used by __throw. */
420
421 rtx
expand_builtin_dwarf_sp_column(void)422 expand_builtin_dwarf_sp_column (void)
423 {
424 unsigned int dwarf_regnum = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
425 return GEN_INT (DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (dwarf_regnum, 1));
426 }
427
428 /* Return a pointer to a copy of the section string name S with all
429 attributes stripped off, and an asterisk prepended (for assemble_name). */
430
431 static inline char *
stripattributes(const char * s)432 stripattributes (const char *s)
433 {
434 char *stripped = XNEWVEC (char, strlen (s) + 2);
435 char *p = stripped;
436
437 *p++ = '*';
438
439 while (*s && *s != ',')
440 *p++ = *s++;
441
442 *p = '\0';
443 return stripped;
444 }
445
446 /* Generate code to initialize the register size table. */
447
448 void
expand_builtin_init_dwarf_reg_sizes(tree address)449 expand_builtin_init_dwarf_reg_sizes (tree address)
450 {
451 unsigned int i;
452 enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (char_type_node);
453 rtx addr = expand_normal (address);
454 rtx mem = gen_rtx_MEM (BLKmode, addr);
455 bool wrote_return_column = false;
456
457 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
458 {
459 int rnum = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (i), 1);
460
461 if (rnum < DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS)
462 {
463 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = rnum * GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
464 enum machine_mode save_mode = reg_raw_mode[i];
465 HOST_WIDE_INT size;
466
467 if (HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED (i, save_mode))
468 save_mode = choose_hard_reg_mode (i, 1, true);
469 if (DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (i) == DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN)
470 {
471 if (save_mode == VOIDmode)
472 continue;
473 wrote_return_column = true;
474 }
475 size = GET_MODE_SIZE (save_mode);
476 if (offset < 0)
477 continue;
478
479 emit_move_insn (adjust_address (mem, mode, offset),
480 gen_int_mode (size, mode));
481 }
482 }
483
484 #ifdef DWARF_ALT_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
485 gcc_assert (wrote_return_column);
486 i = DWARF_ALT_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN;
487 wrote_return_column = false;
488 #else
489 i = DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN;
490 #endif
491
492 if (! wrote_return_column)
493 {
494 enum machine_mode save_mode = Pmode;
495 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = i * GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
496 HOST_WIDE_INT size = GET_MODE_SIZE (save_mode);
497 emit_move_insn (adjust_address (mem, mode, offset), GEN_INT (size));
498 }
499 }
500
501 /* Convert a DWARF call frame info. operation to its string name */
502
503 static const char *
dwarf_cfi_name(unsigned int cfi_opc)504 dwarf_cfi_name (unsigned int cfi_opc)
505 {
506 switch (cfi_opc)
507 {
508 case DW_CFA_advance_loc:
509 return "DW_CFA_advance_loc";
510 case DW_CFA_offset:
511 return "DW_CFA_offset";
512 case DW_CFA_restore:
513 return "DW_CFA_restore";
514 case DW_CFA_nop:
515 return "DW_CFA_nop";
516 case DW_CFA_set_loc:
517 return "DW_CFA_set_loc";
518 case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
519 return "DW_CFA_advance_loc1";
520 case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
521 return "DW_CFA_advance_loc2";
522 case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
523 return "DW_CFA_advance_loc4";
524 case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
525 return "DW_CFA_offset_extended";
526 case DW_CFA_restore_extended:
527 return "DW_CFA_restore_extended";
528 case DW_CFA_undefined:
529 return "DW_CFA_undefined";
530 case DW_CFA_same_value:
531 return "DW_CFA_same_value";
532 case DW_CFA_register:
533 return "DW_CFA_register";
534 case DW_CFA_remember_state:
535 return "DW_CFA_remember_state";
536 case DW_CFA_restore_state:
537 return "DW_CFA_restore_state";
538 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
539 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa";
540 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
541 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_register";
542 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
543 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset";
544
545 /* DWARF 3 */
546 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
547 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression";
548 case DW_CFA_expression:
549 return "DW_CFA_expression";
550 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
551 return "DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf";
552 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
553 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf";
554 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
555 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf";
556
557 /* SGI/MIPS specific */
558 case DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8:
559 return "DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8";
560
561 /* GNU extensions */
562 case DW_CFA_GNU_window_save:
563 return "DW_CFA_GNU_window_save";
564 case DW_CFA_GNU_args_size:
565 return "DW_CFA_GNU_args_size";
566 case DW_CFA_GNU_negative_offset_extended:
567 return "DW_CFA_GNU_negative_offset_extended";
568
569 default:
570 return "DW_CFA_<unknown>";
571 }
572 }
573
574 /* Return a pointer to a newly allocated Call Frame Instruction. */
575
576 static inline dw_cfi_ref
new_cfi(void)577 new_cfi (void)
578 {
579 dw_cfi_ref cfi = ggc_alloc (sizeof (dw_cfi_node));
580
581 cfi->dw_cfi_next = NULL;
582 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = 0;
583 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_reg_num = 0;
584
585 return cfi;
586 }
587
588 /* Add a Call Frame Instruction to list of instructions. */
589
590 static inline void
add_cfi(dw_cfi_ref * list_head,dw_cfi_ref cfi)591 add_cfi (dw_cfi_ref *list_head, dw_cfi_ref cfi)
592 {
593 dw_cfi_ref *p;
594
595 /* Find the end of the chain. */
596 for (p = list_head; (*p) != NULL; p = &(*p)->dw_cfi_next)
597 ;
598
599 *p = cfi;
600 }
601
602 /* Generate a new label for the CFI info to refer to. */
603
604 char *
dwarf2out_cfi_label(void)605 dwarf2out_cfi_label (void)
606 {
607 static char label[20];
608
609 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "LCFI", dwarf2out_cfi_label_num++);
610 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, label);
611 return label;
612 }
613
614 /* Add CFI to the current fde at the PC value indicated by LABEL if specified,
615 or to the CIE if LABEL is NULL. */
616
617 static void
add_fde_cfi(const char * label,dw_cfi_ref cfi)618 add_fde_cfi (const char *label, dw_cfi_ref cfi)
619 {
620 if (label)
621 {
622 dw_fde_ref fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use - 1];
623
624 if (*label == 0)
625 label = dwarf2out_cfi_label ();
626
627 if (fde->dw_fde_current_label == NULL
628 || strcmp (label, fde->dw_fde_current_label) != 0)
629 {
630 dw_cfi_ref xcfi;
631
632 label = xstrdup (label);
633
634 /* Set the location counter to the new label. */
635 xcfi = new_cfi ();
636 /* If we have a current label, advance from there, otherwise
637 set the location directly using set_loc. */
638 xcfi->dw_cfi_opc = fde->dw_fde_current_label
639 ? DW_CFA_advance_loc4
640 : DW_CFA_set_loc;
641 xcfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr = label;
642 add_cfi (&fde->dw_fde_cfi, xcfi);
643
644 fde->dw_fde_current_label = label;
645 }
646
647 add_cfi (&fde->dw_fde_cfi, cfi);
648 }
649
650 else
651 add_cfi (&cie_cfi_head, cfi);
652 }
653
654 /* Subroutine of lookup_cfa. */
655
656 static void
lookup_cfa_1(dw_cfi_ref cfi,dw_cfa_location * loc)657 lookup_cfa_1 (dw_cfi_ref cfi, dw_cfa_location *loc)
658 {
659 switch (cfi->dw_cfi_opc)
660 {
661 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
662 loc->offset = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset;
663 break;
664 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
665 loc->offset
666 = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset * DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT;
667 break;
668 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
669 loc->reg = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num;
670 break;
671 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
672 loc->reg = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num;
673 loc->offset = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset;
674 break;
675 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
676 loc->reg = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num;
677 loc->offset
678 = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset * DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT;
679 break;
680 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
681 get_cfa_from_loc_descr (loc, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_loc);
682 break;
683 default:
684 break;
685 }
686 }
687
688 /* Find the previous value for the CFA. */
689
690 static void
lookup_cfa(dw_cfa_location * loc)691 lookup_cfa (dw_cfa_location *loc)
692 {
693 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
694
695 loc->reg = INVALID_REGNUM;
696 loc->offset = 0;
697 loc->indirect = 0;
698 loc->base_offset = 0;
699
700 for (cfi = cie_cfi_head; cfi; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
701 lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, loc);
702
703 if (fde_table_in_use)
704 {
705 dw_fde_ref fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use - 1];
706 for (cfi = fde->dw_fde_cfi; cfi; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
707 lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, loc);
708 }
709 }
710
711 /* The current rule for calculating the DWARF2 canonical frame address. */
712 static dw_cfa_location cfa;
713
714 /* The register used for saving registers to the stack, and its offset
715 from the CFA. */
716 static dw_cfa_location cfa_store;
717
718 /* The running total of the size of arguments pushed onto the stack. */
719 static HOST_WIDE_INT args_size;
720
721 /* The last args_size we actually output. */
722 static HOST_WIDE_INT old_args_size;
723
724 /* Entry point to update the canonical frame address (CFA).
725 LABEL is passed to add_fde_cfi. The value of CFA is now to be
726 calculated from REG+OFFSET. */
727
728 void
dwarf2out_def_cfa(const char * label,unsigned int reg,HOST_WIDE_INT offset)729 dwarf2out_def_cfa (const char *label, unsigned int reg, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
730 {
731 dw_cfa_location loc;
732 loc.indirect = 0;
733 loc.base_offset = 0;
734 loc.reg = reg;
735 loc.offset = offset;
736 def_cfa_1 (label, &loc);
737 }
738
739 /* Determine if two dw_cfa_location structures define the same data. */
740
741 static bool
cfa_equal_p(const dw_cfa_location * loc1,const dw_cfa_location * loc2)742 cfa_equal_p (const dw_cfa_location *loc1, const dw_cfa_location *loc2)
743 {
744 return (loc1->reg == loc2->reg
745 && loc1->offset == loc2->offset
746 && loc1->indirect == loc2->indirect
747 && (loc1->indirect == 0
748 || loc1->base_offset == loc2->base_offset));
749 }
750
751 /* This routine does the actual work. The CFA is now calculated from
752 the dw_cfa_location structure. */
753
754 static void
def_cfa_1(const char * label,dw_cfa_location * loc_p)755 def_cfa_1 (const char *label, dw_cfa_location *loc_p)
756 {
757 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
758 dw_cfa_location old_cfa, loc;
759
760 cfa = *loc_p;
761 loc = *loc_p;
762
763 if (cfa_store.reg == loc.reg && loc.indirect == 0)
764 cfa_store.offset = loc.offset;
765
766 loc.reg = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (loc.reg);
767 lookup_cfa (&old_cfa);
768
769 /* If nothing changed, no need to issue any call frame instructions. */
770 if (cfa_equal_p (&loc, &old_cfa))
771 return;
772
773 cfi = new_cfi ();
774
775 if (loc.reg == old_cfa.reg && !loc.indirect)
776 {
777 /* Construct a "DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset <offset>" instruction, indicating
778 the CFA register did not change but the offset did. */
779 if (loc.offset < 0)
780 {
781 HOST_WIDE_INT f_offset = loc.offset / DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT;
782 gcc_assert (f_offset * DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT == loc.offset);
783
784 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf;
785 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset = f_offset;
786 }
787 else
788 {
789 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset;
790 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset = loc.offset;
791 }
792 }
793
794 #ifndef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO /* SGI dbx thinks this means no offset. */
795 else if (loc.offset == old_cfa.offset
796 && old_cfa.reg != INVALID_REGNUM
797 && !loc.indirect)
798 {
799 /* Construct a "DW_CFA_def_cfa_register <register>" instruction,
800 indicating the CFA register has changed to <register> but the
801 offset has not changed. */
802 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_register;
803 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = loc.reg;
804 }
805 #endif
806
807 else if (loc.indirect == 0)
808 {
809 /* Construct a "DW_CFA_def_cfa <register> <offset>" instruction,
810 indicating the CFA register has changed to <register> with
811 the specified offset. */
812 if (loc.offset < 0)
813 {
814 HOST_WIDE_INT f_offset = loc.offset / DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT;
815 gcc_assert (f_offset * DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT == loc.offset);
816
817 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf;
818 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = loc.reg;
819 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset = f_offset;
820 }
821 else
822 {
823 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa;
824 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = loc.reg;
825 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset = loc.offset;
826 }
827 }
828 else
829 {
830 /* Construct a DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression instruction to
831 calculate the CFA using a full location expression since no
832 register-offset pair is available. */
833 struct dw_loc_descr_struct *loc_list;
834
835 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression;
836 loc_list = build_cfa_loc (&loc, 0);
837 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_loc = loc_list;
838 }
839
840 add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
841 }
842
843 /* Add the CFI for saving a register. REG is the CFA column number.
844 LABEL is passed to add_fde_cfi.
845 If SREG is -1, the register is saved at OFFSET from the CFA;
846 otherwise it is saved in SREG. */
847
848 static void
reg_save(const char * label,unsigned int reg,unsigned int sreg,HOST_WIDE_INT offset)849 reg_save (const char *label, unsigned int reg, unsigned int sreg, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
850 {
851 dw_cfi_ref cfi = new_cfi ();
852
853 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = reg;
854
855 if (sreg == INVALID_REGNUM)
856 {
857 if (reg & ~0x3f)
858 /* The register number won't fit in 6 bits, so we have to use
859 the long form. */
860 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_offset_extended;
861 else
862 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_offset;
863
864 #ifdef ENABLE_CHECKING
865 {
866 /* If we get an offset that is not a multiple of
867 DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT, there is either a bug in the
868 definition of DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT, or a bug in the machine
869 description. */
870 HOST_WIDE_INT check_offset = offset / DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT;
871
872 gcc_assert (check_offset * DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT == offset);
873 }
874 #endif
875 offset /= DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT;
876 if (offset < 0)
877 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf;
878
879 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset = offset;
880 }
881 else if (sreg == reg)
882 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_same_value;
883 else
884 {
885 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_register;
886 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_reg_num = sreg;
887 }
888
889 add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
890 }
891
892 /* Add the CFI for saving a register window. LABEL is passed to reg_save.
893 This CFI tells the unwinder that it needs to restore the window registers
894 from the previous frame's window save area.
895
896 ??? Perhaps we should note in the CIE where windows are saved (instead of
897 assuming 0(cfa)) and what registers are in the window. */
898
899 void
dwarf2out_window_save(const char * label)900 dwarf2out_window_save (const char *label)
901 {
902 dw_cfi_ref cfi = new_cfi ();
903
904 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_GNU_window_save;
905 add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
906 }
907
908 /* Add a CFI to update the running total of the size of arguments
909 pushed onto the stack. */
910
911 void
dwarf2out_args_size(const char * label,HOST_WIDE_INT size)912 dwarf2out_args_size (const char *label, HOST_WIDE_INT size)
913 {
914 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
915
916 if (size == old_args_size)
917 return;
918
919 old_args_size = size;
920
921 cfi = new_cfi ();
922 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_GNU_args_size;
923 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset = size;
924 add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
925 }
926
927 /* Entry point for saving a register to the stack. REG is the GCC register
928 number. LABEL and OFFSET are passed to reg_save. */
929
930 void
dwarf2out_reg_save(const char * label,unsigned int reg,HOST_WIDE_INT offset)931 dwarf2out_reg_save (const char *label, unsigned int reg, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
932 {
933 reg_save (label, DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (reg), INVALID_REGNUM, offset);
934 }
935
936 /* Entry point for saving the return address in the stack.
937 LABEL and OFFSET are passed to reg_save. */
938
939 void
dwarf2out_return_save(const char * label,HOST_WIDE_INT offset)940 dwarf2out_return_save (const char *label, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
941 {
942 reg_save (label, DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, INVALID_REGNUM, offset);
943 }
944
945 /* Entry point for saving the return address in a register.
946 LABEL and SREG are passed to reg_save. */
947
948 void
dwarf2out_return_reg(const char * label,unsigned int sreg)949 dwarf2out_return_reg (const char *label, unsigned int sreg)
950 {
951 reg_save (label, DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (sreg), 0);
952 }
953
954 /* Record the initial position of the return address. RTL is
955 INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX. */
956
957 static void
initial_return_save(rtx rtl)958 initial_return_save (rtx rtl)
959 {
960 unsigned int reg = INVALID_REGNUM;
961 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
962
963 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
964 {
965 case REG:
966 /* RA is in a register. */
967 reg = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (rtl));
968 break;
969
970 case MEM:
971 /* RA is on the stack. */
972 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
973 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
974 {
975 case REG:
976 gcc_assert (REGNO (rtl) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
977 offset = 0;
978 break;
979
980 case PLUS:
981 gcc_assert (REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
982 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1));
983 break;
984
985 case MINUS:
986 gcc_assert (REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
987 offset = -INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1));
988 break;
989
990 default:
991 gcc_unreachable ();
992 }
993
994 break;
995
996 case PLUS:
997 /* The return address is at some offset from any value we can
998 actually load. For instance, on the SPARC it is in %i7+8. Just
999 ignore the offset for now; it doesn't matter for unwinding frames. */
1000 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 1)) == CONST_INT);
1001 initial_return_save (XEXP (rtl, 0));
1002 return;
1003
1004 default:
1005 gcc_unreachable ();
1006 }
1007
1008 if (reg != DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN)
1009 reg_save (NULL, DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, reg, offset - cfa.offset);
1010 }
1011
1012 /* Given a SET, calculate the amount of stack adjustment it
1013 contains. */
1014
1015 static HOST_WIDE_INT
stack_adjust_offset(rtx pattern)1016 stack_adjust_offset (rtx pattern)
1017 {
1018 rtx src = SET_SRC (pattern);
1019 rtx dest = SET_DEST (pattern);
1020 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
1021 enum rtx_code code;
1022
1023 if (dest == stack_pointer_rtx)
1024 {
1025 /* (set (reg sp) (plus (reg sp) (const_int))) */
1026 code = GET_CODE (src);
1027 if (! (code == PLUS || code == MINUS)
1028 || XEXP (src, 0) != stack_pointer_rtx
1029 || GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) != CONST_INT)
1030 return 0;
1031
1032 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1033 if (code == PLUS)
1034 offset = -offset;
1035 }
1036 else if (MEM_P (dest))
1037 {
1038 /* (set (mem (pre_dec (reg sp))) (foo)) */
1039 src = XEXP (dest, 0);
1040 code = GET_CODE (src);
1041
1042 switch (code)
1043 {
1044 case PRE_MODIFY:
1045 case POST_MODIFY:
1046 if (XEXP (src, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx)
1047 {
1048 rtx val = XEXP (XEXP (src, 1), 1);
1049 /* We handle only adjustments by constant amount. */
1050 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) == PLUS
1051 && GET_CODE (val) == CONST_INT);
1052 offset = -INTVAL (val);
1053 break;
1054 }
1055 return 0;
1056
1057 case PRE_DEC:
1058 case POST_DEC:
1059 if (XEXP (src, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx)
1060 {
1061 offset = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest));
1062 break;
1063 }
1064 return 0;
1065
1066 case PRE_INC:
1067 case POST_INC:
1068 if (XEXP (src, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx)
1069 {
1070 offset = -GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest));
1071 break;
1072 }
1073 return 0;
1074
1075 default:
1076 return 0;
1077 }
1078 }
1079 else
1080 return 0;
1081
1082 return offset;
1083 }
1084
1085 /* Check INSN to see if it looks like a push or a stack adjustment, and
1086 make a note of it if it does. EH uses this information to find out how
1087 much extra space it needs to pop off the stack. */
1088
1089 static void
dwarf2out_stack_adjust(rtx insn,bool after_p)1090 dwarf2out_stack_adjust (rtx insn, bool after_p)
1091 {
1092 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
1093 const char *label;
1094 int i;
1095
1096 /* Don't handle epilogues at all. Certainly it would be wrong to do so
1097 with this function. Proper support would require all frame-related
1098 insns to be marked, and to be able to handle saving state around
1099 epilogues textually in the middle of the function. */
1100 if (prologue_epilogue_contains (insn) || sibcall_epilogue_contains (insn))
1101 return;
1102
1103 /* If only calls can throw, and we have a frame pointer,
1104 save up adjustments until we see the CALL_INSN. */
1105 if (!flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables && cfa.reg != STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1106 {
1107 if (CALL_P (insn) && !after_p)
1108 {
1109 /* Extract the size of the args from the CALL rtx itself. */
1110 insn = PATTERN (insn);
1111 if (GET_CODE (insn) == PARALLEL)
1112 insn = XVECEXP (insn, 0, 0);
1113 if (GET_CODE (insn) == SET)
1114 insn = SET_SRC (insn);
1115 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (insn) == CALL);
1116 dwarf2out_args_size ("", INTVAL (XEXP (insn, 1)));
1117 }
1118 return;
1119 }
1120
1121 if (CALL_P (insn) && !after_p)
1122 {
1123 if (!flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables)
1124 dwarf2out_args_size ("", args_size);
1125 return;
1126 }
1127 else if (BARRIER_P (insn))
1128 {
1129 /* When we see a BARRIER, we know to reset args_size to 0. Usually
1130 the compiler will have already emitted a stack adjustment, but
1131 doesn't bother for calls to noreturn functions. */
1132 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
1133 offset = -args_size;
1134 #else
1135 offset = args_size;
1136 #endif
1137 }
1138 else if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == SET)
1139 offset = stack_adjust_offset (PATTERN (insn));
1140 else if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == PARALLEL
1141 || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == SEQUENCE)
1142 {
1143 /* There may be stack adjustments inside compound insns. Search
1144 for them. */
1145 for (offset = 0, i = XVECLEN (PATTERN (insn), 0) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
1146 if (GET_CODE (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, i)) == SET)
1147 offset += stack_adjust_offset (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, i));
1148 }
1149 else
1150 return;
1151
1152 if (offset == 0)
1153 return;
1154
1155 if (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1156 cfa.offset += offset;
1157
1158 #ifndef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
1159 offset = -offset;
1160 #endif
1161
1162 args_size += offset;
1163 if (args_size < 0)
1164 args_size = 0;
1165
1166 label = dwarf2out_cfi_label ();
1167 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
1168 if (flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables)
1169 dwarf2out_args_size (label, args_size);
1170 }
1171
1172 #endif
1173
1174 /* We delay emitting a register save until either (a) we reach the end
1175 of the prologue or (b) the register is clobbered. This clusters
1176 register saves so that there are fewer pc advances. */
1177
1178 struct queued_reg_save GTY(())
1179 {
1180 struct queued_reg_save *next;
1181 rtx reg;
1182 HOST_WIDE_INT cfa_offset;
1183 rtx saved_reg;
1184 };
1185
1186 static GTY(()) struct queued_reg_save *queued_reg_saves;
1187
1188 /* The caller's ORIG_REG is saved in SAVED_IN_REG. */
1189 struct reg_saved_in_data GTY(()) {
1190 rtx orig_reg;
1191 rtx saved_in_reg;
1192 };
1193
1194 /* A list of registers saved in other registers.
1195 The list intentionally has a small maximum capacity of 4; if your
1196 port needs more than that, you might consider implementing a
1197 more efficient data structure. */
1198 static GTY(()) struct reg_saved_in_data regs_saved_in_regs[4];
1199 static GTY(()) size_t num_regs_saved_in_regs;
1200
1201 #if defined (DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO) || defined (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
1202 static const char *last_reg_save_label;
1203
1204 /* Add an entry to QUEUED_REG_SAVES saying that REG is now saved at
1205 SREG, or if SREG is NULL then it is saved at OFFSET to the CFA. */
1206
1207 static void
queue_reg_save(const char * label,rtx reg,rtx sreg,HOST_WIDE_INT offset)1208 queue_reg_save (const char *label, rtx reg, rtx sreg, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
1209 {
1210 struct queued_reg_save *q;
1211
1212 /* Duplicates waste space, but it's also necessary to remove them
1213 for correctness, since the queue gets output in reverse
1214 order. */
1215 for (q = queued_reg_saves; q != NULL; q = q->next)
1216 if (REGNO (q->reg) == REGNO (reg))
1217 break;
1218
1219 if (q == NULL)
1220 {
1221 q = ggc_alloc (sizeof (*q));
1222 q->next = queued_reg_saves;
1223 queued_reg_saves = q;
1224 }
1225
1226 q->reg = reg;
1227 q->cfa_offset = offset;
1228 q->saved_reg = sreg;
1229
1230 last_reg_save_label = label;
1231 }
1232
1233 /* Output all the entries in QUEUED_REG_SAVES. */
1234
1235 static void
flush_queued_reg_saves(void)1236 flush_queued_reg_saves (void)
1237 {
1238 struct queued_reg_save *q;
1239
1240 for (q = queued_reg_saves; q; q = q->next)
1241 {
1242 size_t i;
1243 unsigned int reg, sreg;
1244
1245 for (i = 0; i < num_regs_saved_in_regs; i++)
1246 if (REGNO (regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg) == REGNO (q->reg))
1247 break;
1248 if (q->saved_reg && i == num_regs_saved_in_regs)
1249 {
1250 gcc_assert (i != ARRAY_SIZE (regs_saved_in_regs));
1251 num_regs_saved_in_regs++;
1252 }
1253 if (i != num_regs_saved_in_regs)
1254 {
1255 regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg = q->reg;
1256 regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg = q->saved_reg;
1257 }
1258
1259 reg = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (q->reg));
1260 if (q->saved_reg)
1261 sreg = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (q->saved_reg));
1262 else
1263 sreg = INVALID_REGNUM;
1264 reg_save (last_reg_save_label, reg, sreg, q->cfa_offset);
1265 }
1266
1267 queued_reg_saves = NULL;
1268 last_reg_save_label = NULL;
1269 }
1270
1271 /* Does INSN clobber any register which QUEUED_REG_SAVES lists a saved
1272 location for? Or, does it clobber a register which we've previously
1273 said that some other register is saved in, and for which we now
1274 have a new location for? */
1275
1276 static bool
clobbers_queued_reg_save(rtx insn)1277 clobbers_queued_reg_save (rtx insn)
1278 {
1279 struct queued_reg_save *q;
1280
1281 for (q = queued_reg_saves; q; q = q->next)
1282 {
1283 size_t i;
1284 if (modified_in_p (q->reg, insn))
1285 return true;
1286 for (i = 0; i < num_regs_saved_in_regs; i++)
1287 if (REGNO (q->reg) == REGNO (regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg)
1288 && modified_in_p (regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg, insn))
1289 return true;
1290 }
1291
1292 return false;
1293 }
1294
1295 /* Entry point for saving the first register into the second. */
1296
1297 void
dwarf2out_reg_save_reg(const char * label,rtx reg,rtx sreg)1298 dwarf2out_reg_save_reg (const char *label, rtx reg, rtx sreg)
1299 {
1300 size_t i;
1301 unsigned int regno, sregno;
1302
1303 for (i = 0; i < num_regs_saved_in_regs; i++)
1304 if (REGNO (regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg) == REGNO (reg))
1305 break;
1306 if (i == num_regs_saved_in_regs)
1307 {
1308 gcc_assert (i != ARRAY_SIZE (regs_saved_in_regs));
1309 num_regs_saved_in_regs++;
1310 }
1311 regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg = reg;
1312 regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg = sreg;
1313
1314 regno = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (reg));
1315 sregno = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (sreg));
1316 reg_save (label, regno, sregno, 0);
1317 }
1318
1319 /* What register, if any, is currently saved in REG? */
1320
1321 static rtx
reg_saved_in(rtx reg)1322 reg_saved_in (rtx reg)
1323 {
1324 unsigned int regn = REGNO (reg);
1325 size_t i;
1326 struct queued_reg_save *q;
1327
1328 for (q = queued_reg_saves; q; q = q->next)
1329 if (q->saved_reg && regn == REGNO (q->saved_reg))
1330 return q->reg;
1331
1332 for (i = 0; i < num_regs_saved_in_regs; i++)
1333 if (regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg
1334 && regn == REGNO (regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg))
1335 return regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg;
1336
1337 return NULL_RTX;
1338 }
1339
1340
1341 /* A temporary register holding an integral value used in adjusting SP
1342 or setting up the store_reg. The "offset" field holds the integer
1343 value, not an offset. */
1344 static dw_cfa_location cfa_temp;
1345
1346 /* Record call frame debugging information for an expression EXPR,
1347 which either sets SP or FP (adjusting how we calculate the frame
1348 address) or saves a register to the stack or another register.
1349 LABEL indicates the address of EXPR.
1350
1351 This function encodes a state machine mapping rtxes to actions on
1352 cfa, cfa_store, and cfa_temp.reg. We describe these rules so
1353 users need not read the source code.
1354
1355 The High-Level Picture
1356
1357 Changes in the register we use to calculate the CFA: Currently we
1358 assume that if you copy the CFA register into another register, we
1359 should take the other one as the new CFA register; this seems to
1360 work pretty well. If it's wrong for some target, it's simple
1361 enough not to set RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P on the insn in question.
1362
1363 Changes in the register we use for saving registers to the stack:
1364 This is usually SP, but not always. Again, we deduce that if you
1365 copy SP into another register (and SP is not the CFA register),
1366 then the new register is the one we will be using for register
1367 saves. This also seems to work.
1368
1369 Register saves: There's not much guesswork about this one; if
1370 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P is set on an insn which modifies memory, it's a
1371 register save, and the register used to calculate the destination
1372 had better be the one we think we're using for this purpose.
1373 It's also assumed that a copy from a call-saved register to another
1374 register is saving that register if RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P is set on
1375 that instruction. If the copy is from a call-saved register to
1376 the *same* register, that means that the register is now the same
1377 value as in the caller.
1378
1379 Except: If the register being saved is the CFA register, and the
1380 offset is nonzero, we are saving the CFA, so we assume we have to
1381 use DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression. If the offset is 0, we assume that
1382 the intent is to save the value of SP from the previous frame.
1383
1384 In addition, if a register has previously been saved to a different
1385 register,
1386
1387 Invariants / Summaries of Rules
1388
1389 cfa current rule for calculating the CFA. It usually
1390 consists of a register and an offset.
1391 cfa_store register used by prologue code to save things to the stack
1392 cfa_store.offset is the offset from the value of
1393 cfa_store.reg to the actual CFA
1394 cfa_temp register holding an integral value. cfa_temp.offset
1395 stores the value, which will be used to adjust the
1396 stack pointer. cfa_temp is also used like cfa_store,
1397 to track stores to the stack via fp or a temp reg.
1398
1399 Rules 1- 4: Setting a register's value to cfa.reg or an expression
1400 with cfa.reg as the first operand changes the cfa.reg and its
1401 cfa.offset. Rule 1 and 4 also set cfa_temp.reg and
1402 cfa_temp.offset.
1403
1404 Rules 6- 9: Set a non-cfa.reg register value to a constant or an
1405 expression yielding a constant. This sets cfa_temp.reg
1406 and cfa_temp.offset.
1407
1408 Rule 5: Create a new register cfa_store used to save items to the
1409 stack.
1410
1411 Rules 10-14: Save a register to the stack. Define offset as the
1412 difference of the original location and cfa_store's
1413 location (or cfa_temp's location if cfa_temp is used).
1414
1415 The Rules
1416
1417 "{a,b}" indicates a choice of a xor b.
1418 "<reg>:cfa.reg" indicates that <reg> must equal cfa.reg.
1419
1420 Rule 1:
1421 (set <reg1> <reg2>:cfa.reg)
1422 effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
1423 cfa.offset unchanged
1424 cfa_temp.reg = <reg1>
1425 cfa_temp.offset = cfa.offset
1426
1427 Rule 2:
1428 (set sp ({minus,plus,losum} {sp,fp}:cfa.reg
1429 {<const_int>,<reg>:cfa_temp.reg}))
1430 effects: cfa.reg = sp if fp used
1431 cfa.offset += {+/- <const_int>, cfa_temp.offset} if cfa.reg==sp
1432 cfa_store.offset += {+/- <const_int>, cfa_temp.offset}
1433 if cfa_store.reg==sp
1434
1435 Rule 3:
1436 (set fp ({minus,plus,losum} <reg>:cfa.reg <const_int>))
1437 effects: cfa.reg = fp
1438 cfa_offset += +/- <const_int>
1439
1440 Rule 4:
1441 (set <reg1> ({plus,losum} <reg2>:cfa.reg <const_int>))
1442 constraints: <reg1> != fp
1443 <reg1> != sp
1444 effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
1445 cfa_temp.reg = <reg1>
1446 cfa_temp.offset = cfa.offset
1447
1448 Rule 5:
1449 (set <reg1> (plus <reg2>:cfa_temp.reg sp:cfa.reg))
1450 constraints: <reg1> != fp
1451 <reg1> != sp
1452 effects: cfa_store.reg = <reg1>
1453 cfa_store.offset = cfa.offset - cfa_temp.offset
1454
1455 Rule 6:
1456 (set <reg> <const_int>)
1457 effects: cfa_temp.reg = <reg>
1458 cfa_temp.offset = <const_int>
1459
1460 Rule 7:
1461 (set <reg1>:cfa_temp.reg (ior <reg2>:cfa_temp.reg <const_int>))
1462 effects: cfa_temp.reg = <reg1>
1463 cfa_temp.offset |= <const_int>
1464
1465 Rule 8:
1466 (set <reg> (high <exp>))
1467 effects: none
1468
1469 Rule 9:
1470 (set <reg> (lo_sum <exp> <const_int>))
1471 effects: cfa_temp.reg = <reg>
1472 cfa_temp.offset = <const_int>
1473
1474 Rule 10:
1475 (set (mem (pre_modify sp:cfa_store (???? <reg1> <const_int>))) <reg2>)
1476 effects: cfa_store.offset -= <const_int>
1477 cfa.offset = cfa_store.offset if cfa.reg == sp
1478 cfa.reg = sp
1479 cfa.base_offset = -cfa_store.offset
1480
1481 Rule 11:
1482 (set (mem ({pre_inc,pre_dec} sp:cfa_store.reg)) <reg>)
1483 effects: cfa_store.offset += -/+ mode_size(mem)
1484 cfa.offset = cfa_store.offset if cfa.reg == sp
1485 cfa.reg = sp
1486 cfa.base_offset = -cfa_store.offset
1487
1488 Rule 12:
1489 (set (mem ({minus,plus,losum} <reg1>:{cfa_store,cfa_temp} <const_int>))
1490
1491 <reg2>)
1492 effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
1493 cfa.base_offset = -/+ <const_int> - {cfa_store,cfa_temp}.offset
1494
1495 Rule 13:
1496 (set (mem <reg1>:{cfa_store,cfa_temp}) <reg2>)
1497 effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
1498 cfa.base_offset = -{cfa_store,cfa_temp}.offset
1499
1500 Rule 14:
1501 (set (mem (postinc <reg1>:cfa_temp <const_int>)) <reg2>)
1502 effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
1503 cfa.base_offset = -cfa_temp.offset
1504 cfa_temp.offset -= mode_size(mem)
1505
1506 Rule 15:
1507 (set <reg> {unspec, unspec_volatile})
1508 effects: target-dependent */
1509
1510 static void
dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr(rtx expr,const char * label)1511 dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (rtx expr, const char *label)
1512 {
1513 rtx src, dest;
1514 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
1515
1516 /* If RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P is set on a PARALLEL, process each member of
1517 the PARALLEL independently. The first element is always processed if
1518 it is a SET. This is for backward compatibility. Other elements
1519 are processed only if they are SETs and the RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P
1520 flag is set in them. */
1521 if (GET_CODE (expr) == PARALLEL || GET_CODE (expr) == SEQUENCE)
1522 {
1523 int par_index;
1524 int limit = XVECLEN (expr, 0);
1525
1526 for (par_index = 0; par_index < limit; par_index++)
1527 if (GET_CODE (XVECEXP (expr, 0, par_index)) == SET
1528 && (RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (XVECEXP (expr, 0, par_index))
1529 || par_index == 0))
1530 dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (XVECEXP (expr, 0, par_index), label);
1531
1532 return;
1533 }
1534
1535 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (expr) == SET);
1536
1537 src = SET_SRC (expr);
1538 dest = SET_DEST (expr);
1539
1540 if (REG_P (src))
1541 {
1542 rtx rsi = reg_saved_in (src);
1543 if (rsi)
1544 src = rsi;
1545 }
1546
1547 switch (GET_CODE (dest))
1548 {
1549 case REG:
1550 switch (GET_CODE (src))
1551 {
1552 /* Setting FP from SP. */
1553 case REG:
1554 if (cfa.reg == (unsigned) REGNO (src))
1555 {
1556 /* Rule 1 */
1557 /* Update the CFA rule wrt SP or FP. Make sure src is
1558 relative to the current CFA register.
1559
1560 We used to require that dest be either SP or FP, but the
1561 ARM copies SP to a temporary register, and from there to
1562 FP. So we just rely on the backends to only set
1563 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P on appropriate insns. */
1564 cfa.reg = REGNO (dest);
1565 cfa_temp.reg = cfa.reg;
1566 cfa_temp.offset = cfa.offset;
1567 }
1568 else
1569 {
1570 /* Saving a register in a register. */
1571 gcc_assert (!fixed_regs [REGNO (dest)]
1572 /* For the SPARC and its register window. */
1573 || (DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (src))
1574 == DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN));
1575 queue_reg_save (label, src, dest, 0);
1576 }
1577 break;
1578
1579 case PLUS:
1580 case MINUS:
1581 case LO_SUM:
1582 if (dest == stack_pointer_rtx)
1583 {
1584 /* Rule 2 */
1585 /* Adjusting SP. */
1586 switch (GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)))
1587 {
1588 case CONST_INT:
1589 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1590 break;
1591 case REG:
1592 gcc_assert ((unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (src, 1))
1593 == cfa_temp.reg);
1594 offset = cfa_temp.offset;
1595 break;
1596 default:
1597 gcc_unreachable ();
1598 }
1599
1600 if (XEXP (src, 0) == hard_frame_pointer_rtx)
1601 {
1602 /* Restoring SP from FP in the epilogue. */
1603 gcc_assert (cfa.reg == (unsigned) HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM);
1604 cfa.reg = STACK_POINTER_REGNUM;
1605 }
1606 else if (GET_CODE (src) == LO_SUM)
1607 /* Assume we've set the source reg of the LO_SUM from sp. */
1608 ;
1609 else
1610 gcc_assert (XEXP (src, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx);
1611
1612 if (GET_CODE (src) != MINUS)
1613 offset = -offset;
1614 if (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1615 cfa.offset += offset;
1616 if (cfa_store.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1617 cfa_store.offset += offset;
1618 }
1619 else if (dest == hard_frame_pointer_rtx)
1620 {
1621 /* Rule 3 */
1622 /* Either setting the FP from an offset of the SP,
1623 or adjusting the FP */
1624 gcc_assert (frame_pointer_needed);
1625
1626 gcc_assert (REG_P (XEXP (src, 0))
1627 && (unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)) == cfa.reg
1628 && GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) == CONST_INT);
1629 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1630 if (GET_CODE (src) != MINUS)
1631 offset = -offset;
1632 cfa.offset += offset;
1633 cfa.reg = HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM;
1634 }
1635 else
1636 {
1637 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (src) != MINUS);
1638
1639 /* Rule 4 */
1640 if (REG_P (XEXP (src, 0))
1641 && REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)) == cfa.reg
1642 && GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) == CONST_INT)
1643 {
1644 /* Setting a temporary CFA register that will be copied
1645 into the FP later on. */
1646 offset = - INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1647 cfa.offset += offset;
1648 cfa.reg = REGNO (dest);
1649 /* Or used to save regs to the stack. */
1650 cfa_temp.reg = cfa.reg;
1651 cfa_temp.offset = cfa.offset;
1652 }
1653
1654 /* Rule 5 */
1655 else if (REG_P (XEXP (src, 0))
1656 && REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)) == cfa_temp.reg
1657 && XEXP (src, 1) == stack_pointer_rtx)
1658 {
1659 /* Setting a scratch register that we will use instead
1660 of SP for saving registers to the stack. */
1661 gcc_assert (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
1662 cfa_store.reg = REGNO (dest);
1663 cfa_store.offset = cfa.offset - cfa_temp.offset;
1664 }
1665
1666 /* Rule 9 */
1667 else if (GET_CODE (src) == LO_SUM
1668 && GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) == CONST_INT)
1669 {
1670 cfa_temp.reg = REGNO (dest);
1671 cfa_temp.offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1672 }
1673 else
1674 gcc_unreachable ();
1675 }
1676 break;
1677
1678 /* Rule 6 */
1679 case CONST_INT:
1680 cfa_temp.reg = REGNO (dest);
1681 cfa_temp.offset = INTVAL (src);
1682 break;
1683
1684 /* Rule 7 */
1685 case IOR:
1686 gcc_assert (REG_P (XEXP (src, 0))
1687 && (unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)) == cfa_temp.reg
1688 && GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) == CONST_INT);
1689
1690 if ((unsigned) REGNO (dest) != cfa_temp.reg)
1691 cfa_temp.reg = REGNO (dest);
1692 cfa_temp.offset |= INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1693 break;
1694
1695 /* Skip over HIGH, assuming it will be followed by a LO_SUM,
1696 which will fill in all of the bits. */
1697 /* Rule 8 */
1698 case HIGH:
1699 break;
1700
1701 /* Rule 15 */
1702 case UNSPEC:
1703 case UNSPEC_VOLATILE:
1704 gcc_assert (targetm.dwarf_handle_frame_unspec);
1705 targetm.dwarf_handle_frame_unspec (label, expr, XINT (src, 1));
1706 return;
1707
1708 default:
1709 gcc_unreachable ();
1710 }
1711
1712 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
1713 break;
1714
1715 case MEM:
1716 gcc_assert (REG_P (src));
1717
1718 /* Saving a register to the stack. Make sure dest is relative to the
1719 CFA register. */
1720 switch (GET_CODE (XEXP (dest, 0)))
1721 {
1722 /* Rule 10 */
1723 /* With a push. */
1724 case PRE_MODIFY:
1725 /* We can't handle variable size modifications. */
1726 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 1), 1))
1727 == CONST_INT);
1728 offset = -INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 1), 1));
1729
1730 gcc_assert (REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
1731 && cfa_store.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
1732
1733 cfa_store.offset += offset;
1734 if (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1735 cfa.offset = cfa_store.offset;
1736
1737 offset = -cfa_store.offset;
1738 break;
1739
1740 /* Rule 11 */
1741 case PRE_INC:
1742 case PRE_DEC:
1743 offset = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest));
1744 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (dest, 0)) == PRE_INC)
1745 offset = -offset;
1746
1747 gcc_assert (REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
1748 && cfa_store.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
1749
1750 cfa_store.offset += offset;
1751 if (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1752 cfa.offset = cfa_store.offset;
1753
1754 offset = -cfa_store.offset;
1755 break;
1756
1757 /* Rule 12 */
1758 /* With an offset. */
1759 case PLUS:
1760 case MINUS:
1761 case LO_SUM:
1762 {
1763 int regno;
1764
1765 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 1)) == CONST_INT
1766 && REG_P (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0)));
1767 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 1));
1768 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (dest, 0)) == MINUS)
1769 offset = -offset;
1770
1771 regno = REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0));
1772
1773 if (cfa_store.reg == (unsigned) regno)
1774 offset -= cfa_store.offset;
1775 else
1776 {
1777 gcc_assert (cfa_temp.reg == (unsigned) regno);
1778 offset -= cfa_temp.offset;
1779 }
1780 }
1781 break;
1782
1783 /* Rule 13 */
1784 /* Without an offset. */
1785 case REG:
1786 {
1787 int regno = REGNO (XEXP (dest, 0));
1788
1789 if (cfa_store.reg == (unsigned) regno)
1790 offset = -cfa_store.offset;
1791 else
1792 {
1793 gcc_assert (cfa_temp.reg == (unsigned) regno);
1794 offset = -cfa_temp.offset;
1795 }
1796 }
1797 break;
1798
1799 /* Rule 14 */
1800 case POST_INC:
1801 gcc_assert (cfa_temp.reg
1802 == (unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0)));
1803 offset = -cfa_temp.offset;
1804 cfa_temp.offset -= GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest));
1805 break;
1806
1807 default:
1808 gcc_unreachable ();
1809 }
1810
1811 if (REGNO (src) != STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
1812 && REGNO (src) != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
1813 && (unsigned) REGNO (src) == cfa.reg)
1814 {
1815 /* We're storing the current CFA reg into the stack. */
1816
1817 if (cfa.offset == 0)
1818 {
1819 /* If the source register is exactly the CFA, assume
1820 we're saving SP like any other register; this happens
1821 on the ARM. */
1822 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
1823 queue_reg_save (label, stack_pointer_rtx, NULL_RTX, offset);
1824 break;
1825 }
1826 else
1827 {
1828 /* Otherwise, we'll need to look in the stack to
1829 calculate the CFA. */
1830 rtx x = XEXP (dest, 0);
1831
1832 if (!REG_P (x))
1833 x = XEXP (x, 0);
1834 gcc_assert (REG_P (x));
1835
1836 cfa.reg = REGNO (x);
1837 cfa.base_offset = offset;
1838 cfa.indirect = 1;
1839 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
1840 break;
1841 }
1842 }
1843
1844 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
1845 queue_reg_save (label, src, NULL_RTX, offset);
1846 break;
1847
1848 default:
1849 gcc_unreachable ();
1850 }
1851 }
1852
1853 /* Record call frame debugging information for INSN, which either
1854 sets SP or FP (adjusting how we calculate the frame address) or saves a
1855 register to the stack. If INSN is NULL_RTX, initialize our state.
1856
1857 If AFTER_P is false, we're being called before the insn is emitted,
1858 otherwise after. Call instructions get invoked twice. */
1859
1860 void
dwarf2out_frame_debug(rtx insn,bool after_p)1861 dwarf2out_frame_debug (rtx insn, bool after_p)
1862 {
1863 const char *label;
1864 rtx src;
1865
1866 if (insn == NULL_RTX)
1867 {
1868 size_t i;
1869
1870 /* Flush any queued register saves. */
1871 flush_queued_reg_saves ();
1872
1873 /* Set up state for generating call frame debug info. */
1874 lookup_cfa (&cfa);
1875 gcc_assert (cfa.reg
1876 == (unsigned long)DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (STACK_POINTER_REGNUM));
1877
1878 cfa.reg = STACK_POINTER_REGNUM;
1879 cfa_store = cfa;
1880 cfa_temp.reg = -1;
1881 cfa_temp.offset = 0;
1882
1883 for (i = 0; i < num_regs_saved_in_regs; i++)
1884 {
1885 regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg = NULL_RTX;
1886 regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg = NULL_RTX;
1887 }
1888 num_regs_saved_in_regs = 0;
1889 return;
1890 }
1891
1892 if (!NONJUMP_INSN_P (insn) || clobbers_queued_reg_save (insn))
1893 flush_queued_reg_saves ();
1894
1895 if (! RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (insn))
1896 {
1897 if (!ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS)
1898 dwarf2out_stack_adjust (insn, after_p);
1899 return;
1900 }
1901
1902 label = dwarf2out_cfi_label ();
1903 src = find_reg_note (insn, REG_FRAME_RELATED_EXPR, NULL_RTX);
1904 if (src)
1905 insn = XEXP (src, 0);
1906 else
1907 insn = PATTERN (insn);
1908
1909 dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (insn, label);
1910 }
1911
1912 #endif
1913
1914 /* Describe for the GTY machinery what parts of dw_cfi_oprnd1 are used. */
1915 static enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type dw_cfi_oprnd1_desc
1916 (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi);
1917
1918 static enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type
dw_cfi_oprnd1_desc(enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi)1919 dw_cfi_oprnd1_desc (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi)
1920 {
1921 switch (cfi)
1922 {
1923 case DW_CFA_nop:
1924 case DW_CFA_GNU_window_save:
1925 return dw_cfi_oprnd_unused;
1926
1927 case DW_CFA_set_loc:
1928 case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
1929 case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
1930 case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
1931 case DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8:
1932 return dw_cfi_oprnd_addr;
1933
1934 case DW_CFA_offset:
1935 case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
1936 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
1937 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
1938 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
1939 case DW_CFA_restore_extended:
1940 case DW_CFA_undefined:
1941 case DW_CFA_same_value:
1942 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
1943 case DW_CFA_register:
1944 return dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num;
1945
1946 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
1947 case DW_CFA_GNU_args_size:
1948 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
1949 return dw_cfi_oprnd_offset;
1950
1951 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
1952 case DW_CFA_expression:
1953 return dw_cfi_oprnd_loc;
1954
1955 default:
1956 gcc_unreachable ();
1957 }
1958 }
1959
1960 /* Describe for the GTY machinery what parts of dw_cfi_oprnd2 are used. */
1961 static enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type dw_cfi_oprnd2_desc
1962 (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi);
1963
1964 static enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type
dw_cfi_oprnd2_desc(enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi)1965 dw_cfi_oprnd2_desc (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi)
1966 {
1967 switch (cfi)
1968 {
1969 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
1970 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
1971 case DW_CFA_offset:
1972 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
1973 case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
1974 return dw_cfi_oprnd_offset;
1975
1976 case DW_CFA_register:
1977 return dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num;
1978
1979 default:
1980 return dw_cfi_oprnd_unused;
1981 }
1982 }
1983
1984 #if defined (DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO) || defined (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
1985
1986 /* Switch to eh_frame_section. If we don't have an eh_frame_section,
1987 switch to the data section instead, and write out a synthetic label
1988 for collect2. */
1989
1990 static void
switch_to_eh_frame_section(void)1991 switch_to_eh_frame_section (void)
1992 {
1993 tree label;
1994
1995 #ifdef EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
1996 if (eh_frame_section == 0)
1997 {
1998 int flags;
1999
2000 if (EH_TABLES_CAN_BE_READ_ONLY)
2001 {
2002 int fde_encoding;
2003 int per_encoding;
2004 int lsda_encoding;
2005
2006 fde_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/1,
2007 /*global=*/0);
2008 per_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/2,
2009 /*global=*/1);
2010 lsda_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/0,
2011 /*global=*/0);
2012 flags = ((! flag_pic
2013 || ((fde_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_absptr
2014 && (fde_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_aligned
2015 && (per_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_absptr
2016 && (per_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_aligned
2017 && (lsda_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_absptr
2018 && (lsda_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_aligned))
2019 ? 0 : SECTION_WRITE);
2020 }
2021 else
2022 flags = SECTION_WRITE;
2023 eh_frame_section = get_section (EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME, flags, NULL);
2024 }
2025 #endif
2026
2027 if (eh_frame_section)
2028 switch_to_section (eh_frame_section);
2029 else
2030 {
2031 /* We have no special eh_frame section. Put the information in
2032 the data section and emit special labels to guide collect2. */
2033 switch_to_section (data_section);
2034 label = get_file_function_name ('F');
2035 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file, floor_log2 (PTR_SIZE));
2036 targetm.asm_out.globalize_label (asm_out_file,
2037 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (label));
2038 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (label));
2039 }
2040 }
2041
2042 /* Output a Call Frame Information opcode and its operand(s). */
2043
2044 static void
output_cfi(dw_cfi_ref cfi,dw_fde_ref fde,int for_eh)2045 output_cfi (dw_cfi_ref cfi, dw_fde_ref fde, int for_eh)
2046 {
2047 unsigned long r;
2048 if (cfi->dw_cfi_opc == DW_CFA_advance_loc)
2049 dw2_asm_output_data (1, (cfi->dw_cfi_opc
2050 | (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset & 0x3f)),
2051 "DW_CFA_advance_loc " HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_HEX,
2052 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset);
2053 else if (cfi->dw_cfi_opc == DW_CFA_offset)
2054 {
2055 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
2056 dw2_asm_output_data (1, (cfi->dw_cfi_opc | (r & 0x3f)),
2057 "DW_CFA_offset, column 0x%lx", r);
2058 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset, NULL);
2059 }
2060 else if (cfi->dw_cfi_opc == DW_CFA_restore)
2061 {
2062 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
2063 dw2_asm_output_data (1, (cfi->dw_cfi_opc | (r & 0x3f)),
2064 "DW_CFA_restore, column 0x%lx", r);
2065 }
2066 else
2067 {
2068 dw2_asm_output_data (1, cfi->dw_cfi_opc,
2069 "%s", dwarf_cfi_name (cfi->dw_cfi_opc));
2070
2071 switch (cfi->dw_cfi_opc)
2072 {
2073 case DW_CFA_set_loc:
2074 if (for_eh)
2075 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (
2076 ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/1, /*global=*/0),
2077 gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr),
2078 false, NULL);
2079 else
2080 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
2081 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr, NULL);
2082 fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
2083 break;
2084
2085 case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
2086 dw2_asm_output_delta (1, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr,
2087 fde->dw_fde_current_label, NULL);
2088 fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
2089 break;
2090
2091 case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
2092 dw2_asm_output_delta (2, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr,
2093 fde->dw_fde_current_label, NULL);
2094 fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
2095 break;
2096
2097 case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
2098 dw2_asm_output_delta (4, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr,
2099 fde->dw_fde_current_label, NULL);
2100 fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
2101 break;
2102
2103 case DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8:
2104 dw2_asm_output_delta (8, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr,
2105 fde->dw_fde_current_label, NULL);
2106 fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
2107 break;
2108
2109 case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
2110 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
2111 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
2112 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
2113 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset, NULL);
2114 break;
2115
2116 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
2117 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
2118 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
2119 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
2120 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset, NULL);
2121 break;
2122
2123 case DW_CFA_restore_extended:
2124 case DW_CFA_undefined:
2125 case DW_CFA_same_value:
2126 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
2127 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
2128 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
2129 break;
2130
2131 case DW_CFA_register:
2132 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
2133 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
2134 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
2135 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
2136 break;
2137
2138 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
2139 case DW_CFA_GNU_args_size:
2140 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset, NULL);
2141 break;
2142
2143 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
2144 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset, NULL);
2145 break;
2146
2147 case DW_CFA_GNU_window_save:
2148 break;
2149
2150 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
2151 case DW_CFA_expression:
2152 output_cfa_loc (cfi);
2153 break;
2154
2155 case DW_CFA_GNU_negative_offset_extended:
2156 /* Obsoleted by DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf. */
2157 gcc_unreachable ();
2158
2159 default:
2160 break;
2161 }
2162 }
2163 }
2164
2165 /* Output the call frame information used to record information
2166 that relates to calculating the frame pointer, and records the
2167 location of saved registers. */
2168
2169 static void
output_call_frame_info(int for_eh)2170 output_call_frame_info (int for_eh)
2171 {
2172 unsigned int i;
2173 dw_fde_ref fde;
2174 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
2175 char l1[20], l2[20], section_start_label[20];
2176 bool any_lsda_needed = false;
2177 char augmentation[6];
2178 int augmentation_size;
2179 int fde_encoding = DW_EH_PE_absptr;
2180 int per_encoding = DW_EH_PE_absptr;
2181 int lsda_encoding = DW_EH_PE_absptr;
2182 int return_reg;
2183
2184 /* Don't emit a CIE if there won't be any FDEs. */
2185 if (fde_table_in_use == 0)
2186 return;
2187
2188 /* If we make FDEs linkonce, we may have to emit an empty label for
2189 an FDE that wouldn't otherwise be emitted. We want to avoid
2190 having an FDE kept around when the function it refers to is
2191 discarded. Example where this matters: a primary function
2192 template in C++ requires EH information, but an explicit
2193 specialization doesn't. */
2194 if (TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO
2195 && ! flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables
2196 /* APPLE LOCAL begin for-fsf-4_4 5480287 */ \
2197 && flag_exceptions
2198 /* APPLE LOCAL end for-fsf-4_4 5480287 */ \
2199 && for_eh)
2200 for (i = 0; i < fde_table_in_use; i++)
2201 if ((fde_table[i].nothrow || fde_table[i].all_throwers_are_sibcalls)
2202 && !fde_table[i].uses_eh_lsda
2203 && ! DECL_WEAK (fde_table[i].decl))
2204 targetm.asm_out.unwind_label (asm_out_file, fde_table[i].decl,
2205 for_eh, /* empty */ 1);
2206
2207 /* If we don't have any functions we'll want to unwind out of, don't
2208 emit any EH unwind information. Note that if exceptions aren't
2209 enabled, we won't have collected nothrow information, and if we
2210 asked for asynchronous tables, we always want this info. */
2211 if (for_eh)
2212 {
2213 bool any_eh_needed = !flag_exceptions || flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables;
2214
2215 for (i = 0; i < fde_table_in_use; i++)
2216 if (fde_table[i].uses_eh_lsda)
2217 any_eh_needed = any_lsda_needed = true;
2218 else if (TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO && DECL_WEAK (fde_table[i].decl))
2219 any_eh_needed = true;
2220 else if (! fde_table[i].nothrow
2221 && ! fde_table[i].all_throwers_are_sibcalls)
2222 any_eh_needed = true;
2223
2224 if (! any_eh_needed)
2225 return;
2226 }
2227
2228 /* We're going to be generating comments, so turn on app. */
2229 if (flag_debug_asm)
2230 app_enable ();
2231
2232 if (for_eh)
2233 switch_to_eh_frame_section ();
2234 else
2235 {
2236 if (!debug_frame_section)
2237 debug_frame_section = get_section (DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION,
2238 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
2239 switch_to_section (debug_frame_section);
2240 }
2241
2242 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (section_start_label, FRAME_BEGIN_LABEL, for_eh);
2243 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, section_start_label);
2244
2245 /* Output the CIE. */
2246 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, CIE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL, for_eh);
2247 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, CIE_END_LABEL, for_eh);
2248 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 && !for_eh)
2249 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
2250 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
2251 dw2_asm_output_delta (for_eh ? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
2252 "Length of Common Information Entry");
2253 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
2254
2255 /* Now that the CIE pointer is PC-relative for EH,
2256 use 0 to identify the CIE. */
2257 dw2_asm_output_data ((for_eh ? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE),
2258 (for_eh ? 0 : DWARF_CIE_ID),
2259 "CIE Identifier Tag");
2260
2261 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_CIE_VERSION, "CIE Version");
2262
2263 augmentation[0] = 0;
2264 augmentation_size = 0;
2265 if (for_eh)
2266 {
2267 char *p;
2268
2269 /* Augmentation:
2270 z Indicates that a uleb128 is present to size the
2271 augmentation section.
2272 L Indicates the encoding (and thus presence) of
2273 an LSDA pointer in the FDE augmentation.
2274 R Indicates a non-default pointer encoding for
2275 FDE code pointers.
2276 P Indicates the presence of an encoding + language
2277 personality routine in the CIE augmentation. */
2278
2279 fde_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/1, /*global=*/0);
2280 per_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/2, /*global=*/1);
2281 lsda_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/0, /*global=*/0);
2282
2283 p = augmentation + 1;
2284 if (eh_personality_libfunc)
2285 {
2286 *p++ = 'P';
2287 augmentation_size += 1 + size_of_encoded_value (per_encoding);
2288 }
2289 if (any_lsda_needed)
2290 {
2291 *p++ = 'L';
2292 augmentation_size += 1;
2293 }
2294 if (fde_encoding != DW_EH_PE_absptr)
2295 {
2296 *p++ = 'R';
2297 augmentation_size += 1;
2298 }
2299 if (p > augmentation + 1)
2300 {
2301 augmentation[0] = 'z';
2302 *p = '\0';
2303 }
2304
2305 /* Ug. Some platforms can't do unaligned dynamic relocations at all. */
2306 if (eh_personality_libfunc && per_encoding == DW_EH_PE_aligned)
2307 {
2308 int offset = ( 4 /* Length */
2309 + 4 /* CIE Id */
2310 + 1 /* CIE version */
2311 + strlen (augmentation) + 1 /* Augmentation */
2312 + size_of_uleb128 (1) /* Code alignment */
2313 + size_of_sleb128 (DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT)
2314 + 1 /* RA column */
2315 + 1 /* Augmentation size */
2316 + 1 /* Personality encoding */ );
2317 int pad = -offset & (PTR_SIZE - 1);
2318
2319 augmentation_size += pad;
2320
2321 /* Augmentations should be small, so there's scarce need to
2322 iterate for a solution. Die if we exceed one uleb128 byte. */
2323 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (augmentation_size) == 1);
2324 }
2325 }
2326
2327 dw2_asm_output_nstring (augmentation, -1, "CIE Augmentation");
2328 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1, "CIE Code Alignment Factor");
2329 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT,
2330 "CIE Data Alignment Factor");
2331
2332 return_reg = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, for_eh);
2333 if (DW_CIE_VERSION == 1)
2334 dw2_asm_output_data (1, return_reg, "CIE RA Column");
2335 else
2336 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (return_reg, "CIE RA Column");
2337
2338 if (augmentation[0])
2339 {
2340 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (augmentation_size, "Augmentation size");
2341 if (eh_personality_libfunc)
2342 {
2343 dw2_asm_output_data (1, per_encoding, "Personality (%s)",
2344 eh_data_format_name (per_encoding));
2345 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (per_encoding,
2346 eh_personality_libfunc,
2347 true, NULL);
2348 }
2349
2350 if (any_lsda_needed)
2351 dw2_asm_output_data (1, lsda_encoding, "LSDA Encoding (%s)",
2352 eh_data_format_name (lsda_encoding));
2353
2354 if (fde_encoding != DW_EH_PE_absptr)
2355 dw2_asm_output_data (1, fde_encoding, "FDE Encoding (%s)",
2356 eh_data_format_name (fde_encoding));
2357 }
2358
2359 for (cfi = cie_cfi_head; cfi != NULL; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
2360 output_cfi (cfi, NULL, for_eh);
2361
2362 /* Pad the CIE out to an address sized boundary. */
2363 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file,
2364 floor_log2 (for_eh ? PTR_SIZE : DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE));
2365 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
2366
2367 /* Loop through all of the FDE's. */
2368 for (i = 0; i < fde_table_in_use; i++)
2369 {
2370 fde = &fde_table[i];
2371
2372 /* Don't emit EH unwind info for leaf functions that don't need it. */
2373 if (for_eh && !flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables && flag_exceptions
2374 && (fde->nothrow || fde->all_throwers_are_sibcalls)
2375 && ! (TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO && DECL_WEAK (fde_table[i].decl))
2376 && !fde->uses_eh_lsda)
2377 continue;
2378
2379 targetm.asm_out.unwind_label (asm_out_file, fde->decl, for_eh, /* empty */ 0);
2380 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, FDE_LABEL, for_eh + i * 2);
2381 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, FDE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL, for_eh + i * 2);
2382 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, FDE_END_LABEL, for_eh + i * 2);
2383 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 && !for_eh)
2384 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
2385 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
2386 dw2_asm_output_delta (for_eh ? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
2387 "FDE Length");
2388 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
2389
2390 if (for_eh)
2391 dw2_asm_output_delta (4, l1, section_start_label, "FDE CIE offset");
2392 else
2393 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, section_start_label,
2394 debug_frame_section, "FDE CIE offset");
2395
2396 if (for_eh)
2397 {
2398 rtx sym_ref = gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, fde->dw_fde_begin);
2399 SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS (sym_ref) |= SYMBOL_FLAG_LOCAL;
2400 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (fde_encoding,
2401 sym_ref,
2402 false,
2403 "FDE initial location");
2404 if (fde->dw_fde_switched_sections)
2405 {
2406 rtx sym_ref2 = gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode,
2407 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_label);
2408 rtx sym_ref3= gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode,
2409 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_label);
2410 SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS (sym_ref2) |= SYMBOL_FLAG_LOCAL;
2411 SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS (sym_ref3) |= SYMBOL_FLAG_LOCAL;
2412 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (fde_encoding, sym_ref3, false,
2413 "FDE initial location");
2414 dw2_asm_output_delta (size_of_encoded_value (fde_encoding),
2415 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_end_label,
2416 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_label,
2417 "FDE address range");
2418 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (fde_encoding, sym_ref2, false,
2419 "FDE initial location");
2420 dw2_asm_output_delta (size_of_encoded_value (fde_encoding),
2421 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_end_label,
2422 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_label,
2423 "FDE address range");
2424 }
2425 else
2426 dw2_asm_output_delta (size_of_encoded_value (fde_encoding),
2427 fde->dw_fde_end, fde->dw_fde_begin,
2428 "FDE address range");
2429 }
2430 else
2431 {
2432 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, fde->dw_fde_begin,
2433 "FDE initial location");
2434 if (fde->dw_fde_switched_sections)
2435 {
2436 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
2437 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_label,
2438 "FDE initial location");
2439 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
2440 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_end_label,
2441 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_label,
2442 "FDE address range");
2443 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
2444 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_label,
2445 "FDE initial location");
2446 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
2447 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_end_label,
2448 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_label,
2449 "FDE address range");
2450 }
2451 else
2452 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
2453 fde->dw_fde_end, fde->dw_fde_begin,
2454 "FDE address range");
2455 }
2456
2457 if (augmentation[0])
2458 {
2459 if (any_lsda_needed)
2460 {
2461 int size = size_of_encoded_value (lsda_encoding);
2462
2463 if (lsda_encoding == DW_EH_PE_aligned)
2464 {
2465 int offset = ( 4 /* Length */
2466 + 4 /* CIE offset */
2467 + 2 * size_of_encoded_value (fde_encoding)
2468 + 1 /* Augmentation size */ );
2469 int pad = -offset & (PTR_SIZE - 1);
2470
2471 size += pad;
2472 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (size) == 1);
2473 }
2474
2475 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (size, "Augmentation size");
2476
2477 if (fde->uses_eh_lsda)
2478 {
2479 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, "LLSDA",
2480 fde->funcdef_number);
2481 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (
2482 lsda_encoding, gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, l1),
2483 false, "Language Specific Data Area");
2484 }
2485 else
2486 {
2487 if (lsda_encoding == DW_EH_PE_aligned)
2488 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file, floor_log2 (PTR_SIZE));
2489 dw2_asm_output_data
2490 (size_of_encoded_value (lsda_encoding), 0,
2491 "Language Specific Data Area (none)");
2492 }
2493 }
2494 else
2495 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, "Augmentation size");
2496 }
2497
2498 /* Loop through the Call Frame Instructions associated with
2499 this FDE. */
2500 fde->dw_fde_current_label = fde->dw_fde_begin;
2501 for (cfi = fde->dw_fde_cfi; cfi != NULL; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
2502 output_cfi (cfi, fde, for_eh);
2503
2504 /* Pad the FDE out to an address sized boundary. */
2505 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file,
2506 floor_log2 ((for_eh ? PTR_SIZE : DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)));
2507 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
2508 }
2509
2510 if (for_eh && targetm.terminate_dw2_eh_frame_info)
2511 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0, "End of Table");
2512 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
2513 /* Work around Irix 6 assembler bug whereby labels at the end of a section
2514 get a value of 0. Putting .align 0 after the label fixes it. */
2515 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file, 0);
2516 #endif
2517
2518 /* Turn off app to make assembly quicker. */
2519 if (flag_debug_asm)
2520 app_disable ();
2521 }
2522
2523 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the beginning of a function, before
2524 the prologue. */
2525
2526 void
dwarf2out_begin_prologue(unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,const char * file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)2527 dwarf2out_begin_prologue (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2528 const char *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
2529 {
2530 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
2531 char * dup_label;
2532 dw_fde_ref fde;
2533
2534 current_function_func_begin_label = NULL;
2535
2536 #ifdef TARGET_UNWIND_INFO
2537 /* ??? current_function_func_begin_label is also used by except.c
2538 for call-site information. We must emit this label if it might
2539 be used. */
2540 if ((! flag_exceptions || USING_SJLJ_EXCEPTIONS)
2541 && ! dwarf2out_do_frame ())
2542 return;
2543 #else
2544 if (! dwarf2out_do_frame ())
2545 return;
2546 #endif
2547
2548 switch_to_section (function_section (current_function_decl));
2549 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL,
2550 current_function_funcdef_no);
2551 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL,
2552 current_function_funcdef_no);
2553 dup_label = xstrdup (label);
2554 current_function_func_begin_label = dup_label;
2555
2556 #ifdef TARGET_UNWIND_INFO
2557 /* We can elide the fde allocation if we're not emitting debug info. */
2558 if (! dwarf2out_do_frame ())
2559 return;
2560 #endif
2561
2562 /* Expand the fde table if necessary. */
2563 if (fde_table_in_use == fde_table_allocated)
2564 {
2565 fde_table_allocated += FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
2566 fde_table = ggc_realloc (fde_table,
2567 fde_table_allocated * sizeof (dw_fde_node));
2568 memset (fde_table + fde_table_in_use, 0,
2569 FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (dw_fde_node));
2570 }
2571
2572 /* Record the FDE associated with this function. */
2573 current_funcdef_fde = fde_table_in_use;
2574
2575 /* Add the new FDE at the end of the fde_table. */
2576 fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use++];
2577 fde->decl = current_function_decl;
2578 fde->dw_fde_begin = dup_label;
2579 fde->dw_fde_current_label = dup_label;
2580 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_label = NULL;
2581 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_end_label = NULL;
2582 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_label = NULL;
2583 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_end_label = NULL;
2584 fde->dw_fde_switched_sections = false;
2585 fde->dw_fde_end = NULL;
2586 fde->dw_fde_cfi = NULL;
2587 fde->funcdef_number = current_function_funcdef_no;
2588 fde->nothrow = TREE_NOTHROW (current_function_decl);
2589 fde->uses_eh_lsda = cfun->uses_eh_lsda;
2590 fde->all_throwers_are_sibcalls = cfun->all_throwers_are_sibcalls;
2591
2592 args_size = old_args_size = 0;
2593
2594 /* We only want to output line number information for the genuine dwarf2
2595 prologue case, not the eh frame case. */
2596 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
2597 if (file)
2598 dwarf2out_source_line (line, file);
2599 #endif
2600 }
2601
2602 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the absolute end of the generated code
2603 for a function definition. This gets called *after* the epilogue code has
2604 been generated. */
2605
2606 void
dwarf2out_end_epilogue(unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,const char * file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)2607 dwarf2out_end_epilogue (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2608 const char *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
2609 {
2610 dw_fde_ref fde;
2611 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
2612
2613 /* Output a label to mark the endpoint of the code generated for this
2614 function. */
2615 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, FUNC_END_LABEL,
2616 current_function_funcdef_no);
2617 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, label);
2618 fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use - 1];
2619 fde->dw_fde_end = xstrdup (label);
2620 }
2621
2622 void
dwarf2out_frame_init(void)2623 dwarf2out_frame_init (void)
2624 {
2625 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the fde_table. */
2626 fde_table = ggc_alloc_cleared (FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (dw_fde_node));
2627 fde_table_allocated = FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
2628 fde_table_in_use = 0;
2629
2630 /* Generate the CFA instructions common to all FDE's. Do it now for the
2631 sake of lookup_cfa. */
2632
2633 /* On entry, the Canonical Frame Address is at SP. */
2634 dwarf2out_def_cfa (NULL, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM, INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET);
2635
2636 #ifdef DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
2637 if (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
2638 initial_return_save (INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX);
2639 #endif
2640 }
2641
2642 void
dwarf2out_frame_finish(void)2643 dwarf2out_frame_finish (void)
2644 {
2645 /* Output call frame information. */
2646 if (DWARF2_FRAME_INFO)
2647 output_call_frame_info (0);
2648
2649 #ifndef TARGET_UNWIND_INFO
2650 /* Output another copy for the unwinder. */
2651 if (! USING_SJLJ_EXCEPTIONS && (flag_unwind_tables || flag_exceptions))
2652 output_call_frame_info (1);
2653 #endif
2654 }
2655 #endif
2656
2657 /* And now, the subset of the debugging information support code necessary
2658 for emitting location expressions. */
2659
2660 /* Data about a single source file. */
2661 struct dwarf_file_data GTY(())
2662 {
2663 const char * filename;
2664 int emitted_number;
2665 };
2666
2667 /* We need some way to distinguish DW_OP_addr with a direct symbol
2668 relocation from DW_OP_addr with a dtp-relative symbol relocation. */
2669 #define INTERNAL_DW_OP_tls_addr (0x100 + DW_OP_addr)
2670
2671
2672 typedef struct dw_val_struct *dw_val_ref;
2673 typedef struct die_struct *dw_die_ref;
2674 typedef struct dw_loc_descr_struct *dw_loc_descr_ref;
2675 typedef struct dw_loc_list_struct *dw_loc_list_ref;
2676
2677 /* Each DIE may have a series of attribute/value pairs. Values
2678 can take on several forms. The forms that are used in this
2679 implementation are listed below. */
2680
2681 enum dw_val_class
2682 {
2683 dw_val_class_addr,
2684 dw_val_class_offset,
2685 dw_val_class_loc,
2686 dw_val_class_loc_list,
2687 dw_val_class_range_list,
2688 dw_val_class_const,
2689 dw_val_class_unsigned_const,
2690 dw_val_class_long_long,
2691 dw_val_class_vec,
2692 dw_val_class_flag,
2693 dw_val_class_die_ref,
2694 dw_val_class_fde_ref,
2695 dw_val_class_lbl_id,
2696 dw_val_class_lineptr,
2697 dw_val_class_str,
2698 dw_val_class_macptr,
2699 dw_val_class_file
2700 };
2701
2702 /* Describe a double word constant value. */
2703 /* ??? Every instance of long_long in the code really means CONST_DOUBLE. */
2704
2705 typedef struct dw_long_long_struct GTY(())
2706 {
2707 unsigned long hi;
2708 unsigned long low;
2709 }
2710 dw_long_long_const;
2711
2712 /* Describe a floating point constant value, or a vector constant value. */
2713
2714 typedef struct dw_vec_struct GTY(())
2715 {
2716 unsigned char * GTY((length ("%h.length"))) array;
2717 unsigned length;
2718 unsigned elt_size;
2719 }
2720 dw_vec_const;
2721
2722 /* The dw_val_node describes an attribute's value, as it is
2723 represented internally. */
2724
2725 typedef struct dw_val_struct GTY(())
2726 {
2727 enum dw_val_class val_class;
2728 union dw_val_struct_union
2729 {
2730 rtx GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_addr"))) val_addr;
2731 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_offset"))) val_offset;
2732 dw_loc_list_ref GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_loc_list"))) val_loc_list;
2733 dw_loc_descr_ref GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_loc"))) val_loc;
2734 HOST_WIDE_INT GTY ((default)) val_int;
2735 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_unsigned_const"))) val_unsigned;
2736 dw_long_long_const GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_long_long"))) val_long_long;
2737 dw_vec_const GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_vec"))) val_vec;
2738 struct dw_val_die_union
2739 {
2740 dw_die_ref die;
2741 int external;
2742 } GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_die_ref"))) val_die_ref;
2743 unsigned GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_fde_ref"))) val_fde_index;
2744 struct indirect_string_node * GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_str"))) val_str;
2745 char * GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_lbl_id"))) val_lbl_id;
2746 unsigned char GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_flag"))) val_flag;
2747 struct dwarf_file_data * GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_file"))) val_file;
2748 }
2749 GTY ((desc ("%1.val_class"))) v;
2750 }
2751 dw_val_node;
2752
2753 /* Locations in memory are described using a sequence of stack machine
2754 operations. */
2755
2756 typedef struct dw_loc_descr_struct GTY(())
2757 {
2758 dw_loc_descr_ref dw_loc_next;
2759 enum dwarf_location_atom dw_loc_opc;
2760 dw_val_node dw_loc_oprnd1;
2761 dw_val_node dw_loc_oprnd2;
2762 int dw_loc_addr;
2763 }
2764 dw_loc_descr_node;
2765
2766 /* Location lists are ranges + location descriptions for that range,
2767 so you can track variables that are in different places over
2768 their entire life. */
2769 typedef struct dw_loc_list_struct GTY(())
2770 {
2771 dw_loc_list_ref dw_loc_next;
2772 const char *begin; /* Label for begin address of range */
2773 const char *end; /* Label for end address of range */
2774 char *ll_symbol; /* Label for beginning of location list.
2775 Only on head of list */
2776 const char *section; /* Section this loclist is relative to */
2777 dw_loc_descr_ref expr;
2778 } dw_loc_list_node;
2779
2780 #if defined (DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO) || defined (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
2781
2782 static const char *dwarf_stack_op_name (unsigned);
2783 static dw_loc_descr_ref new_loc_descr (enum dwarf_location_atom,
2784 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
2785 static void add_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref *, dw_loc_descr_ref);
2786 static unsigned long size_of_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref);
2787 static unsigned long size_of_locs (dw_loc_descr_ref);
2788 static void output_loc_operands (dw_loc_descr_ref);
2789 static void output_loc_sequence (dw_loc_descr_ref);
2790
2791 /* Convert a DWARF stack opcode into its string name. */
2792
2793 static const char *
dwarf_stack_op_name(unsigned int op)2794 dwarf_stack_op_name (unsigned int op)
2795 {
2796 switch (op)
2797 {
2798 case DW_OP_addr:
2799 case INTERNAL_DW_OP_tls_addr:
2800 return "DW_OP_addr";
2801 case DW_OP_deref:
2802 return "DW_OP_deref";
2803 case DW_OP_const1u:
2804 return "DW_OP_const1u";
2805 case DW_OP_const1s:
2806 return "DW_OP_const1s";
2807 case DW_OP_const2u:
2808 return "DW_OP_const2u";
2809 case DW_OP_const2s:
2810 return "DW_OP_const2s";
2811 case DW_OP_const4u:
2812 return "DW_OP_const4u";
2813 case DW_OP_const4s:
2814 return "DW_OP_const4s";
2815 case DW_OP_const8u:
2816 return "DW_OP_const8u";
2817 case DW_OP_const8s:
2818 return "DW_OP_const8s";
2819 case DW_OP_constu:
2820 return "DW_OP_constu";
2821 case DW_OP_consts:
2822 return "DW_OP_consts";
2823 case DW_OP_dup:
2824 return "DW_OP_dup";
2825 case DW_OP_drop:
2826 return "DW_OP_drop";
2827 case DW_OP_over:
2828 return "DW_OP_over";
2829 case DW_OP_pick:
2830 return "DW_OP_pick";
2831 case DW_OP_swap:
2832 return "DW_OP_swap";
2833 case DW_OP_rot:
2834 return "DW_OP_rot";
2835 case DW_OP_xderef:
2836 return "DW_OP_xderef";
2837 case DW_OP_abs:
2838 return "DW_OP_abs";
2839 case DW_OP_and:
2840 return "DW_OP_and";
2841 case DW_OP_div:
2842 return "DW_OP_div";
2843 case DW_OP_minus:
2844 return "DW_OP_minus";
2845 case DW_OP_mod:
2846 return "DW_OP_mod";
2847 case DW_OP_mul:
2848 return "DW_OP_mul";
2849 case DW_OP_neg:
2850 return "DW_OP_neg";
2851 case DW_OP_not:
2852 return "DW_OP_not";
2853 case DW_OP_or:
2854 return "DW_OP_or";
2855 case DW_OP_plus:
2856 return "DW_OP_plus";
2857 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
2858 return "DW_OP_plus_uconst";
2859 case DW_OP_shl:
2860 return "DW_OP_shl";
2861 case DW_OP_shr:
2862 return "DW_OP_shr";
2863 case DW_OP_shra:
2864 return "DW_OP_shra";
2865 case DW_OP_xor:
2866 return "DW_OP_xor";
2867 case DW_OP_bra:
2868 return "DW_OP_bra";
2869 case DW_OP_eq:
2870 return "DW_OP_eq";
2871 case DW_OP_ge:
2872 return "DW_OP_ge";
2873 case DW_OP_gt:
2874 return "DW_OP_gt";
2875 case DW_OP_le:
2876 return "DW_OP_le";
2877 case DW_OP_lt:
2878 return "DW_OP_lt";
2879 case DW_OP_ne:
2880 return "DW_OP_ne";
2881 case DW_OP_skip:
2882 return "DW_OP_skip";
2883 case DW_OP_lit0:
2884 return "DW_OP_lit0";
2885 case DW_OP_lit1:
2886 return "DW_OP_lit1";
2887 case DW_OP_lit2:
2888 return "DW_OP_lit2";
2889 case DW_OP_lit3:
2890 return "DW_OP_lit3";
2891 case DW_OP_lit4:
2892 return "DW_OP_lit4";
2893 case DW_OP_lit5:
2894 return "DW_OP_lit5";
2895 case DW_OP_lit6:
2896 return "DW_OP_lit6";
2897 case DW_OP_lit7:
2898 return "DW_OP_lit7";
2899 case DW_OP_lit8:
2900 return "DW_OP_lit8";
2901 case DW_OP_lit9:
2902 return "DW_OP_lit9";
2903 case DW_OP_lit10:
2904 return "DW_OP_lit10";
2905 case DW_OP_lit11:
2906 return "DW_OP_lit11";
2907 case DW_OP_lit12:
2908 return "DW_OP_lit12";
2909 case DW_OP_lit13:
2910 return "DW_OP_lit13";
2911 case DW_OP_lit14:
2912 return "DW_OP_lit14";
2913 case DW_OP_lit15:
2914 return "DW_OP_lit15";
2915 case DW_OP_lit16:
2916 return "DW_OP_lit16";
2917 case DW_OP_lit17:
2918 return "DW_OP_lit17";
2919 case DW_OP_lit18:
2920 return "DW_OP_lit18";
2921 case DW_OP_lit19:
2922 return "DW_OP_lit19";
2923 case DW_OP_lit20:
2924 return "DW_OP_lit20";
2925 case DW_OP_lit21:
2926 return "DW_OP_lit21";
2927 case DW_OP_lit22:
2928 return "DW_OP_lit22";
2929 case DW_OP_lit23:
2930 return "DW_OP_lit23";
2931 case DW_OP_lit24:
2932 return "DW_OP_lit24";
2933 case DW_OP_lit25:
2934 return "DW_OP_lit25";
2935 case DW_OP_lit26:
2936 return "DW_OP_lit26";
2937 case DW_OP_lit27:
2938 return "DW_OP_lit27";
2939 case DW_OP_lit28:
2940 return "DW_OP_lit28";
2941 case DW_OP_lit29:
2942 return "DW_OP_lit29";
2943 case DW_OP_lit30:
2944 return "DW_OP_lit30";
2945 case DW_OP_lit31:
2946 return "DW_OP_lit31";
2947 case DW_OP_reg0:
2948 return "DW_OP_reg0";
2949 case DW_OP_reg1:
2950 return "DW_OP_reg1";
2951 case DW_OP_reg2:
2952 return "DW_OP_reg2";
2953 case DW_OP_reg3:
2954 return "DW_OP_reg3";
2955 case DW_OP_reg4:
2956 return "DW_OP_reg4";
2957 case DW_OP_reg5:
2958 return "DW_OP_reg5";
2959 case DW_OP_reg6:
2960 return "DW_OP_reg6";
2961 case DW_OP_reg7:
2962 return "DW_OP_reg7";
2963 case DW_OP_reg8:
2964 return "DW_OP_reg8";
2965 case DW_OP_reg9:
2966 return "DW_OP_reg9";
2967 case DW_OP_reg10:
2968 return "DW_OP_reg10";
2969 case DW_OP_reg11:
2970 return "DW_OP_reg11";
2971 case DW_OP_reg12:
2972 return "DW_OP_reg12";
2973 case DW_OP_reg13:
2974 return "DW_OP_reg13";
2975 case DW_OP_reg14:
2976 return "DW_OP_reg14";
2977 case DW_OP_reg15:
2978 return "DW_OP_reg15";
2979 case DW_OP_reg16:
2980 return "DW_OP_reg16";
2981 case DW_OP_reg17:
2982 return "DW_OP_reg17";
2983 case DW_OP_reg18:
2984 return "DW_OP_reg18";
2985 case DW_OP_reg19:
2986 return "DW_OP_reg19";
2987 case DW_OP_reg20:
2988 return "DW_OP_reg20";
2989 case DW_OP_reg21:
2990 return "DW_OP_reg21";
2991 case DW_OP_reg22:
2992 return "DW_OP_reg22";
2993 case DW_OP_reg23:
2994 return "DW_OP_reg23";
2995 case DW_OP_reg24:
2996 return "DW_OP_reg24";
2997 case DW_OP_reg25:
2998 return "DW_OP_reg25";
2999 case DW_OP_reg26:
3000 return "DW_OP_reg26";
3001 case DW_OP_reg27:
3002 return "DW_OP_reg27";
3003 case DW_OP_reg28:
3004 return "DW_OP_reg28";
3005 case DW_OP_reg29:
3006 return "DW_OP_reg29";
3007 case DW_OP_reg30:
3008 return "DW_OP_reg30";
3009 case DW_OP_reg31:
3010 return "DW_OP_reg31";
3011 case DW_OP_breg0:
3012 return "DW_OP_breg0";
3013 case DW_OP_breg1:
3014 return "DW_OP_breg1";
3015 case DW_OP_breg2:
3016 return "DW_OP_breg2";
3017 case DW_OP_breg3:
3018 return "DW_OP_breg3";
3019 case DW_OP_breg4:
3020 return "DW_OP_breg4";
3021 case DW_OP_breg5:
3022 return "DW_OP_breg5";
3023 case DW_OP_breg6:
3024 return "DW_OP_breg6";
3025 case DW_OP_breg7:
3026 return "DW_OP_breg7";
3027 case DW_OP_breg8:
3028 return "DW_OP_breg8";
3029 case DW_OP_breg9:
3030 return "DW_OP_breg9";
3031 case DW_OP_breg10:
3032 return "DW_OP_breg10";
3033 case DW_OP_breg11:
3034 return "DW_OP_breg11";
3035 case DW_OP_breg12:
3036 return "DW_OP_breg12";
3037 case DW_OP_breg13:
3038 return "DW_OP_breg13";
3039 case DW_OP_breg14:
3040 return "DW_OP_breg14";
3041 case DW_OP_breg15:
3042 return "DW_OP_breg15";
3043 case DW_OP_breg16:
3044 return "DW_OP_breg16";
3045 case DW_OP_breg17:
3046 return "DW_OP_breg17";
3047 case DW_OP_breg18:
3048 return "DW_OP_breg18";
3049 case DW_OP_breg19:
3050 return "DW_OP_breg19";
3051 case DW_OP_breg20:
3052 return "DW_OP_breg20";
3053 case DW_OP_breg21:
3054 return "DW_OP_breg21";
3055 case DW_OP_breg22:
3056 return "DW_OP_breg22";
3057 case DW_OP_breg23:
3058 return "DW_OP_breg23";
3059 case DW_OP_breg24:
3060 return "DW_OP_breg24";
3061 case DW_OP_breg25:
3062 return "DW_OP_breg25";
3063 case DW_OP_breg26:
3064 return "DW_OP_breg26";
3065 case DW_OP_breg27:
3066 return "DW_OP_breg27";
3067 case DW_OP_breg28:
3068 return "DW_OP_breg28";
3069 case DW_OP_breg29:
3070 return "DW_OP_breg29";
3071 case DW_OP_breg30:
3072 return "DW_OP_breg30";
3073 case DW_OP_breg31:
3074 return "DW_OP_breg31";
3075 case DW_OP_regx:
3076 return "DW_OP_regx";
3077 case DW_OP_fbreg:
3078 return "DW_OP_fbreg";
3079 case DW_OP_bregx:
3080 return "DW_OP_bregx";
3081 case DW_OP_piece:
3082 return "DW_OP_piece";
3083 case DW_OP_deref_size:
3084 return "DW_OP_deref_size";
3085 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
3086 return "DW_OP_xderef_size";
3087 case DW_OP_nop:
3088 return "DW_OP_nop";
3089 case DW_OP_push_object_address:
3090 return "DW_OP_push_object_address";
3091 case DW_OP_call2:
3092 return "DW_OP_call2";
3093 case DW_OP_call4:
3094 return "DW_OP_call4";
3095 case DW_OP_call_ref:
3096 return "DW_OP_call_ref";
3097 case DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address:
3098 return "DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address";
3099 default:
3100 return "OP_<unknown>";
3101 }
3102 }
3103
3104 /* Return a pointer to a newly allocated location description. Location
3105 descriptions are simple expression terms that can be strung
3106 together to form more complicated location (address) descriptions. */
3107
3108 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
new_loc_descr(enum dwarf_location_atom op,unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT oprnd1,unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT oprnd2)3109 new_loc_descr (enum dwarf_location_atom op, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT oprnd1,
3110 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT oprnd2)
3111 {
3112 dw_loc_descr_ref descr = ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (dw_loc_descr_node));
3113
3114 descr->dw_loc_opc = op;
3115 descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const;
3116 descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned = oprnd1;
3117 descr->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const;
3118 descr->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_unsigned = oprnd2;
3119
3120 return descr;
3121 }
3122
3123 /* Add a location description term to a location description expression. */
3124
3125 static inline void
add_loc_descr(dw_loc_descr_ref * list_head,dw_loc_descr_ref descr)3126 add_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref *list_head, dw_loc_descr_ref descr)
3127 {
3128 dw_loc_descr_ref *d;
3129
3130 /* Find the end of the chain. */
3131 for (d = list_head; (*d) != NULL; d = &(*d)->dw_loc_next)
3132 ;
3133
3134 *d = descr;
3135 }
3136
3137 /* Return the size of a location descriptor. */
3138
3139 static unsigned long
size_of_loc_descr(dw_loc_descr_ref loc)3140 size_of_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
3141 {
3142 unsigned long size = 1;
3143
3144 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
3145 {
3146 case DW_OP_addr:
3147 case INTERNAL_DW_OP_tls_addr:
3148 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
3149 break;
3150 case DW_OP_const1u:
3151 case DW_OP_const1s:
3152 size += 1;
3153 break;
3154 case DW_OP_const2u:
3155 case DW_OP_const2s:
3156 size += 2;
3157 break;
3158 case DW_OP_const4u:
3159 case DW_OP_const4s:
3160 size += 4;
3161 break;
3162 case DW_OP_const8u:
3163 case DW_OP_const8s:
3164 size += 8;
3165 break;
3166 case DW_OP_constu:
3167 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
3168 break;
3169 case DW_OP_consts:
3170 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int);
3171 break;
3172 case DW_OP_pick:
3173 size += 1;
3174 break;
3175 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
3176 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
3177 break;
3178 case DW_OP_skip:
3179 case DW_OP_bra:
3180 size += 2;
3181 break;
3182 case DW_OP_breg0:
3183 case DW_OP_breg1:
3184 case DW_OP_breg2:
3185 case DW_OP_breg3:
3186 case DW_OP_breg4:
3187 case DW_OP_breg5:
3188 case DW_OP_breg6:
3189 case DW_OP_breg7:
3190 case DW_OP_breg8:
3191 case DW_OP_breg9:
3192 case DW_OP_breg10:
3193 case DW_OP_breg11:
3194 case DW_OP_breg12:
3195 case DW_OP_breg13:
3196 case DW_OP_breg14:
3197 case DW_OP_breg15:
3198 case DW_OP_breg16:
3199 case DW_OP_breg17:
3200 case DW_OP_breg18:
3201 case DW_OP_breg19:
3202 case DW_OP_breg20:
3203 case DW_OP_breg21:
3204 case DW_OP_breg22:
3205 case DW_OP_breg23:
3206 case DW_OP_breg24:
3207 case DW_OP_breg25:
3208 case DW_OP_breg26:
3209 case DW_OP_breg27:
3210 case DW_OP_breg28:
3211 case DW_OP_breg29:
3212 case DW_OP_breg30:
3213 case DW_OP_breg31:
3214 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int);
3215 break;
3216 case DW_OP_regx:
3217 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
3218 break;
3219 case DW_OP_fbreg:
3220 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int);
3221 break;
3222 case DW_OP_bregx:
3223 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
3224 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int);
3225 break;
3226 case DW_OP_piece:
3227 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
3228 break;
3229 case DW_OP_deref_size:
3230 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
3231 size += 1;
3232 break;
3233 case DW_OP_call2:
3234 size += 2;
3235 break;
3236 case DW_OP_call4:
3237 size += 4;
3238 break;
3239 case DW_OP_call_ref:
3240 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
3241 break;
3242 default:
3243 break;
3244 }
3245
3246 return size;
3247 }
3248
3249 /* Return the size of a series of location descriptors. */
3250
3251 static unsigned long
size_of_locs(dw_loc_descr_ref loc)3252 size_of_locs (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
3253 {
3254 dw_loc_descr_ref l;
3255 unsigned long size;
3256
3257 /* If there are no skip or bra opcodes, don't fill in the dw_loc_addr
3258 field, to avoid writing to a PCH file. */
3259 for (size = 0, l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->dw_loc_next)
3260 {
3261 if (l->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_skip || l->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_bra)
3262 break;
3263 size += size_of_loc_descr (l);
3264 }
3265 if (! l)
3266 return size;
3267
3268 for (size = 0, l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->dw_loc_next)
3269 {
3270 l->dw_loc_addr = size;
3271 size += size_of_loc_descr (l);
3272 }
3273
3274 return size;
3275 }
3276
3277 /* Output location description stack opcode's operands (if any). */
3278
3279 static void
output_loc_operands(dw_loc_descr_ref loc)3280 output_loc_operands (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
3281 {
3282 dw_val_ref val1 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd1;
3283 dw_val_ref val2 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd2;
3284
3285 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
3286 {
3287 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
3288 case DW_OP_addr:
3289 dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, val1->v.val_addr, NULL);
3290 break;
3291 case DW_OP_const2u:
3292 case DW_OP_const2s:
3293 dw2_asm_output_data (2, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3294 break;
3295 case DW_OP_const4u:
3296 case DW_OP_const4s:
3297 dw2_asm_output_data (4, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3298 break;
3299 case DW_OP_const8u:
3300 case DW_OP_const8s:
3301 gcc_assert (HOST_BITS_PER_LONG >= 64);
3302 dw2_asm_output_data (8, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3303 break;
3304 case DW_OP_skip:
3305 case DW_OP_bra:
3306 {
3307 int offset;
3308
3309 gcc_assert (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_loc);
3310 offset = val1->v.val_loc->dw_loc_addr - (loc->dw_loc_addr + 3);
3311
3312 dw2_asm_output_data (2, offset, NULL);
3313 }
3314 break;
3315 #else
3316 case DW_OP_addr:
3317 case DW_OP_const2u:
3318 case DW_OP_const2s:
3319 case DW_OP_const4u:
3320 case DW_OP_const4s:
3321 case DW_OP_const8u:
3322 case DW_OP_const8s:
3323 case DW_OP_skip:
3324 case DW_OP_bra:
3325 /* We currently don't make any attempt to make sure these are
3326 aligned properly like we do for the main unwind info, so
3327 don't support emitting things larger than a byte if we're
3328 only doing unwinding. */
3329 gcc_unreachable ();
3330 #endif
3331 case DW_OP_const1u:
3332 case DW_OP_const1s:
3333 dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3334 break;
3335 case DW_OP_constu:
3336 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
3337 break;
3338 case DW_OP_consts:
3339 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3340 break;
3341 case DW_OP_pick:
3342 dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3343 break;
3344 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
3345 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
3346 break;
3347 case DW_OP_breg0:
3348 case DW_OP_breg1:
3349 case DW_OP_breg2:
3350 case DW_OP_breg3:
3351 case DW_OP_breg4:
3352 case DW_OP_breg5:
3353 case DW_OP_breg6:
3354 case DW_OP_breg7:
3355 case DW_OP_breg8:
3356 case DW_OP_breg9:
3357 case DW_OP_breg10:
3358 case DW_OP_breg11:
3359 case DW_OP_breg12:
3360 case DW_OP_breg13:
3361 case DW_OP_breg14:
3362 case DW_OP_breg15:
3363 case DW_OP_breg16:
3364 case DW_OP_breg17:
3365 case DW_OP_breg18:
3366 case DW_OP_breg19:
3367 case DW_OP_breg20:
3368 case DW_OP_breg21:
3369 case DW_OP_breg22:
3370 case DW_OP_breg23:
3371 case DW_OP_breg24:
3372 case DW_OP_breg25:
3373 case DW_OP_breg26:
3374 case DW_OP_breg27:
3375 case DW_OP_breg28:
3376 case DW_OP_breg29:
3377 case DW_OP_breg30:
3378 case DW_OP_breg31:
3379 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3380 break;
3381 case DW_OP_regx:
3382 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
3383 break;
3384 case DW_OP_fbreg:
3385 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3386 break;
3387 case DW_OP_bregx:
3388 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
3389 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val2->v.val_int, NULL);
3390 break;
3391 case DW_OP_piece:
3392 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
3393 break;
3394 case DW_OP_deref_size:
3395 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
3396 dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3397 break;
3398
3399 case INTERNAL_DW_OP_tls_addr:
3400 if (targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel)
3401 {
3402 targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel (asm_out_file,
3403 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
3404 val1->v.val_addr);
3405 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
3406 }
3407 else
3408 gcc_unreachable ();
3409 break;
3410
3411 default:
3412 /* Other codes have no operands. */
3413 break;
3414 }
3415 }
3416
3417 /* Output a sequence of location operations. */
3418
3419 static void
output_loc_sequence(dw_loc_descr_ref loc)3420 output_loc_sequence (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
3421 {
3422 for (; loc != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
3423 {
3424 /* Output the opcode. */
3425 dw2_asm_output_data (1, loc->dw_loc_opc,
3426 "%s", dwarf_stack_op_name (loc->dw_loc_opc));
3427
3428 /* Output the operand(s) (if any). */
3429 output_loc_operands (loc);
3430 }
3431 }
3432
3433 /* This routine will generate the correct assembly data for a location
3434 description based on a cfi entry with a complex address. */
3435
3436 static void
output_cfa_loc(dw_cfi_ref cfi)3437 output_cfa_loc (dw_cfi_ref cfi)
3438 {
3439 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
3440 unsigned long size;
3441
3442 /* Output the size of the block. */
3443 loc = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_loc;
3444 size = size_of_locs (loc);
3445 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (size, NULL);
3446
3447 /* Now output the operations themselves. */
3448 output_loc_sequence (loc);
3449 }
3450
3451 /* This function builds a dwarf location descriptor sequence from a
3452 dw_cfa_location, adding the given OFFSET to the result of the
3453 expression. */
3454
3455 static struct dw_loc_descr_struct *
build_cfa_loc(dw_cfa_location * cfa,HOST_WIDE_INT offset)3456 build_cfa_loc (dw_cfa_location *cfa, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
3457 {
3458 struct dw_loc_descr_struct *head, *tmp;
3459
3460 offset += cfa->offset;
3461
3462 if (cfa->indirect)
3463 {
3464 if (cfa->base_offset)
3465 {
3466 if (cfa->reg <= 31)
3467 head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_breg0 + cfa->reg, cfa->base_offset, 0);
3468 else
3469 head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bregx, cfa->reg, cfa->base_offset);
3470 }
3471 else if (cfa->reg <= 31)
3472 head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_reg0 + cfa->reg, 0, 0);
3473 else
3474 head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_regx, cfa->reg, 0);
3475
3476 head->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
3477 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
3478 add_loc_descr (&head, tmp);
3479 if (offset != 0)
3480 {
3481 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, offset, 0);
3482 add_loc_descr (&head, tmp);
3483 }
3484 }
3485 else
3486 {
3487 if (offset == 0)
3488 if (cfa->reg <= 31)
3489 head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_reg0 + cfa->reg, 0, 0);
3490 else
3491 head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_regx, cfa->reg, 0);
3492 else if (cfa->reg <= 31)
3493 head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_breg0 + cfa->reg, offset, 0);
3494 else
3495 head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bregx, cfa->reg, offset);
3496 }
3497
3498 return head;
3499 }
3500
3501 /* This function fills in aa dw_cfa_location structure from a dwarf location
3502 descriptor sequence. */
3503
3504 static void
get_cfa_from_loc_descr(dw_cfa_location * cfa,struct dw_loc_descr_struct * loc)3505 get_cfa_from_loc_descr (dw_cfa_location *cfa, struct dw_loc_descr_struct *loc)
3506 {
3507 struct dw_loc_descr_struct *ptr;
3508 cfa->offset = 0;
3509 cfa->base_offset = 0;
3510 cfa->indirect = 0;
3511 cfa->reg = -1;
3512
3513 for (ptr = loc; ptr != NULL; ptr = ptr->dw_loc_next)
3514 {
3515 enum dwarf_location_atom op = ptr->dw_loc_opc;
3516
3517 switch (op)
3518 {
3519 case DW_OP_reg0:
3520 case DW_OP_reg1:
3521 case DW_OP_reg2:
3522 case DW_OP_reg3:
3523 case DW_OP_reg4:
3524 case DW_OP_reg5:
3525 case DW_OP_reg6:
3526 case DW_OP_reg7:
3527 case DW_OP_reg8:
3528 case DW_OP_reg9:
3529 case DW_OP_reg10:
3530 case DW_OP_reg11:
3531 case DW_OP_reg12:
3532 case DW_OP_reg13:
3533 case DW_OP_reg14:
3534 case DW_OP_reg15:
3535 case DW_OP_reg16:
3536 case DW_OP_reg17:
3537 case DW_OP_reg18:
3538 case DW_OP_reg19:
3539 case DW_OP_reg20:
3540 case DW_OP_reg21:
3541 case DW_OP_reg22:
3542 case DW_OP_reg23:
3543 case DW_OP_reg24:
3544 case DW_OP_reg25:
3545 case DW_OP_reg26:
3546 case DW_OP_reg27:
3547 case DW_OP_reg28:
3548 case DW_OP_reg29:
3549 case DW_OP_reg30:
3550 case DW_OP_reg31:
3551 cfa->reg = op - DW_OP_reg0;
3552 break;
3553 case DW_OP_regx:
3554 cfa->reg = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int;
3555 break;
3556 case DW_OP_breg0:
3557 case DW_OP_breg1:
3558 case DW_OP_breg2:
3559 case DW_OP_breg3:
3560 case DW_OP_breg4:
3561 case DW_OP_breg5:
3562 case DW_OP_breg6:
3563 case DW_OP_breg7:
3564 case DW_OP_breg8:
3565 case DW_OP_breg9:
3566 case DW_OP_breg10:
3567 case DW_OP_breg11:
3568 case DW_OP_breg12:
3569 case DW_OP_breg13:
3570 case DW_OP_breg14:
3571 case DW_OP_breg15:
3572 case DW_OP_breg16:
3573 case DW_OP_breg17:
3574 case DW_OP_breg18:
3575 case DW_OP_breg19:
3576 case DW_OP_breg20:
3577 case DW_OP_breg21:
3578 case DW_OP_breg22:
3579 case DW_OP_breg23:
3580 case DW_OP_breg24:
3581 case DW_OP_breg25:
3582 case DW_OP_breg26:
3583 case DW_OP_breg27:
3584 case DW_OP_breg28:
3585 case DW_OP_breg29:
3586 case DW_OP_breg30:
3587 case DW_OP_breg31:
3588 cfa->reg = op - DW_OP_breg0;
3589 cfa->base_offset = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int;
3590 break;
3591 case DW_OP_bregx:
3592 cfa->reg = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int;
3593 cfa->base_offset = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int;
3594 break;
3595 case DW_OP_deref:
3596 cfa->indirect = 1;
3597 break;
3598 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
3599 cfa->offset = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned;
3600 break;
3601 default:
3602 internal_error ("DW_LOC_OP %s not implemented",
3603 dwarf_stack_op_name (ptr->dw_loc_opc));
3604 }
3605 }
3606 }
3607 #endif /* .debug_frame support */
3608
3609 /* And now, the support for symbolic debugging information. */
3610 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
3611
3612 /* .debug_str support. */
3613 static int output_indirect_string (void **, void *);
3614
3615 static void dwarf2out_init (const char *);
3616 static void dwarf2out_finish (const char *);
3617 static void dwarf2out_define (unsigned int, const char *);
3618 static void dwarf2out_undef (unsigned int, const char *);
3619 static void dwarf2out_start_source_file (unsigned, const char *);
3620 static void dwarf2out_end_source_file (unsigned);
3621 static void dwarf2out_begin_block (unsigned, unsigned);
3622 static void dwarf2out_end_block (unsigned, unsigned);
3623 static bool dwarf2out_ignore_block (tree);
3624 static void dwarf2out_global_decl (tree);
3625 static void dwarf2out_type_decl (tree, int);
3626 static void dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl (tree, tree);
3627 static void dwarf2out_abstract_function (tree);
3628 static void dwarf2out_var_location (rtx);
3629 static void dwarf2out_begin_function (tree);
3630 static void dwarf2out_switch_text_section (void);
3631
3632 /* The debug hooks structure. */
3633
3634 const struct gcc_debug_hooks dwarf2_debug_hooks =
3635 {
3636 dwarf2out_init,
3637 dwarf2out_finish,
3638 dwarf2out_define,
3639 dwarf2out_undef,
3640 dwarf2out_start_source_file,
3641 dwarf2out_end_source_file,
3642 dwarf2out_begin_block,
3643 dwarf2out_end_block,
3644 dwarf2out_ignore_block,
3645 dwarf2out_source_line,
3646 dwarf2out_begin_prologue,
3647 debug_nothing_int_charstar, /* end_prologue */
3648 dwarf2out_end_epilogue,
3649 dwarf2out_begin_function,
3650 debug_nothing_int, /* end_function */
3651 dwarf2out_decl, /* function_decl */
3652 dwarf2out_global_decl,
3653 dwarf2out_type_decl, /* type_decl */
3654 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl,
3655 debug_nothing_tree, /* deferred_inline_function */
3656 /* The DWARF 2 backend tries to reduce debugging bloat by not
3657 emitting the abstract description of inline functions until
3658 something tries to reference them. */
3659 dwarf2out_abstract_function, /* outlining_inline_function */
3660 debug_nothing_rtx, /* label */
3661 debug_nothing_int, /* handle_pch */
3662 dwarf2out_var_location,
3663 dwarf2out_switch_text_section,
3664 1 /* start_end_main_source_file */
3665 };
3666 #endif
3667
3668 /* NOTE: In the comments in this file, many references are made to
3669 "Debugging Information Entries". This term is abbreviated as `DIE'
3670 throughout the remainder of this file. */
3671
3672 /* An internal representation of the DWARF output is built, and then
3673 walked to generate the DWARF debugging info. The walk of the internal
3674 representation is done after the entire program has been compiled.
3675 The types below are used to describe the internal representation. */
3676
3677 /* Various DIE's use offsets relative to the beginning of the
3678 .debug_info section to refer to each other. */
3679
3680 typedef long int dw_offset;
3681
3682 /* Define typedefs here to avoid circular dependencies. */
3683
3684 typedef struct dw_attr_struct *dw_attr_ref;
3685 typedef struct dw_line_info_struct *dw_line_info_ref;
3686 typedef struct dw_separate_line_info_struct *dw_separate_line_info_ref;
3687 typedef struct pubname_struct *pubname_ref;
3688 typedef struct dw_ranges_struct *dw_ranges_ref;
3689
3690 /* Each entry in the line_info_table maintains the file and
3691 line number associated with the label generated for that
3692 entry. The label gives the PC value associated with
3693 the line number entry. */
3694
3695 typedef struct dw_line_info_struct GTY(())
3696 {
3697 unsigned long dw_file_num;
3698 unsigned long dw_line_num;
3699 }
3700 dw_line_info_entry;
3701
3702 /* Line information for functions in separate sections; each one gets its
3703 own sequence. */
3704 typedef struct dw_separate_line_info_struct GTY(())
3705 {
3706 unsigned long dw_file_num;
3707 unsigned long dw_line_num;
3708 unsigned long function;
3709 }
3710 dw_separate_line_info_entry;
3711
3712 /* Each DIE attribute has a field specifying the attribute kind,
3713 a link to the next attribute in the chain, and an attribute value.
3714 Attributes are typically linked below the DIE they modify. */
3715
3716 typedef struct dw_attr_struct GTY(())
3717 {
3718 enum dwarf_attribute dw_attr;
3719 dw_val_node dw_attr_val;
3720 }
3721 dw_attr_node;
3722
3723 DEF_VEC_O(dw_attr_node);
3724 DEF_VEC_ALLOC_O(dw_attr_node,gc);
3725
3726 /* The Debugging Information Entry (DIE) structure. DIEs form a tree.
3727 The children of each node form a circular list linked by
3728 die_sib. die_child points to the node *before* the "first" child node. */
3729
3730 typedef struct die_struct GTY(())
3731 {
3732 enum dwarf_tag die_tag;
3733 char *die_symbol;
3734 VEC(dw_attr_node,gc) * die_attr;
3735 dw_die_ref die_parent;
3736 dw_die_ref die_child;
3737 dw_die_ref die_sib;
3738 dw_die_ref die_definition; /* ref from a specification to its definition */
3739 dw_offset die_offset;
3740 unsigned long die_abbrev;
3741 int die_mark;
3742 /* Die is used and must not be pruned as unused. */
3743 int die_perennial_p;
3744 unsigned int decl_id;
3745 }
3746 die_node;
3747
3748 /* Evaluate 'expr' while 'c' is set to each child of DIE in order. */
3749 #define FOR_EACH_CHILD(die, c, expr) do { \
3750 c = die->die_child; \
3751 if (c) do { \
3752 c = c->die_sib; \
3753 expr; \
3754 } while (c != die->die_child); \
3755 } while (0)
3756
3757 /* The pubname structure */
3758
3759 typedef struct pubname_struct GTY(())
3760 {
3761 dw_die_ref die;
3762 char *name;
3763 }
3764 pubname_entry;
3765
3766 DEF_VEC_O(pubname_entry);
3767 DEF_VEC_ALLOC_O(pubname_entry, gc);
3768
3769 struct dw_ranges_struct GTY(())
3770 {
3771 int block_num;
3772 };
3773
3774 /* The limbo die list structure. */
3775 typedef struct limbo_die_struct GTY(())
3776 {
3777 dw_die_ref die;
3778 tree created_for;
3779 struct limbo_die_struct *next;
3780 }
3781 limbo_die_node;
3782
3783 /* How to start an assembler comment. */
3784 #ifndef ASM_COMMENT_START
3785 #define ASM_COMMENT_START ";#"
3786 #endif
3787
3788 /* Define a macro which returns nonzero for a TYPE_DECL which was
3789 implicitly generated for a tagged type.
3790
3791 Note that unlike the gcc front end (which generates a NULL named
3792 TYPE_DECL node for each complete tagged type, each array type, and
3793 each function type node created) the g++ front end generates a
3794 _named_ TYPE_DECL node for each tagged type node created.
3795 These TYPE_DECLs have DECL_ARTIFICIAL set, so we know not to
3796 generate a DW_TAG_typedef DIE for them. */
3797
3798 #define TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB(decl) \
3799 (DECL_NAME (decl) == NULL_TREE \
3800 || (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl) \
3801 && is_tagged_type (TREE_TYPE (decl)) \
3802 && ((decl == TYPE_STUB_DECL (TREE_TYPE (decl))) \
3803 /* This is necessary for stub decls that \
3804 appear in nested inline functions. */ \
3805 || (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) != NULL_TREE \
3806 && (decl_ultimate_origin (decl) \
3807 == TYPE_STUB_DECL (TREE_TYPE (decl)))))))
3808
3809 /* Information concerning the compilation unit's programming
3810 language, and compiler version. */
3811
3812 /* Fixed size portion of the DWARF compilation unit header. */
3813 #define DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE \
3814 (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 3)
3815
3816 /* Fixed size portion of public names info. */
3817 #define DWARF_PUBNAMES_HEADER_SIZE (2 * DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 2)
3818
3819 /* Fixed size portion of the address range info. */
3820 #define DWARF_ARANGES_HEADER_SIZE \
3821 (DWARF_ROUND (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4, \
3822 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * 2) \
3823 - DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE)
3824
3825 /* Size of padding portion in the address range info. It must be
3826 aligned to twice the pointer size. */
3827 #define DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE \
3828 (DWARF_ROUND (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4, \
3829 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * 2) \
3830 - (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4))
3831
3832 /* Use assembler line directives if available. */
3833 #ifndef DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
3834 #ifdef HAVE_AS_DWARF2_DEBUG_LINE
3835 #define DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO 1
3836 #else
3837 #define DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO 0
3838 #endif
3839 #endif
3840
3841 /* Minimum line offset in a special line info. opcode.
3842 This value was chosen to give a reasonable range of values. */
3843 #define DWARF_LINE_BASE -10
3844
3845 /* First special line opcode - leave room for the standard opcodes. */
3846 #define DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE 10
3847
3848 /* Range of line offsets in a special line info. opcode. */
3849 #define DWARF_LINE_RANGE (254-DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE+1)
3850
3851 /* Flag that indicates the initial value of the is_stmt_start flag.
3852 In the present implementation, we do not mark any lines as
3853 the beginning of a source statement, because that information
3854 is not made available by the GCC front-end. */
3855 #define DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START 1
3856
3857 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
3858 /* This location is used by calc_die_sizes() to keep track
3859 the offset of each DIE within the .debug_info section. */
3860 static unsigned long next_die_offset;
3861 #endif
3862
3863 /* Record the root of the DIE's built for the current compilation unit. */
3864 static GTY(()) dw_die_ref comp_unit_die;
3865
3866 /* A list of DIEs with a NULL parent waiting to be relocated. */
3867 static GTY(()) limbo_die_node *limbo_die_list;
3868
3869 /* Filenames referenced by this compilation unit. */
3870 static GTY((param_is (struct dwarf_file_data))) htab_t file_table;
3871
3872 /* A hash table of references to DIE's that describe declarations.
3873 The key is a DECL_UID() which is a unique number identifying each decl. */
3874 static GTY ((param_is (struct die_struct))) htab_t decl_die_table;
3875
3876 /* Node of the variable location list. */
3877 struct var_loc_node GTY ((chain_next ("%h.next")))
3878 {
3879 rtx GTY (()) var_loc_note;
3880 const char * GTY (()) label;
3881 const char * GTY (()) section_label;
3882 struct var_loc_node * GTY (()) next;
3883 };
3884
3885 /* Variable location list. */
3886 struct var_loc_list_def GTY (())
3887 {
3888 struct var_loc_node * GTY (()) first;
3889
3890 /* Do not mark the last element of the chained list because
3891 it is marked through the chain. */
3892 struct var_loc_node * GTY ((skip ("%h"))) last;
3893
3894 /* DECL_UID of the variable decl. */
3895 unsigned int decl_id;
3896 };
3897 typedef struct var_loc_list_def var_loc_list;
3898
3899
3900 /* Table of decl location linked lists. */
3901 static GTY ((param_is (var_loc_list))) htab_t decl_loc_table;
3902
3903 /* A pointer to the base of a list of references to DIE's that
3904 are uniquely identified by their tag, presence/absence of
3905 children DIE's, and list of attribute/value pairs. */
3906 static GTY((length ("abbrev_die_table_allocated")))
3907 dw_die_ref *abbrev_die_table;
3908
3909 /* Number of elements currently allocated for abbrev_die_table. */
3910 static GTY(()) unsigned abbrev_die_table_allocated;
3911
3912 /* Number of elements in type_die_table currently in use. */
3913 static GTY(()) unsigned abbrev_die_table_in_use;
3914
3915 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
3916 abbrev_die_table. */
3917 #define ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT 256
3918
3919 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains line information
3920 for each source code line in .text in the compilation unit. */
3921 static GTY((length ("line_info_table_allocated")))
3922 dw_line_info_ref line_info_table;
3923
3924 /* Number of elements currently allocated for line_info_table. */
3925 static GTY(()) unsigned line_info_table_allocated;
3926
3927 /* Number of elements in line_info_table currently in use. */
3928 static GTY(()) unsigned line_info_table_in_use;
3929
3930 /* True if the compilation unit places functions in more than one section. */
3931 static GTY(()) bool have_multiple_function_sections = false;
3932
3933 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains line information
3934 for each source code line outside of .text in the compilation unit. */
3935 static GTY ((length ("separate_line_info_table_allocated")))
3936 dw_separate_line_info_ref separate_line_info_table;
3937
3938 /* Number of elements currently allocated for separate_line_info_table. */
3939 static GTY(()) unsigned separate_line_info_table_allocated;
3940
3941 /* Number of elements in separate_line_info_table currently in use. */
3942 static GTY(()) unsigned separate_line_info_table_in_use;
3943
3944 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
3945 line_info_table. */
3946 #define LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT 1024
3947
3948 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains a list of publicly
3949 accessible names. */
3950 static GTY (()) VEC (pubname_entry, gc) * pubname_table;
3951
3952 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains a list of publicly
3953 accessible types. */
3954 static GTY (()) VEC (pubname_entry, gc) * pubtype_table;
3955
3956 /* Array of dies for which we should generate .debug_arange info. */
3957 static GTY((length ("arange_table_allocated"))) dw_die_ref *arange_table;
3958
3959 /* Number of elements currently allocated for arange_table. */
3960 static GTY(()) unsigned arange_table_allocated;
3961
3962 /* Number of elements in arange_table currently in use. */
3963 static GTY(()) unsigned arange_table_in_use;
3964
3965 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
3966 arange_table. */
3967 #define ARANGE_TABLE_INCREMENT 64
3968
3969 /* Array of dies for which we should generate .debug_ranges info. */
3970 static GTY ((length ("ranges_table_allocated"))) dw_ranges_ref ranges_table;
3971
3972 /* Number of elements currently allocated for ranges_table. */
3973 static GTY(()) unsigned ranges_table_allocated;
3974
3975 /* Number of elements in ranges_table currently in use. */
3976 static GTY(()) unsigned ranges_table_in_use;
3977
3978 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
3979 ranges_table. */
3980 #define RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT 64
3981
3982 /* Whether we have location lists that need outputting */
3983 static GTY(()) bool have_location_lists;
3984
3985 /* Unique label counter. */
3986 static GTY(()) unsigned int loclabel_num;
3987
3988 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
3989 /* Record whether the function being analyzed contains inlined functions. */
3990 static int current_function_has_inlines;
3991 #endif
3992 #if 0 && defined (MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO)
3993 static int comp_unit_has_inlines;
3994 #endif
3995
3996 /* The last file entry emitted by maybe_emit_file(). */
3997 static GTY(()) struct dwarf_file_data * last_emitted_file;
3998
3999 /* Number of internal labels generated by gen_internal_sym(). */
4000 static GTY(()) int label_num;
4001
4002 /* Cached result of previous call to lookup_filename. */
4003 static GTY(()) struct dwarf_file_data * file_table_last_lookup;
4004
4005 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
4006
4007 /* Offset from the "steady-state frame pointer" to the frame base,
4008 within the current function. */
4009 static HOST_WIDE_INT frame_pointer_fb_offset;
4010
4011 /* Forward declarations for functions defined in this file. */
4012
4013 static int is_pseudo_reg (rtx);
4014 static tree type_main_variant (tree);
4015 static int is_tagged_type (tree);
4016 static const char *dwarf_tag_name (unsigned);
4017 static const char *dwarf_attr_name (unsigned);
4018 static const char *dwarf_form_name (unsigned);
4019 static tree decl_ultimate_origin (tree);
4020 static tree block_ultimate_origin (tree);
4021 static tree decl_class_context (tree);
4022 static void add_dwarf_attr (dw_die_ref, dw_attr_ref);
4023 static inline enum dw_val_class AT_class (dw_attr_ref);
4024 static void add_AT_flag (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned);
4025 static inline unsigned AT_flag (dw_attr_ref);
4026 static void add_AT_int (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, HOST_WIDE_INT);
4027 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT AT_int (dw_attr_ref);
4028 static void add_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
4029 static inline unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT AT_unsigned (dw_attr_ref);
4030 static void add_AT_long_long (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned long,
4031 unsigned long);
4032 static inline void add_AT_vec (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned int,
4033 unsigned int, unsigned char *);
4034 static hashval_t debug_str_do_hash (const void *);
4035 static int debug_str_eq (const void *, const void *);
4036 static void add_AT_string (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
4037 static inline const char *AT_string (dw_attr_ref);
4038 static int AT_string_form (dw_attr_ref);
4039 static void add_AT_die_ref (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, dw_die_ref);
4040 static void add_AT_specification (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
4041 static inline dw_die_ref AT_ref (dw_attr_ref);
4042 static inline int AT_ref_external (dw_attr_ref);
4043 static inline void set_AT_ref_external (dw_attr_ref, int);
4044 static void add_AT_fde_ref (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned);
4045 static void add_AT_loc (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, dw_loc_descr_ref);
4046 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref AT_loc (dw_attr_ref);
4047 static void add_AT_loc_list (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
4048 dw_loc_list_ref);
4049 static inline dw_loc_list_ref AT_loc_list (dw_attr_ref);
4050 static void add_AT_addr (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, rtx);
4051 static inline rtx AT_addr (dw_attr_ref);
4052 static void add_AT_lbl_id (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
4053 static void add_AT_lineptr (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
4054 static void add_AT_macptr (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
4055 static void add_AT_offset (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
4056 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
4057 static void add_AT_range_list (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
4058 unsigned long);
4059 static inline const char *AT_lbl (dw_attr_ref);
4060 static dw_attr_ref get_AT (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
4061 static const char *get_AT_low_pc (dw_die_ref);
4062 static const char *get_AT_hi_pc (dw_die_ref);
4063 static const char *get_AT_string (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
4064 static int get_AT_flag (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
4065 static unsigned get_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
4066 static inline dw_die_ref get_AT_ref (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
4067 static bool is_c_family (void);
4068 static bool is_cxx (void);
4069 static bool is_java (void);
4070 static bool is_fortran (void);
4071 static bool is_ada (void);
4072 static void remove_AT (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
4073 static void remove_child_TAG (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_tag);
4074 static void add_child_die (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
4075 static dw_die_ref new_die (enum dwarf_tag, dw_die_ref, tree);
4076 static dw_die_ref lookup_type_die (tree);
4077 static void equate_type_number_to_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4078 static hashval_t decl_die_table_hash (const void *);
4079 static int decl_die_table_eq (const void *, const void *);
4080 static dw_die_ref lookup_decl_die (tree);
4081 static hashval_t decl_loc_table_hash (const void *);
4082 static int decl_loc_table_eq (const void *, const void *);
4083 static var_loc_list *lookup_decl_loc (tree);
4084 static void equate_decl_number_to_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4085 static void add_var_loc_to_decl (tree, struct var_loc_node *);
4086 static void print_spaces (FILE *);
4087 static void print_die (dw_die_ref, FILE *);
4088 static void print_dwarf_line_table (FILE *);
4089 static dw_die_ref push_new_compile_unit (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
4090 static dw_die_ref pop_compile_unit (dw_die_ref);
4091 static void loc_checksum (dw_loc_descr_ref, struct md5_ctx *);
4092 static void attr_checksum (dw_attr_ref, struct md5_ctx *, int *);
4093 static void die_checksum (dw_die_ref, struct md5_ctx *, int *);
4094 static int same_loc_p (dw_loc_descr_ref, dw_loc_descr_ref, int *);
4095 static int same_dw_val_p (dw_val_node *, dw_val_node *, int *);
4096 static int same_attr_p (dw_attr_ref, dw_attr_ref, int *);
4097 static int same_die_p (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref, int *);
4098 static int same_die_p_wrap (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
4099 static void compute_section_prefix (dw_die_ref);
4100 static int is_type_die (dw_die_ref);
4101 static int is_comdat_die (dw_die_ref);
4102 static int is_symbol_die (dw_die_ref);
4103 static void assign_symbol_names (dw_die_ref);
4104 static void break_out_includes (dw_die_ref);
4105 static hashval_t htab_cu_hash (const void *);
4106 static int htab_cu_eq (const void *, const void *);
4107 static void htab_cu_del (void *);
4108 static int check_duplicate_cu (dw_die_ref, htab_t, unsigned *);
4109 static void record_comdat_symbol_number (dw_die_ref, htab_t, unsigned);
4110 static void add_sibling_attributes (dw_die_ref);
4111 static void build_abbrev_table (dw_die_ref);
4112 static void output_location_lists (dw_die_ref);
4113 static int constant_size (long unsigned);
4114 static unsigned long size_of_die (dw_die_ref);
4115 static void calc_die_sizes (dw_die_ref);
4116 static void mark_dies (dw_die_ref);
4117 static void unmark_dies (dw_die_ref);
4118 static void unmark_all_dies (dw_die_ref);
4119 static unsigned long size_of_pubnames (VEC (pubname_entry,gc) *);
4120 static unsigned long size_of_aranges (void);
4121 static enum dwarf_form value_format (dw_attr_ref);
4122 static void output_value_format (dw_attr_ref);
4123 static void output_abbrev_section (void);
4124 static void output_die_symbol (dw_die_ref);
4125 static void output_die (dw_die_ref);
4126 static void output_compilation_unit_header (void);
4127 static void output_comp_unit (dw_die_ref, int);
4128 static const char *dwarf2_name (tree, int);
4129 static void add_pubname (tree, dw_die_ref);
4130 static void add_pubtype (tree, dw_die_ref);
4131 static void output_pubnames (VEC (pubname_entry,gc) *);
4132 static void add_arange (tree, dw_die_ref);
4133 static void output_aranges (void);
4134 static unsigned int add_ranges (tree);
4135 static void output_ranges (void);
4136 static void output_line_info (void);
4137 static void output_file_names (void);
4138 static dw_die_ref base_type_die (tree);
4139 static tree root_type (tree);
4140 static int is_base_type (tree);
4141 static bool is_subrange_type (tree);
4142 static dw_die_ref subrange_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4143 static dw_die_ref modified_type_die (tree, int, int, dw_die_ref);
4144 static int type_is_enum (tree);
4145 static unsigned int dbx_reg_number (rtx);
4146 static void add_loc_descr_op_piece (dw_loc_descr_ref *, int);
4147 static dw_loc_descr_ref reg_loc_descriptor (rtx);
4148 static dw_loc_descr_ref one_reg_loc_descriptor (unsigned int);
4149 static dw_loc_descr_ref multiple_reg_loc_descriptor (rtx, rtx);
4150 static dw_loc_descr_ref int_loc_descriptor (HOST_WIDE_INT);
4151 static dw_loc_descr_ref based_loc_descr (rtx, HOST_WIDE_INT);
4152 static int is_based_loc (rtx);
4153 static dw_loc_descr_ref mem_loc_descriptor (rtx, enum machine_mode mode);
4154 static dw_loc_descr_ref concat_loc_descriptor (rtx, rtx);
4155 static dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descriptor (rtx);
4156 static dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (tree, int);
4157 static dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descriptor_from_tree (tree);
4158 static HOST_WIDE_INT ceiling (HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned int);
4159 static tree field_type (tree);
4160 static unsigned int simple_type_align_in_bits (tree);
4161 static unsigned int simple_decl_align_in_bits (tree);
4162 static unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT simple_type_size_in_bits (tree);
4163 static HOST_WIDE_INT field_byte_offset (tree);
4164 static void add_AT_location_description (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
4165 dw_loc_descr_ref);
4166 static void add_data_member_location_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4167 static void add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref, rtx);
4168 static void insert_int (HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned, unsigned char *);
4169 static HOST_WIDE_INT extract_int (const unsigned char *, unsigned);
4170 static void insert_float (rtx, unsigned char *);
4171 static rtx rtl_for_decl_location (tree);
4172 static void add_location_or_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree,
4173 enum dwarf_attribute);
4174 static void tree_add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4175 static void add_name_attribute (dw_die_ref, const char *);
4176 static void add_comp_dir_attribute (dw_die_ref);
4177 static void add_bound_info (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, tree);
4178 static void add_subscript_info (dw_die_ref, tree);
4179 static void add_byte_size_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4180 static void add_bit_offset_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4181 static void add_bit_size_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4182 static void add_prototyped_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4183 static void add_abstract_origin_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4184 static void add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4185 static void add_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref, tree);
4186 static void add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref, tree);
4187 static void push_decl_scope (tree);
4188 static void pop_decl_scope (void);
4189 static dw_die_ref scope_die_for (tree, dw_die_ref);
4190 static inline int local_scope_p (dw_die_ref);
4191 static inline int class_or_namespace_scope_p (dw_die_ref);
4192 static void add_type_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree, int, int, dw_die_ref);
4193 static void add_calling_convention_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4194 static const char *type_tag (tree);
4195 static tree member_declared_type (tree);
4196 #if 0
4197 static const char *decl_start_label (tree);
4198 #endif
4199 static void gen_array_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4200 #if 0
4201 static void gen_entry_point_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4202 #endif
4203 static void gen_inlined_enumeration_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4204 static void gen_inlined_structure_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4205 static void gen_inlined_union_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4206 static dw_die_ref gen_enumeration_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4207 static dw_die_ref gen_formal_parameter_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4208 static void gen_unspecified_parameters_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4209 static void gen_formal_types_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4210 static void gen_subprogram_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4211 static void gen_variable_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4212 static void gen_label_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4213 static void gen_lexical_block_die (tree, dw_die_ref, int);
4214 static void gen_inlined_subroutine_die (tree, dw_die_ref, int);
4215 static void gen_field_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4216 static void gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4217 static dw_die_ref gen_compile_unit_die (const char *);
4218 static void gen_inheritance_die (tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
4219 static void gen_member_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4220 static void gen_struct_or_union_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref,
4221 enum debug_info_usage);
4222 static void gen_subroutine_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4223 static void gen_typedef_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4224 static void gen_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4225 static void gen_tagged_type_instantiation_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4226 static void gen_block_die (tree, dw_die_ref, int);
4227 static void decls_for_scope (tree, dw_die_ref, int);
4228 static int is_redundant_typedef (tree);
4229 static void gen_namespace_die (tree);
4230 static void gen_decl_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4231 static dw_die_ref force_decl_die (tree);
4232 static dw_die_ref force_type_die (tree);
4233 static dw_die_ref setup_namespace_context (tree, dw_die_ref);
4234 static void declare_in_namespace (tree, dw_die_ref);
4235 static struct dwarf_file_data * lookup_filename (const char *);
4236 static void retry_incomplete_types (void);
4237 static void gen_type_die_for_member (tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
4238 static void splice_child_die (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
4239 static int file_info_cmp (const void *, const void *);
4240 static dw_loc_list_ref new_loc_list (dw_loc_descr_ref, const char *,
4241 const char *, const char *, unsigned);
4242 static void add_loc_descr_to_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref *, dw_loc_descr_ref,
4243 const char *, const char *,
4244 const char *);
4245 static void output_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref);
4246 static char *gen_internal_sym (const char *);
4247
4248 static void prune_unmark_dies (dw_die_ref);
4249 static void prune_unused_types_mark (dw_die_ref, int);
4250 static void prune_unused_types_walk (dw_die_ref);
4251 static void prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (dw_die_ref);
4252 static void prune_unused_types_prune (dw_die_ref);
4253 static void prune_unused_types (void);
4254 static int maybe_emit_file (struct dwarf_file_data *fd);
4255
4256 /* Section names used to hold DWARF debugging information. */
4257 #ifndef DEBUG_INFO_SECTION
4258 #define DEBUG_INFO_SECTION ".debug_info"
4259 #endif
4260 #ifndef DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION
4261 #define DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION ".debug_abbrev"
4262 #endif
4263 #ifndef DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION
4264 #define DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION ".debug_aranges"
4265 #endif
4266 #ifndef DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION
4267 #define DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION ".debug_macinfo"
4268 #endif
4269 #ifndef DEBUG_LINE_SECTION
4270 #define DEBUG_LINE_SECTION ".debug_line"
4271 #endif
4272 #ifndef DEBUG_LOC_SECTION
4273 #define DEBUG_LOC_SECTION ".debug_loc"
4274 #endif
4275 #ifndef DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION
4276 #define DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION ".debug_pubnames"
4277 #endif
4278 #ifndef DEBUG_STR_SECTION
4279 #define DEBUG_STR_SECTION ".debug_str"
4280 #endif
4281 #ifndef DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION
4282 #define DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION ".debug_ranges"
4283 #endif
4284
4285 /* Standard ELF section names for compiled code and data. */
4286 #ifndef TEXT_SECTION_NAME
4287 #define TEXT_SECTION_NAME ".text"
4288 #endif
4289
4290 /* Section flags for .debug_str section. */
4291 #define DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS \
4292 (HAVE_GAS_SHF_MERGE && flag_merge_constants \
4293 ? SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_MERGE | SECTION_STRINGS | 1 \
4294 : SECTION_DEBUG)
4295
4296 /* Labels we insert at beginning sections we can reference instead of
4297 the section names themselves. */
4298
4299 #ifndef TEXT_SECTION_LABEL
4300 #define TEXT_SECTION_LABEL "Ltext"
4301 #endif
4302 #ifndef COLD_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL
4303 #define COLD_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL "Ltext_cold"
4304 #endif
4305 #ifndef DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL
4306 #define DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_line"
4307 #endif
4308 #ifndef DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL
4309 #define DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_info"
4310 #endif
4311 #ifndef DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL
4312 #define DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_abbrev"
4313 #endif
4314 #ifndef DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL
4315 #define DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_loc"
4316 #endif
4317 #ifndef DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL
4318 #define DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_ranges"
4319 #endif
4320 #ifndef DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL
4321 #define DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_macinfo"
4322 #endif
4323
4324 /* Definitions of defaults for formats and names of various special
4325 (artificial) labels which may be generated within this file (when the -g
4326 options is used and DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO is in effect.
4327 If necessary, these may be overridden from within the tm.h file, but
4328 typically, overriding these defaults is unnecessary. */
4329
4330 static char text_end_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4331 static char text_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4332 static char cold_text_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4333 static char cold_end_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4334 static char abbrev_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4335 static char debug_info_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4336 static char debug_line_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4337 static char macinfo_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4338 static char loc_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4339 static char ranges_section_label[2 * MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4340
4341 #ifndef TEXT_END_LABEL
4342 #define TEXT_END_LABEL "Letext"
4343 #endif
4344 #ifndef COLD_END_LABEL
4345 #define COLD_END_LABEL "Letext_cold"
4346 #endif
4347 #ifndef BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL
4348 #define BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL "LBB"
4349 #endif
4350 #ifndef BLOCK_END_LABEL
4351 #define BLOCK_END_LABEL "LBE"
4352 #endif
4353 #ifndef LINE_CODE_LABEL
4354 #define LINE_CODE_LABEL "LM"
4355 #endif
4356 #ifndef SEPARATE_LINE_CODE_LABEL
4357 #define SEPARATE_LINE_CODE_LABEL "LSM"
4358 #endif
4359
4360 /* We allow a language front-end to designate a function that is to be
4361 called to "demangle" any name before it is put into a DIE. */
4362
4363 static const char *(*demangle_name_func) (const char *);
4364
4365 void
dwarf2out_set_demangle_name_func(const char * (* func)(const char *))4366 dwarf2out_set_demangle_name_func (const char *(*func) (const char *))
4367 {
4368 demangle_name_func = func;
4369 }
4370
4371 /* Test if rtl node points to a pseudo register. */
4372
4373 static inline int
is_pseudo_reg(rtx rtl)4374 is_pseudo_reg (rtx rtl)
4375 {
4376 return ((REG_P (rtl) && REGNO (rtl) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
4377 || (GET_CODE (rtl) == SUBREG
4378 && REGNO (SUBREG_REG (rtl)) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER));
4379 }
4380
4381 /* Return a reference to a type, with its const and volatile qualifiers
4382 removed. */
4383
4384 static inline tree
type_main_variant(tree type)4385 type_main_variant (tree type)
4386 {
4387 type = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type);
4388
4389 /* ??? There really should be only one main variant among any group of
4390 variants of a given type (and all of the MAIN_VARIANT values for all
4391 members of the group should point to that one type) but sometimes the C
4392 front-end messes this up for array types, so we work around that bug
4393 here. */
4394 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
4395 while (type != TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type))
4396 type = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type);
4397
4398 return type;
4399 }
4400
4401 /* Return nonzero if the given type node represents a tagged type. */
4402
4403 static inline int
is_tagged_type(tree type)4404 is_tagged_type (tree type)
4405 {
4406 enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (type);
4407
4408 return (code == RECORD_TYPE || code == UNION_TYPE
4409 || code == QUAL_UNION_TYPE || code == ENUMERAL_TYPE);
4410 }
4411
4412 /* Convert a DIE tag into its string name. */
4413
4414 static const char *
dwarf_tag_name(unsigned int tag)4415 dwarf_tag_name (unsigned int tag)
4416 {
4417 switch (tag)
4418 {
4419 case DW_TAG_padding:
4420 return "DW_TAG_padding";
4421 case DW_TAG_array_type:
4422 return "DW_TAG_array_type";
4423 case DW_TAG_class_type:
4424 return "DW_TAG_class_type";
4425 case DW_TAG_entry_point:
4426 return "DW_TAG_entry_point";
4427 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
4428 return "DW_TAG_enumeration_type";
4429 case DW_TAG_formal_parameter:
4430 return "DW_TAG_formal_parameter";
4431 case DW_TAG_imported_declaration:
4432 return "DW_TAG_imported_declaration";
4433 case DW_TAG_label:
4434 return "DW_TAG_label";
4435 case DW_TAG_lexical_block:
4436 return "DW_TAG_lexical_block";
4437 case DW_TAG_member:
4438 return "DW_TAG_member";
4439 case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
4440 return "DW_TAG_pointer_type";
4441 case DW_TAG_reference_type:
4442 return "DW_TAG_reference_type";
4443 case DW_TAG_compile_unit:
4444 return "DW_TAG_compile_unit";
4445 case DW_TAG_string_type:
4446 return "DW_TAG_string_type";
4447 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
4448 return "DW_TAG_structure_type";
4449 case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
4450 return "DW_TAG_subroutine_type";
4451 case DW_TAG_typedef:
4452 return "DW_TAG_typedef";
4453 case DW_TAG_union_type:
4454 return "DW_TAG_union_type";
4455 case DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters:
4456 return "DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters";
4457 case DW_TAG_variant:
4458 return "DW_TAG_variant";
4459 case DW_TAG_common_block:
4460 return "DW_TAG_common_block";
4461 case DW_TAG_common_inclusion:
4462 return "DW_TAG_common_inclusion";
4463 case DW_TAG_inheritance:
4464 return "DW_TAG_inheritance";
4465 case DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine:
4466 return "DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine";
4467 case DW_TAG_module:
4468 return "DW_TAG_module";
4469 case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
4470 return "DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type";
4471 case DW_TAG_set_type:
4472 return "DW_TAG_set_type";
4473 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
4474 return "DW_TAG_subrange_type";
4475 case DW_TAG_with_stmt:
4476 return "DW_TAG_with_stmt";
4477 case DW_TAG_access_declaration:
4478 return "DW_TAG_access_declaration";
4479 case DW_TAG_base_type:
4480 return "DW_TAG_base_type";
4481 case DW_TAG_catch_block:
4482 return "DW_TAG_catch_block";
4483 case DW_TAG_const_type:
4484 return "DW_TAG_const_type";
4485 case DW_TAG_constant:
4486 return "DW_TAG_constant";
4487 case DW_TAG_enumerator:
4488 return "DW_TAG_enumerator";
4489 case DW_TAG_file_type:
4490 return "DW_TAG_file_type";
4491 case DW_TAG_friend:
4492 return "DW_TAG_friend";
4493 case DW_TAG_namelist:
4494 return "DW_TAG_namelist";
4495 case DW_TAG_namelist_item:
4496 return "DW_TAG_namelist_item";
4497 case DW_TAG_namespace:
4498 return "DW_TAG_namespace";
4499 case DW_TAG_packed_type:
4500 return "DW_TAG_packed_type";
4501 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
4502 return "DW_TAG_subprogram";
4503 case DW_TAG_template_type_param:
4504 return "DW_TAG_template_type_param";
4505 case DW_TAG_template_value_param:
4506 return "DW_TAG_template_value_param";
4507 case DW_TAG_thrown_type:
4508 return "DW_TAG_thrown_type";
4509 case DW_TAG_try_block:
4510 return "DW_TAG_try_block";
4511 case DW_TAG_variant_part:
4512 return "DW_TAG_variant_part";
4513 case DW_TAG_variable:
4514 return "DW_TAG_variable";
4515 case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
4516 return "DW_TAG_volatile_type";
4517 case DW_TAG_imported_module:
4518 return "DW_TAG_imported_module";
4519 case DW_TAG_MIPS_loop:
4520 return "DW_TAG_MIPS_loop";
4521 case DW_TAG_format_label:
4522 return "DW_TAG_format_label";
4523 case DW_TAG_function_template:
4524 return "DW_TAG_function_template";
4525 case DW_TAG_class_template:
4526 return "DW_TAG_class_template";
4527 case DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL:
4528 return "DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL";
4529 case DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL:
4530 return "DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL";
4531 default:
4532 return "DW_TAG_<unknown>";
4533 }
4534 }
4535
4536 /* Convert a DWARF attribute code into its string name. */
4537
4538 static const char *
dwarf_attr_name(unsigned int attr)4539 dwarf_attr_name (unsigned int attr)
4540 {
4541 switch (attr)
4542 {
4543 case DW_AT_sibling:
4544 return "DW_AT_sibling";
4545 case DW_AT_location:
4546 return "DW_AT_location";
4547 case DW_AT_name:
4548 return "DW_AT_name";
4549 case DW_AT_ordering:
4550 return "DW_AT_ordering";
4551 case DW_AT_subscr_data:
4552 return "DW_AT_subscr_data";
4553 case DW_AT_byte_size:
4554 return "DW_AT_byte_size";
4555 case DW_AT_bit_offset:
4556 return "DW_AT_bit_offset";
4557 case DW_AT_bit_size:
4558 return "DW_AT_bit_size";
4559 case DW_AT_element_list:
4560 return "DW_AT_element_list";
4561 case DW_AT_stmt_list:
4562 return "DW_AT_stmt_list";
4563 case DW_AT_low_pc:
4564 return "DW_AT_low_pc";
4565 case DW_AT_high_pc:
4566 return "DW_AT_high_pc";
4567 case DW_AT_language:
4568 return "DW_AT_language";
4569 case DW_AT_member:
4570 return "DW_AT_member";
4571 case DW_AT_discr:
4572 return "DW_AT_discr";
4573 case DW_AT_discr_value:
4574 return "DW_AT_discr_value";
4575 case DW_AT_visibility:
4576 return "DW_AT_visibility";
4577 case DW_AT_import:
4578 return "DW_AT_import";
4579 case DW_AT_string_length:
4580 return "DW_AT_string_length";
4581 case DW_AT_common_reference:
4582 return "DW_AT_common_reference";
4583 case DW_AT_comp_dir:
4584 return "DW_AT_comp_dir";
4585 case DW_AT_const_value:
4586 return "DW_AT_const_value";
4587 case DW_AT_containing_type:
4588 return "DW_AT_containing_type";
4589 case DW_AT_default_value:
4590 return "DW_AT_default_value";
4591 case DW_AT_inline:
4592 return "DW_AT_inline";
4593 case DW_AT_is_optional:
4594 return "DW_AT_is_optional";
4595 case DW_AT_lower_bound:
4596 return "DW_AT_lower_bound";
4597 case DW_AT_producer:
4598 return "DW_AT_producer";
4599 case DW_AT_prototyped:
4600 return "DW_AT_prototyped";
4601 case DW_AT_return_addr:
4602 return "DW_AT_return_addr";
4603 case DW_AT_start_scope:
4604 return "DW_AT_start_scope";
4605 case DW_AT_stride_size:
4606 return "DW_AT_stride_size";
4607 case DW_AT_upper_bound:
4608 return "DW_AT_upper_bound";
4609 case DW_AT_abstract_origin:
4610 return "DW_AT_abstract_origin";
4611 case DW_AT_accessibility:
4612 return "DW_AT_accessibility";
4613 case DW_AT_address_class:
4614 return "DW_AT_address_class";
4615 case DW_AT_artificial:
4616 return "DW_AT_artificial";
4617 case DW_AT_base_types:
4618 return "DW_AT_base_types";
4619 case DW_AT_calling_convention:
4620 return "DW_AT_calling_convention";
4621 case DW_AT_count:
4622 return "DW_AT_count";
4623 case DW_AT_data_member_location:
4624 return "DW_AT_data_member_location";
4625 case DW_AT_decl_column:
4626 return "DW_AT_decl_column";
4627 case DW_AT_decl_file:
4628 return "DW_AT_decl_file";
4629 case DW_AT_decl_line:
4630 return "DW_AT_decl_line";
4631 case DW_AT_declaration:
4632 return "DW_AT_declaration";
4633 case DW_AT_discr_list:
4634 return "DW_AT_discr_list";
4635 case DW_AT_encoding:
4636 return "DW_AT_encoding";
4637 case DW_AT_external:
4638 return "DW_AT_external";
4639 case DW_AT_frame_base:
4640 return "DW_AT_frame_base";
4641 case DW_AT_friend:
4642 return "DW_AT_friend";
4643 case DW_AT_identifier_case:
4644 return "DW_AT_identifier_case";
4645 case DW_AT_macro_info:
4646 return "DW_AT_macro_info";
4647 case DW_AT_namelist_items:
4648 return "DW_AT_namelist_items";
4649 case DW_AT_priority:
4650 return "DW_AT_priority";
4651 case DW_AT_segment:
4652 return "DW_AT_segment";
4653 case DW_AT_specification:
4654 return "DW_AT_specification";
4655 case DW_AT_static_link:
4656 return "DW_AT_static_link";
4657 case DW_AT_type:
4658 return "DW_AT_type";
4659 case DW_AT_use_location:
4660 return "DW_AT_use_location";
4661 case DW_AT_variable_parameter:
4662 return "DW_AT_variable_parameter";
4663 case DW_AT_virtuality:
4664 return "DW_AT_virtuality";
4665 case DW_AT_vtable_elem_location:
4666 return "DW_AT_vtable_elem_location";
4667
4668 case DW_AT_allocated:
4669 return "DW_AT_allocated";
4670 case DW_AT_associated:
4671 return "DW_AT_associated";
4672 case DW_AT_data_location:
4673 return "DW_AT_data_location";
4674 case DW_AT_stride:
4675 return "DW_AT_stride";
4676 case DW_AT_entry_pc:
4677 return "DW_AT_entry_pc";
4678 case DW_AT_use_UTF8:
4679 return "DW_AT_use_UTF8";
4680 case DW_AT_extension:
4681 return "DW_AT_extension";
4682 case DW_AT_ranges:
4683 return "DW_AT_ranges";
4684 case DW_AT_trampoline:
4685 return "DW_AT_trampoline";
4686 case DW_AT_call_column:
4687 return "DW_AT_call_column";
4688 case DW_AT_call_file:
4689 return "DW_AT_call_file";
4690 case DW_AT_call_line:
4691 return "DW_AT_call_line";
4692
4693 case DW_AT_MIPS_fde:
4694 return "DW_AT_MIPS_fde";
4695 case DW_AT_MIPS_loop_begin:
4696 return "DW_AT_MIPS_loop_begin";
4697 case DW_AT_MIPS_tail_loop_begin:
4698 return "DW_AT_MIPS_tail_loop_begin";
4699 case DW_AT_MIPS_epilog_begin:
4700 return "DW_AT_MIPS_epilog_begin";
4701 case DW_AT_MIPS_loop_unroll_factor:
4702 return "DW_AT_MIPS_loop_unroll_factor";
4703 case DW_AT_MIPS_software_pipeline_depth:
4704 return "DW_AT_MIPS_software_pipeline_depth";
4705 case DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name:
4706 return "DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name";
4707 case DW_AT_MIPS_stride:
4708 return "DW_AT_MIPS_stride";
4709 case DW_AT_MIPS_abstract_name:
4710 return "DW_AT_MIPS_abstract_name";
4711 case DW_AT_MIPS_clone_origin:
4712 return "DW_AT_MIPS_clone_origin";
4713 case DW_AT_MIPS_has_inlines:
4714 return "DW_AT_MIPS_has_inlines";
4715
4716 case DW_AT_sf_names:
4717 return "DW_AT_sf_names";
4718 case DW_AT_src_info:
4719 return "DW_AT_src_info";
4720 case DW_AT_mac_info:
4721 return "DW_AT_mac_info";
4722 case DW_AT_src_coords:
4723 return "DW_AT_src_coords";
4724 case DW_AT_body_begin:
4725 return "DW_AT_body_begin";
4726 case DW_AT_body_end:
4727 return "DW_AT_body_end";
4728 case DW_AT_GNU_vector:
4729 return "DW_AT_GNU_vector";
4730
4731 case DW_AT_VMS_rtnbeg_pd_address:
4732 return "DW_AT_VMS_rtnbeg_pd_address";
4733
4734 default:
4735 return "DW_AT_<unknown>";
4736 }
4737 }
4738
4739 /* Convert a DWARF value form code into its string name. */
4740
4741 static const char *
dwarf_form_name(unsigned int form)4742 dwarf_form_name (unsigned int form)
4743 {
4744 switch (form)
4745 {
4746 case DW_FORM_addr:
4747 return "DW_FORM_addr";
4748 case DW_FORM_block2:
4749 return "DW_FORM_block2";
4750 case DW_FORM_block4:
4751 return "DW_FORM_block4";
4752 case DW_FORM_data2:
4753 return "DW_FORM_data2";
4754 case DW_FORM_data4:
4755 return "DW_FORM_data4";
4756 case DW_FORM_data8:
4757 return "DW_FORM_data8";
4758 case DW_FORM_string:
4759 return "DW_FORM_string";
4760 case DW_FORM_block:
4761 return "DW_FORM_block";
4762 case DW_FORM_block1:
4763 return "DW_FORM_block1";
4764 case DW_FORM_data1:
4765 return "DW_FORM_data1";
4766 case DW_FORM_flag:
4767 return "DW_FORM_flag";
4768 case DW_FORM_sdata:
4769 return "DW_FORM_sdata";
4770 case DW_FORM_strp:
4771 return "DW_FORM_strp";
4772 case DW_FORM_udata:
4773 return "DW_FORM_udata";
4774 case DW_FORM_ref_addr:
4775 return "DW_FORM_ref_addr";
4776 case DW_FORM_ref1:
4777 return "DW_FORM_ref1";
4778 case DW_FORM_ref2:
4779 return "DW_FORM_ref2";
4780 case DW_FORM_ref4:
4781 return "DW_FORM_ref4";
4782 case DW_FORM_ref8:
4783 return "DW_FORM_ref8";
4784 case DW_FORM_ref_udata:
4785 return "DW_FORM_ref_udata";
4786 case DW_FORM_indirect:
4787 return "DW_FORM_indirect";
4788 default:
4789 return "DW_FORM_<unknown>";
4790 }
4791 }
4792
4793 /* Determine the "ultimate origin" of a decl. The decl may be an inlined
4794 instance of an inlined instance of a decl which is local to an inline
4795 function, so we have to trace all of the way back through the origin chain
4796 to find out what sort of node actually served as the original seed for the
4797 given block. */
4798
4799 static tree
decl_ultimate_origin(tree decl)4800 decl_ultimate_origin (tree decl)
4801 {
4802 if (!CODE_CONTAINS_STRUCT (TREE_CODE (decl), TS_DECL_COMMON))
4803 return NULL_TREE;
4804
4805 /* output_inline_function sets DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for all the
4806 nodes in the function to point to themselves; ignore that if
4807 we're trying to output the abstract instance of this function. */
4808 if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl) && DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) == decl)
4809 return NULL_TREE;
4810
4811 /* Since the DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for a DECL is supposed to be the
4812 most distant ancestor, this should never happen. */
4813 gcc_assert (!DECL_FROM_INLINE (DECL_ORIGIN (decl)));
4814
4815 return DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl);
4816 }
4817
4818 /* Determine the "ultimate origin" of a block. The block may be an inlined
4819 instance of an inlined instance of a block which is local to an inline
4820 function, so we have to trace all of the way back through the origin chain
4821 to find out what sort of node actually served as the original seed for the
4822 given block. */
4823
4824 static tree
block_ultimate_origin(tree block)4825 block_ultimate_origin (tree block)
4826 {
4827 tree immediate_origin = BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (block);
4828
4829 /* output_inline_function sets BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for all the
4830 nodes in the function to point to themselves; ignore that if
4831 we're trying to output the abstract instance of this function. */
4832 if (BLOCK_ABSTRACT (block) && immediate_origin == block)
4833 return NULL_TREE;
4834
4835 if (immediate_origin == NULL_TREE)
4836 return NULL_TREE;
4837 else
4838 {
4839 tree ret_val;
4840 tree lookahead = immediate_origin;
4841
4842 do
4843 {
4844 ret_val = lookahead;
4845 lookahead = (TREE_CODE (ret_val) == BLOCK
4846 ? BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (ret_val) : NULL);
4847 }
4848 while (lookahead != NULL && lookahead != ret_val);
4849
4850 /* The block's abstract origin chain may not be the *ultimate* origin of
4851 the block. It could lead to a DECL that has an abstract origin set.
4852 If so, we want that DECL's abstract origin (which is what DECL_ORIGIN
4853 will give us if it has one). Note that DECL's abstract origins are
4854 supposed to be the most distant ancestor (or so decl_ultimate_origin
4855 claims), so we don't need to loop following the DECL origins. */
4856 if (DECL_P (ret_val))
4857 return DECL_ORIGIN (ret_val);
4858
4859 return ret_val;
4860 }
4861 }
4862
4863 /* Get the class to which DECL belongs, if any. In g++, the DECL_CONTEXT
4864 of a virtual function may refer to a base class, so we check the 'this'
4865 parameter. */
4866
4867 static tree
decl_class_context(tree decl)4868 decl_class_context (tree decl)
4869 {
4870 tree context = NULL_TREE;
4871
4872 if (TREE_CODE (decl) != FUNCTION_DECL || ! DECL_VINDEX (decl))
4873 context = DECL_CONTEXT (decl);
4874 else
4875 context = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT
4876 (TREE_TYPE (TREE_VALUE (TYPE_ARG_TYPES (TREE_TYPE (decl)))));
4877
4878 if (context && !TYPE_P (context))
4879 context = NULL_TREE;
4880
4881 return context;
4882 }
4883
4884 /* Add an attribute/value pair to a DIE. */
4885
4886 static inline void
add_dwarf_attr(dw_die_ref die,dw_attr_ref attr)4887 add_dwarf_attr (dw_die_ref die, dw_attr_ref attr)
4888 {
4889 /* Maybe this should be an assert? */
4890 if (die == NULL)
4891 return;
4892
4893 if (die->die_attr == NULL)
4894 die->die_attr = VEC_alloc (dw_attr_node, gc, 1);
4895 VEC_safe_push (dw_attr_node, gc, die->die_attr, attr);
4896 }
4897
4898 static inline enum dw_val_class
AT_class(dw_attr_ref a)4899 AT_class (dw_attr_ref a)
4900 {
4901 return a->dw_attr_val.val_class;
4902 }
4903
4904 /* Add a flag value attribute to a DIE. */
4905
4906 static inline void
add_AT_flag(dw_die_ref die,enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,unsigned int flag)4907 add_AT_flag (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, unsigned int flag)
4908 {
4909 dw_attr_node attr;
4910
4911 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4912 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_flag;
4913 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_flag = flag;
4914 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4915 }
4916
4917 static inline unsigned
AT_flag(dw_attr_ref a)4918 AT_flag (dw_attr_ref a)
4919 {
4920 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_flag);
4921 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag;
4922 }
4923
4924 /* Add a signed integer attribute value to a DIE. */
4925
4926 static inline void
add_AT_int(dw_die_ref die,enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,HOST_WIDE_INT int_val)4927 add_AT_int (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, HOST_WIDE_INT int_val)
4928 {
4929 dw_attr_node attr;
4930
4931 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4932 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
4933 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_int = int_val;
4934 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4935 }
4936
4937 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT
AT_int(dw_attr_ref a)4938 AT_int (dw_attr_ref a)
4939 {
4940 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_const);
4941 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_int;
4942 }
4943
4944 /* Add an unsigned integer attribute value to a DIE. */
4945
4946 static inline void
add_AT_unsigned(dw_die_ref die,enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT unsigned_val)4947 add_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4948 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT unsigned_val)
4949 {
4950 dw_attr_node attr;
4951
4952 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4953 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const;
4954 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned = unsigned_val;
4955 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4956 }
4957
4958 static inline unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
AT_unsigned(dw_attr_ref a)4959 AT_unsigned (dw_attr_ref a)
4960 {
4961 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_unsigned_const);
4962 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned;
4963 }
4964
4965 /* Add an unsigned double integer attribute value to a DIE. */
4966
4967 static inline void
add_AT_long_long(dw_die_ref die,enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,long unsigned int val_hi,long unsigned int val_low)4968 add_AT_long_long (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4969 long unsigned int val_hi, long unsigned int val_low)
4970 {
4971 dw_attr_node attr;
4972
4973 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4974 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_long_long;
4975 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.hi = val_hi;
4976 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.low = val_low;
4977 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4978 }
4979
4980 /* Add a floating point attribute value to a DIE and return it. */
4981
4982 static inline void
add_AT_vec(dw_die_ref die,enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,unsigned int length,unsigned int elt_size,unsigned char * array)4983 add_AT_vec (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4984 unsigned int length, unsigned int elt_size, unsigned char *array)
4985 {
4986 dw_attr_node attr;
4987
4988 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4989 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_vec;
4990 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length = length;
4991 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size = elt_size;
4992 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.array = array;
4993 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4994 }
4995
4996 /* Hash and equality functions for debug_str_hash. */
4997
4998 static hashval_t
debug_str_do_hash(const void * x)4999 debug_str_do_hash (const void *x)
5000 {
5001 return htab_hash_string (((const struct indirect_string_node *)x)->str);
5002 }
5003
5004 static int
debug_str_eq(const void * x1,const void * x2)5005 debug_str_eq (const void *x1, const void *x2)
5006 {
5007 return strcmp ((((const struct indirect_string_node *)x1)->str),
5008 (const char *)x2) == 0;
5009 }
5010
5011 /* Add a string attribute value to a DIE. */
5012
5013 static inline void
add_AT_string(dw_die_ref die,enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,const char * str)5014 add_AT_string (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, const char *str)
5015 {
5016 dw_attr_node attr;
5017 struct indirect_string_node *node;
5018 void **slot;
5019
5020 if (! debug_str_hash)
5021 debug_str_hash = htab_create_ggc (10, debug_str_do_hash,
5022 debug_str_eq, NULL);
5023
5024 slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (debug_str_hash, str,
5025 htab_hash_string (str), INSERT);
5026 if (*slot == NULL)
5027 *slot = ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (struct indirect_string_node));
5028 node = (struct indirect_string_node *) *slot;
5029 node->str = ggc_strdup (str);
5030 node->refcount++;
5031
5032 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5033 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_str;
5034 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_str = node;
5035 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5036 }
5037
5038 static inline const char *
AT_string(dw_attr_ref a)5039 AT_string (dw_attr_ref a)
5040 {
5041 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str);
5042 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->str;
5043 }
5044
5045 /* Find out whether a string should be output inline in DIE
5046 or out-of-line in .debug_str section. */
5047
5048 static int
AT_string_form(dw_attr_ref a)5049 AT_string_form (dw_attr_ref a)
5050 {
5051 struct indirect_string_node *node;
5052 unsigned int len;
5053 char label[32];
5054
5055 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str);
5056
5057 node = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str;
5058 if (node->form)
5059 return node->form;
5060
5061 len = strlen (node->str) + 1;
5062
5063 /* If the string is shorter or equal to the size of the reference, it is
5064 always better to put it inline. */
5065 if (len <= DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE || node->refcount == 0)
5066 return node->form = DW_FORM_string;
5067
5068 /* If we cannot expect the linker to merge strings in .debug_str
5069 section, only put it into .debug_str if it is worth even in this
5070 single module. */
5071 if ((debug_str_section->common.flags & SECTION_MERGE) == 0
5072 && (len - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE) * node->refcount <= len)
5073 return node->form = DW_FORM_string;
5074
5075 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "LASF", dw2_string_counter);
5076 ++dw2_string_counter;
5077 node->label = xstrdup (label);
5078
5079 return node->form = DW_FORM_strp;
5080 }
5081
5082 /* Add a DIE reference attribute value to a DIE. */
5083
5084 static inline void
add_AT_die_ref(dw_die_ref die,enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,dw_die_ref targ_die)5085 add_AT_die_ref (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, dw_die_ref targ_die)
5086 {
5087 dw_attr_node attr;
5088
5089 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5090 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
5091 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die = targ_die;
5092 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
5093 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5094 }
5095
5096 /* Add an AT_specification attribute to a DIE, and also make the back
5097 pointer from the specification to the definition. */
5098
5099 static inline void
add_AT_specification(dw_die_ref die,dw_die_ref targ_die)5100 add_AT_specification (dw_die_ref die, dw_die_ref targ_die)
5101 {
5102 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_specification, targ_die);
5103 gcc_assert (!targ_die->die_definition);
5104 targ_die->die_definition = die;
5105 }
5106
5107 static inline dw_die_ref
AT_ref(dw_attr_ref a)5108 AT_ref (dw_attr_ref a)
5109 {
5110 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref);
5111 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die;
5112 }
5113
5114 static inline int
AT_ref_external(dw_attr_ref a)5115 AT_ref_external (dw_attr_ref a)
5116 {
5117 if (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
5118 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external;
5119
5120 return 0;
5121 }
5122
5123 static inline void
set_AT_ref_external(dw_attr_ref a,int i)5124 set_AT_ref_external (dw_attr_ref a, int i)
5125 {
5126 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref);
5127 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = i;
5128 }
5129
5130 /* Add an FDE reference attribute value to a DIE. */
5131
5132 static inline void
add_AT_fde_ref(dw_die_ref die,enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,unsigned int targ_fde)5133 add_AT_fde_ref (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, unsigned int targ_fde)
5134 {
5135 dw_attr_node attr;
5136
5137 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5138 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_fde_ref;
5139 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_fde_index = targ_fde;
5140 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5141 }
5142
5143 /* Add a location description attribute value to a DIE. */
5144
5145 static inline void
add_AT_loc(dw_die_ref die,enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,dw_loc_descr_ref loc)5146 add_AT_loc (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
5147 {
5148 dw_attr_node attr;
5149
5150 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5151 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
5152 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_loc = loc;
5153 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5154 }
5155
5156 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
AT_loc(dw_attr_ref a)5157 AT_loc (dw_attr_ref a)
5158 {
5159 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc);
5160 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc;
5161 }
5162
5163 static inline void
add_AT_loc_list(dw_die_ref die,enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,dw_loc_list_ref loc_list)5164 add_AT_loc_list (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, dw_loc_list_ref loc_list)
5165 {
5166 dw_attr_node attr;
5167
5168 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5169 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_loc_list;
5170 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_loc_list = loc_list;
5171 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5172 have_location_lists = true;
5173 }
5174
5175 static inline dw_loc_list_ref
AT_loc_list(dw_attr_ref a)5176 AT_loc_list (dw_attr_ref a)
5177 {
5178 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list);
5179 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc_list;
5180 }
5181
5182 /* Add an address constant attribute value to a DIE. */
5183
5184 static inline void
add_AT_addr(dw_die_ref die,enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,rtx addr)5185 add_AT_addr (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, rtx addr)
5186 {
5187 dw_attr_node attr;
5188
5189 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5190 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
5191 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_addr = addr;
5192 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5193 }
5194
5195 /* Get the RTX from to an address DIE attribute. */
5196
5197 static inline rtx
AT_addr(dw_attr_ref a)5198 AT_addr (dw_attr_ref a)
5199 {
5200 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_addr);
5201 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_addr;
5202 }
5203
5204 /* Add a file attribute value to a DIE. */
5205
5206 static inline void
add_AT_file(dw_die_ref die,enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,struct dwarf_file_data * fd)5207 add_AT_file (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
5208 struct dwarf_file_data *fd)
5209 {
5210 dw_attr_node attr;
5211
5212 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5213 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_file;
5214 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_file = fd;
5215 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5216 }
5217
5218 /* Get the dwarf_file_data from a file DIE attribute. */
5219
5220 static inline struct dwarf_file_data *
AT_file(dw_attr_ref a)5221 AT_file (dw_attr_ref a)
5222 {
5223 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_file);
5224 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file;
5225 }
5226
5227 /* Add a label identifier attribute value to a DIE. */
5228
5229 static inline void
add_AT_lbl_id(dw_die_ref die,enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,const char * lbl_id)5230 add_AT_lbl_id (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, const char *lbl_id)
5231 {
5232 dw_attr_node attr;
5233
5234 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5235 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_lbl_id;
5236 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = xstrdup (lbl_id);
5237 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5238 }
5239
5240 /* Add a section offset attribute value to a DIE, an offset into the
5241 debug_line section. */
5242
5243 static inline void
add_AT_lineptr(dw_die_ref die,enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,const char * label)5244 add_AT_lineptr (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
5245 const char *label)
5246 {
5247 dw_attr_node attr;
5248
5249 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5250 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_lineptr;
5251 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = xstrdup (label);
5252 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5253 }
5254
5255 /* Add a section offset attribute value to a DIE, an offset into the
5256 debug_macinfo section. */
5257
5258 static inline void
add_AT_macptr(dw_die_ref die,enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,const char * label)5259 add_AT_macptr (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
5260 const char *label)
5261 {
5262 dw_attr_node attr;
5263
5264 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5265 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_macptr;
5266 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = xstrdup (label);
5267 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5268 }
5269
5270 /* Add an offset attribute value to a DIE. */
5271
5272 static inline void
add_AT_offset(dw_die_ref die,enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT offset)5273 add_AT_offset (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
5274 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
5275 {
5276 dw_attr_node attr;
5277
5278 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5279 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_offset;
5280 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_offset = offset;
5281 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5282 }
5283
5284 /* Add an range_list attribute value to a DIE. */
5285
5286 static void
add_AT_range_list(dw_die_ref die,enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,long unsigned int offset)5287 add_AT_range_list (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
5288 long unsigned int offset)
5289 {
5290 dw_attr_node attr;
5291
5292 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5293 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_range_list;
5294 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_offset = offset;
5295 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5296 }
5297
5298 static inline const char *
AT_lbl(dw_attr_ref a)5299 AT_lbl (dw_attr_ref a)
5300 {
5301 gcc_assert (a && (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_lbl_id
5302 || AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_lineptr
5303 || AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_macptr));
5304 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id;
5305 }
5306
5307 /* Get the attribute of type attr_kind. */
5308
5309 static dw_attr_ref
get_AT(dw_die_ref die,enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)5310 get_AT (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5311 {
5312 dw_attr_ref a;
5313 unsigned ix;
5314 dw_die_ref spec = NULL;
5315
5316 if (! die)
5317 return NULL;
5318
5319 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
5320 if (a->dw_attr == attr_kind)
5321 return a;
5322 else if (a->dw_attr == DW_AT_specification
5323 || a->dw_attr == DW_AT_abstract_origin)
5324 spec = AT_ref (a);
5325
5326 if (spec)
5327 return get_AT (spec, attr_kind);
5328
5329 return NULL;
5330 }
5331
5332 /* Return the "low pc" attribute value, typically associated with a subprogram
5333 DIE. Return null if the "low pc" attribute is either not present, or if it
5334 cannot be represented as an assembler label identifier. */
5335
5336 static inline const char *
get_AT_low_pc(dw_die_ref die)5337 get_AT_low_pc (dw_die_ref die)
5338 {
5339 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, DW_AT_low_pc);
5340
5341 return a ? AT_lbl (a) : NULL;
5342 }
5343
5344 /* Return the "high pc" attribute value, typically associated with a subprogram
5345 DIE. Return null if the "high pc" attribute is either not present, or if it
5346 cannot be represented as an assembler label identifier. */
5347
5348 static inline const char *
get_AT_hi_pc(dw_die_ref die)5349 get_AT_hi_pc (dw_die_ref die)
5350 {
5351 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, DW_AT_high_pc);
5352
5353 return a ? AT_lbl (a) : NULL;
5354 }
5355
5356 /* Return the value of the string attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or
5357 NULL if it is not present. */
5358
5359 static inline const char *
get_AT_string(dw_die_ref die,enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)5360 get_AT_string (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5361 {
5362 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
5363
5364 return a ? AT_string (a) : NULL;
5365 }
5366
5367 /* Return the value of the flag attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or -1
5368 if it is not present. */
5369
5370 static inline int
get_AT_flag(dw_die_ref die,enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)5371 get_AT_flag (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5372 {
5373 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
5374
5375 return a ? AT_flag (a) : 0;
5376 }
5377
5378 /* Return the value of the unsigned attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or 0
5379 if it is not present. */
5380
5381 static inline unsigned
get_AT_unsigned(dw_die_ref die,enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)5382 get_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5383 {
5384 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
5385
5386 return a ? AT_unsigned (a) : 0;
5387 }
5388
5389 static inline dw_die_ref
get_AT_ref(dw_die_ref die,enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)5390 get_AT_ref (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5391 {
5392 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
5393
5394 return a ? AT_ref (a) : NULL;
5395 }
5396
5397 static inline struct dwarf_file_data *
get_AT_file(dw_die_ref die,enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)5398 get_AT_file (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5399 {
5400 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
5401
5402 return a ? AT_file (a) : NULL;
5403 }
5404
5405 /* Return TRUE if the language is C or C++. */
5406
5407 static inline bool
is_c_family(void)5408 is_c_family (void)
5409 {
5410 unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language);
5411
5412 return (lang == DW_LANG_C || lang == DW_LANG_C89 || lang == DW_LANG_ObjC
5413 || lang == DW_LANG_C99
5414 || lang == DW_LANG_C_plus_plus || lang == DW_LANG_ObjC_plus_plus);
5415 }
5416
5417 /* Return TRUE if the language is C++. */
5418
5419 static inline bool
is_cxx(void)5420 is_cxx (void)
5421 {
5422 unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language);
5423
5424 return lang == DW_LANG_C_plus_plus || lang == DW_LANG_ObjC_plus_plus;
5425 }
5426
5427 /* Return TRUE if the language is Fortran. */
5428
5429 static inline bool
is_fortran(void)5430 is_fortran (void)
5431 {
5432 unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language);
5433
5434 return (lang == DW_LANG_Fortran77
5435 || lang == DW_LANG_Fortran90
5436 || lang == DW_LANG_Fortran95);
5437 }
5438
5439 /* Return TRUE if the language is Java. */
5440
5441 static inline bool
is_java(void)5442 is_java (void)
5443 {
5444 unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language);
5445
5446 return lang == DW_LANG_Java;
5447 }
5448
5449 /* Return TRUE if the language is Ada. */
5450
5451 static inline bool
is_ada(void)5452 is_ada (void)
5453 {
5454 unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language);
5455
5456 return lang == DW_LANG_Ada95 || lang == DW_LANG_Ada83;
5457 }
5458
5459 /* Remove the specified attribute if present. */
5460
5461 static void
remove_AT(dw_die_ref die,enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)5462 remove_AT (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5463 {
5464 dw_attr_ref a;
5465 unsigned ix;
5466
5467 if (! die)
5468 return;
5469
5470 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
5471 if (a->dw_attr == attr_kind)
5472 {
5473 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str)
5474 if (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount)
5475 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount--;
5476
5477 /* VEC_ordered_remove should help reduce the number of abbrevs
5478 that are needed. */
5479 VEC_ordered_remove (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix);
5480 return;
5481 }
5482 }
5483
5484 /* Remove CHILD from its parent. PREV must have the property that
5485 PREV->DIE_SIB == CHILD. Does not alter CHILD. */
5486
5487 static void
remove_child_with_prev(dw_die_ref child,dw_die_ref prev)5488 remove_child_with_prev (dw_die_ref child, dw_die_ref prev)
5489 {
5490 gcc_assert (child->die_parent == prev->die_parent);
5491 gcc_assert (prev->die_sib == child);
5492 if (prev == child)
5493 {
5494 gcc_assert (child->die_parent->die_child == child);
5495 prev = NULL;
5496 }
5497 else
5498 prev->die_sib = child->die_sib;
5499 if (child->die_parent->die_child == child)
5500 child->die_parent->die_child = prev;
5501 }
5502
5503 /* Remove child DIE whose die_tag is TAG. Do nothing if no child
5504 matches TAG. */
5505
5506 static void
remove_child_TAG(dw_die_ref die,enum dwarf_tag tag)5507 remove_child_TAG (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_tag tag)
5508 {
5509 dw_die_ref c;
5510
5511 c = die->die_child;
5512 if (c) do {
5513 dw_die_ref prev = c;
5514 c = c->die_sib;
5515 while (c->die_tag == tag)
5516 {
5517 remove_child_with_prev (c, prev);
5518 /* Might have removed every child. */
5519 if (c == c->die_sib)
5520 return;
5521 c = c->die_sib;
5522 }
5523 } while (c != die->die_child);
5524 }
5525
5526 /* Add a CHILD_DIE as the last child of DIE. */
5527
5528 static void
add_child_die(dw_die_ref die,dw_die_ref child_die)5529 add_child_die (dw_die_ref die, dw_die_ref child_die)
5530 {
5531 /* FIXME this should probably be an assert. */
5532 if (! die || ! child_die)
5533 return;
5534 gcc_assert (die != child_die);
5535
5536 child_die->die_parent = die;
5537 if (die->die_child)
5538 {
5539 child_die->die_sib = die->die_child->die_sib;
5540 die->die_child->die_sib = child_die;
5541 }
5542 else
5543 child_die->die_sib = child_die;
5544 die->die_child = child_die;
5545 }
5546
5547 /* Move CHILD, which must be a child of PARENT or the DIE for which PARENT
5548 is the specification, to the end of PARENT's list of children.
5549 This is done by removing and re-adding it. */
5550
5551 static void
splice_child_die(dw_die_ref parent,dw_die_ref child)5552 splice_child_die (dw_die_ref parent, dw_die_ref child)
5553 {
5554 dw_die_ref p;
5555
5556 /* We want the declaration DIE from inside the class, not the
5557 specification DIE at toplevel. */
5558 if (child->die_parent != parent)
5559 {
5560 dw_die_ref tmp = get_AT_ref (child, DW_AT_specification);
5561
5562 if (tmp)
5563 child = tmp;
5564 }
5565
5566 gcc_assert (child->die_parent == parent
5567 || (child->die_parent
5568 == get_AT_ref (parent, DW_AT_specification)));
5569
5570 for (p = child->die_parent->die_child; ; p = p->die_sib)
5571 if (p->die_sib == child)
5572 {
5573 remove_child_with_prev (child, p);
5574 break;
5575 }
5576
5577 add_child_die (parent, child);
5578 }
5579
5580 /* Return a pointer to a newly created DIE node. */
5581
5582 static inline dw_die_ref
new_die(enum dwarf_tag tag_value,dw_die_ref parent_die,tree t)5583 new_die (enum dwarf_tag tag_value, dw_die_ref parent_die, tree t)
5584 {
5585 dw_die_ref die = ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (die_node));
5586
5587 die->die_tag = tag_value;
5588
5589 if (parent_die != NULL)
5590 add_child_die (parent_die, die);
5591 else
5592 {
5593 limbo_die_node *limbo_node;
5594
5595 limbo_node = ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (limbo_die_node));
5596 limbo_node->die = die;
5597 limbo_node->created_for = t;
5598 limbo_node->next = limbo_die_list;
5599 limbo_die_list = limbo_node;
5600 }
5601
5602 return die;
5603 }
5604
5605 /* Return the DIE associated with the given type specifier. */
5606
5607 static inline dw_die_ref
lookup_type_die(tree type)5608 lookup_type_die (tree type)
5609 {
5610 return TYPE_SYMTAB_DIE (type);
5611 }
5612
5613 /* Equate a DIE to a given type specifier. */
5614
5615 static inline void
equate_type_number_to_die(tree type,dw_die_ref type_die)5616 equate_type_number_to_die (tree type, dw_die_ref type_die)
5617 {
5618 TYPE_SYMTAB_DIE (type) = type_die;
5619 }
5620
5621 /* Returns a hash value for X (which really is a die_struct). */
5622
5623 static hashval_t
decl_die_table_hash(const void * x)5624 decl_die_table_hash (const void *x)
5625 {
5626 return (hashval_t) ((const dw_die_ref) x)->decl_id;
5627 }
5628
5629 /* Return nonzero if decl_id of die_struct X is the same as UID of decl *Y. */
5630
5631 static int
decl_die_table_eq(const void * x,const void * y)5632 decl_die_table_eq (const void *x, const void *y)
5633 {
5634 return (((const dw_die_ref) x)->decl_id == DECL_UID ((const tree) y));
5635 }
5636
5637 /* Return the DIE associated with a given declaration. */
5638
5639 static inline dw_die_ref
lookup_decl_die(tree decl)5640 lookup_decl_die (tree decl)
5641 {
5642 return htab_find_with_hash (decl_die_table, decl, DECL_UID (decl));
5643 }
5644
5645 /* Returns a hash value for X (which really is a var_loc_list). */
5646
5647 static hashval_t
decl_loc_table_hash(const void * x)5648 decl_loc_table_hash (const void *x)
5649 {
5650 return (hashval_t) ((const var_loc_list *) x)->decl_id;
5651 }
5652
5653 /* Return nonzero if decl_id of var_loc_list X is the same as
5654 UID of decl *Y. */
5655
5656 static int
decl_loc_table_eq(const void * x,const void * y)5657 decl_loc_table_eq (const void *x, const void *y)
5658 {
5659 return (((const var_loc_list *) x)->decl_id == DECL_UID ((const tree) y));
5660 }
5661
5662 /* Return the var_loc list associated with a given declaration. */
5663
5664 static inline var_loc_list *
lookup_decl_loc(tree decl)5665 lookup_decl_loc (tree decl)
5666 {
5667 return htab_find_with_hash (decl_loc_table, decl, DECL_UID (decl));
5668 }
5669
5670 /* Equate a DIE to a particular declaration. */
5671
5672 static void
equate_decl_number_to_die(tree decl,dw_die_ref decl_die)5673 equate_decl_number_to_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref decl_die)
5674 {
5675 unsigned int decl_id = DECL_UID (decl);
5676 void **slot;
5677
5678 slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (decl_die_table, decl, decl_id, INSERT);
5679 *slot = decl_die;
5680 decl_die->decl_id = decl_id;
5681 }
5682
5683 /* Add a variable location node to the linked list for DECL. */
5684
5685 static void
add_var_loc_to_decl(tree decl,struct var_loc_node * loc)5686 add_var_loc_to_decl (tree decl, struct var_loc_node *loc)
5687 {
5688 unsigned int decl_id = DECL_UID (decl);
5689 var_loc_list *temp;
5690 void **slot;
5691
5692 slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (decl_loc_table, decl, decl_id, INSERT);
5693 if (*slot == NULL)
5694 {
5695 temp = ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (var_loc_list));
5696 temp->decl_id = decl_id;
5697 *slot = temp;
5698 }
5699 else
5700 temp = *slot;
5701
5702 if (temp->last)
5703 {
5704 /* If the current location is the same as the end of the list,
5705 we have nothing to do. */
5706 if (!rtx_equal_p (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (temp->last->var_loc_note),
5707 NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (loc->var_loc_note)))
5708 {
5709 /* Add LOC to the end of list and update LAST. */
5710 temp->last->next = loc;
5711 temp->last = loc;
5712 }
5713 }
5714 /* Do not add empty location to the beginning of the list. */
5715 else if (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (loc->var_loc_note) != NULL_RTX)
5716 {
5717 temp->first = loc;
5718 temp->last = loc;
5719 }
5720 }
5721
5722 /* Keep track of the number of spaces used to indent the
5723 output of the debugging routines that print the structure of
5724 the DIE internal representation. */
5725 static int print_indent;
5726
5727 /* Indent the line the number of spaces given by print_indent. */
5728
5729 static inline void
print_spaces(FILE * outfile)5730 print_spaces (FILE *outfile)
5731 {
5732 fprintf (outfile, "%*s", print_indent, "");
5733 }
5734
5735 /* Print the information associated with a given DIE, and its children.
5736 This routine is a debugging aid only. */
5737
5738 static void
print_die(dw_die_ref die,FILE * outfile)5739 print_die (dw_die_ref die, FILE *outfile)
5740 {
5741 dw_attr_ref a;
5742 dw_die_ref c;
5743 unsigned ix;
5744
5745 print_spaces (outfile);
5746 fprintf (outfile, "DIE %4ld: %s\n",
5747 die->die_offset, dwarf_tag_name (die->die_tag));
5748 print_spaces (outfile);
5749 fprintf (outfile, " abbrev id: %lu", die->die_abbrev);
5750 fprintf (outfile, " offset: %ld\n", die->die_offset);
5751
5752 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
5753 {
5754 print_spaces (outfile);
5755 fprintf (outfile, " %s: ", dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr));
5756
5757 switch (AT_class (a))
5758 {
5759 case dw_val_class_addr:
5760 fprintf (outfile, "address");
5761 break;
5762 case dw_val_class_offset:
5763 fprintf (outfile, "offset");
5764 break;
5765 case dw_val_class_loc:
5766 fprintf (outfile, "location descriptor");
5767 break;
5768 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
5769 fprintf (outfile, "location list -> label:%s",
5770 AT_loc_list (a)->ll_symbol);
5771 break;
5772 case dw_val_class_range_list:
5773 fprintf (outfile, "range list");
5774 break;
5775 case dw_val_class_const:
5776 fprintf (outfile, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC, AT_int (a));
5777 break;
5778 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
5779 fprintf (outfile, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_UNSIGNED, AT_unsigned (a));
5780 break;
5781 case dw_val_class_long_long:
5782 fprintf (outfile, "constant (%lu,%lu)",
5783 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.hi,
5784 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.low);
5785 break;
5786 case dw_val_class_vec:
5787 fprintf (outfile, "floating-point or vector constant");
5788 break;
5789 case dw_val_class_flag:
5790 fprintf (outfile, "%u", AT_flag (a));
5791 break;
5792 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
5793 if (AT_ref (a) != NULL)
5794 {
5795 if (AT_ref (a)->die_symbol)
5796 fprintf (outfile, "die -> label: %s", AT_ref (a)->die_symbol);
5797 else
5798 fprintf (outfile, "die -> %ld", AT_ref (a)->die_offset);
5799 }
5800 else
5801 fprintf (outfile, "die -> <null>");
5802 break;
5803 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
5804 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
5805 case dw_val_class_macptr:
5806 fprintf (outfile, "label: %s", AT_lbl (a));
5807 break;
5808 case dw_val_class_str:
5809 if (AT_string (a) != NULL)
5810 fprintf (outfile, "\"%s\"", AT_string (a));
5811 else
5812 fprintf (outfile, "<null>");
5813 break;
5814 case dw_val_class_file:
5815 fprintf (outfile, "\"%s\" (%d)", AT_file (a)->filename,
5816 AT_file (a)->emitted_number);
5817 break;
5818 default:
5819 break;
5820 }
5821
5822 fprintf (outfile, "\n");
5823 }
5824
5825 if (die->die_child != NULL)
5826 {
5827 print_indent += 4;
5828 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, print_die (c, outfile));
5829 print_indent -= 4;
5830 }
5831 if (print_indent == 0)
5832 fprintf (outfile, "\n");
5833 }
5834
5835 /* Print the contents of the source code line number correspondence table.
5836 This routine is a debugging aid only. */
5837
5838 static void
print_dwarf_line_table(FILE * outfile)5839 print_dwarf_line_table (FILE *outfile)
5840 {
5841 unsigned i;
5842 dw_line_info_ref line_info;
5843
5844 fprintf (outfile, "\n\nDWARF source line information\n");
5845 for (i = 1; i < line_info_table_in_use; i++)
5846 {
5847 line_info = &line_info_table[i];
5848 fprintf (outfile, "%5d: %4ld %6ld\n", i,
5849 line_info->dw_file_num,
5850 line_info->dw_line_num);
5851 }
5852
5853 fprintf (outfile, "\n\n");
5854 }
5855
5856 /* Print the information collected for a given DIE. */
5857
5858 void
debug_dwarf_die(dw_die_ref die)5859 debug_dwarf_die (dw_die_ref die)
5860 {
5861 print_die (die, stderr);
5862 }
5863
5864 /* Print all DWARF information collected for the compilation unit.
5865 This routine is a debugging aid only. */
5866
5867 void
debug_dwarf(void)5868 debug_dwarf (void)
5869 {
5870 print_indent = 0;
5871 print_die (comp_unit_die, stderr);
5872 if (! DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
5873 print_dwarf_line_table (stderr);
5874 }
5875
5876 /* Start a new compilation unit DIE for an include file. OLD_UNIT is the CU
5877 for the enclosing include file, if any. BINCL_DIE is the DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL
5878 DIE that marks the start of the DIEs for this include file. */
5879
5880 static dw_die_ref
push_new_compile_unit(dw_die_ref old_unit,dw_die_ref bincl_die)5881 push_new_compile_unit (dw_die_ref old_unit, dw_die_ref bincl_die)
5882 {
5883 const char *filename = get_AT_string (bincl_die, DW_AT_name);
5884 dw_die_ref new_unit = gen_compile_unit_die (filename);
5885
5886 new_unit->die_sib = old_unit;
5887 return new_unit;
5888 }
5889
5890 /* Close an include-file CU and reopen the enclosing one. */
5891
5892 static dw_die_ref
pop_compile_unit(dw_die_ref old_unit)5893 pop_compile_unit (dw_die_ref old_unit)
5894 {
5895 dw_die_ref new_unit = old_unit->die_sib;
5896
5897 old_unit->die_sib = NULL;
5898 return new_unit;
5899 }
5900
5901 #define CHECKSUM(FOO) md5_process_bytes (&(FOO), sizeof (FOO), ctx)
5902 #define CHECKSUM_STRING(FOO) md5_process_bytes ((FOO), strlen (FOO), ctx)
5903
5904 /* Calculate the checksum of a location expression. */
5905
5906 static inline void
loc_checksum(dw_loc_descr_ref loc,struct md5_ctx * ctx)5907 loc_checksum (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, struct md5_ctx *ctx)
5908 {
5909 CHECKSUM (loc->dw_loc_opc);
5910 CHECKSUM (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1);
5911 CHECKSUM (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2);
5912 }
5913
5914 /* Calculate the checksum of an attribute. */
5915
5916 static void
attr_checksum(dw_attr_ref at,struct md5_ctx * ctx,int * mark)5917 attr_checksum (dw_attr_ref at, struct md5_ctx *ctx, int *mark)
5918 {
5919 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
5920 rtx r;
5921
5922 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr);
5923
5924 /* We don't care that this was compiled with a different compiler
5925 snapshot; if the output is the same, that's what matters. */
5926 if (at->dw_attr == DW_AT_producer)
5927 return;
5928
5929 switch (AT_class (at))
5930 {
5931 case dw_val_class_const:
5932 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_int);
5933 break;
5934 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
5935 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned);
5936 break;
5937 case dw_val_class_long_long:
5938 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long);
5939 break;
5940 case dw_val_class_vec:
5941 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec);
5942 break;
5943 case dw_val_class_flag:
5944 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag);
5945 break;
5946 case dw_val_class_str:
5947 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_string (at));
5948 break;
5949
5950 case dw_val_class_addr:
5951 r = AT_addr (at);
5952 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (r) == SYMBOL_REF);
5953 CHECKSUM_STRING (XSTR (r, 0));
5954 break;
5955
5956 case dw_val_class_offset:
5957 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset);
5958 break;
5959
5960 case dw_val_class_loc:
5961 for (loc = AT_loc (at); loc; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
5962 loc_checksum (loc, ctx);
5963 break;
5964
5965 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
5966 die_checksum (AT_ref (at), ctx, mark);
5967 break;
5968
5969 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
5970 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
5971 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
5972 case dw_val_class_macptr:
5973 break;
5974
5975 case dw_val_class_file:
5976 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_file (at)->filename);
5977 break;
5978
5979 default:
5980 break;
5981 }
5982 }
5983
5984 /* Calculate the checksum of a DIE. */
5985
5986 static void
die_checksum(dw_die_ref die,struct md5_ctx * ctx,int * mark)5987 die_checksum (dw_die_ref die, struct md5_ctx *ctx, int *mark)
5988 {
5989 dw_die_ref c;
5990 dw_attr_ref a;
5991 unsigned ix;
5992
5993 /* To avoid infinite recursion. */
5994 if (die->die_mark)
5995 {
5996 CHECKSUM (die->die_mark);
5997 return;
5998 }
5999 die->die_mark = ++(*mark);
6000
6001 CHECKSUM (die->die_tag);
6002
6003 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
6004 attr_checksum (a, ctx, mark);
6005
6006 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, die_checksum (c, ctx, mark));
6007 }
6008
6009 #undef CHECKSUM
6010 #undef CHECKSUM_STRING
6011
6012 /* Do the location expressions look same? */
6013 static inline int
same_loc_p(dw_loc_descr_ref loc1,dw_loc_descr_ref loc2,int * mark)6014 same_loc_p (dw_loc_descr_ref loc1, dw_loc_descr_ref loc2, int *mark)
6015 {
6016 return loc1->dw_loc_opc == loc2->dw_loc_opc
6017 && same_dw_val_p (&loc1->dw_loc_oprnd1, &loc2->dw_loc_oprnd1, mark)
6018 && same_dw_val_p (&loc1->dw_loc_oprnd2, &loc2->dw_loc_oprnd2, mark);
6019 }
6020
6021 /* Do the values look the same? */
6022 static int
same_dw_val_p(dw_val_node * v1,dw_val_node * v2,int * mark)6023 same_dw_val_p (dw_val_node *v1, dw_val_node *v2, int *mark)
6024 {
6025 dw_loc_descr_ref loc1, loc2;
6026 rtx r1, r2;
6027
6028 if (v1->val_class != v2->val_class)
6029 return 0;
6030
6031 switch (v1->val_class)
6032 {
6033 case dw_val_class_const:
6034 return v1->v.val_int == v2->v.val_int;
6035 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
6036 return v1->v.val_unsigned == v2->v.val_unsigned;
6037 case dw_val_class_long_long:
6038 return v1->v.val_long_long.hi == v2->v.val_long_long.hi
6039 && v1->v.val_long_long.low == v2->v.val_long_long.low;
6040 case dw_val_class_vec:
6041 if (v1->v.val_vec.length != v2->v.val_vec.length
6042 || v1->v.val_vec.elt_size != v2->v.val_vec.elt_size)
6043 return 0;
6044 if (memcmp (v1->v.val_vec.array, v2->v.val_vec.array,
6045 v1->v.val_vec.length * v1->v.val_vec.elt_size))
6046 return 0;
6047 return 1;
6048 case dw_val_class_flag:
6049 return v1->v.val_flag == v2->v.val_flag;
6050 case dw_val_class_str:
6051 return !strcmp(v1->v.val_str->str, v2->v.val_str->str);
6052
6053 case dw_val_class_addr:
6054 r1 = v1->v.val_addr;
6055 r2 = v2->v.val_addr;
6056 if (GET_CODE (r1) != GET_CODE (r2))
6057 return 0;
6058 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (r1) == SYMBOL_REF);
6059 return !strcmp (XSTR (r1, 0), XSTR (r2, 0));
6060
6061 case dw_val_class_offset:
6062 return v1->v.val_offset == v2->v.val_offset;
6063
6064 case dw_val_class_loc:
6065 for (loc1 = v1->v.val_loc, loc2 = v2->v.val_loc;
6066 loc1 && loc2;
6067 loc1 = loc1->dw_loc_next, loc2 = loc2->dw_loc_next)
6068 if (!same_loc_p (loc1, loc2, mark))
6069 return 0;
6070 return !loc1 && !loc2;
6071
6072 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
6073 return same_die_p (v1->v.val_die_ref.die, v2->v.val_die_ref.die, mark);
6074
6075 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
6076 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
6077 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
6078 case dw_val_class_macptr:
6079 return 1;
6080
6081 case dw_val_class_file:
6082 return v1->v.val_file == v2->v.val_file;
6083
6084 default:
6085 return 1;
6086 }
6087 }
6088
6089 /* Do the attributes look the same? */
6090
6091 static int
same_attr_p(dw_attr_ref at1,dw_attr_ref at2,int * mark)6092 same_attr_p (dw_attr_ref at1, dw_attr_ref at2, int *mark)
6093 {
6094 if (at1->dw_attr != at2->dw_attr)
6095 return 0;
6096
6097 /* We don't care that this was compiled with a different compiler
6098 snapshot; if the output is the same, that's what matters. */
6099 if (at1->dw_attr == DW_AT_producer)
6100 return 1;
6101
6102 return same_dw_val_p (&at1->dw_attr_val, &at2->dw_attr_val, mark);
6103 }
6104
6105 /* Do the dies look the same? */
6106
6107 static int
same_die_p(dw_die_ref die1,dw_die_ref die2,int * mark)6108 same_die_p (dw_die_ref die1, dw_die_ref die2, int *mark)
6109 {
6110 dw_die_ref c1, c2;
6111 dw_attr_ref a1;
6112 unsigned ix;
6113
6114 /* To avoid infinite recursion. */
6115 if (die1->die_mark)
6116 return die1->die_mark == die2->die_mark;
6117 die1->die_mark = die2->die_mark = ++(*mark);
6118
6119 if (die1->die_tag != die2->die_tag)
6120 return 0;
6121
6122 if (VEC_length (dw_attr_node, die1->die_attr)
6123 != VEC_length (dw_attr_node, die2->die_attr))
6124 return 0;
6125
6126 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die1->die_attr, ix, a1); ix++)
6127 if (!same_attr_p (a1, VEC_index (dw_attr_node, die2->die_attr, ix), mark))
6128 return 0;
6129
6130 c1 = die1->die_child;
6131 c2 = die2->die_child;
6132 if (! c1)
6133 {
6134 if (c2)
6135 return 0;
6136 }
6137 else
6138 for (;;)
6139 {
6140 if (!same_die_p (c1, c2, mark))
6141 return 0;
6142 c1 = c1->die_sib;
6143 c2 = c2->die_sib;
6144 if (c1 == die1->die_child)
6145 {
6146 if (c2 == die2->die_child)
6147 break;
6148 else
6149 return 0;
6150 }
6151 }
6152
6153 return 1;
6154 }
6155
6156 /* Do the dies look the same? Wrapper around same_die_p. */
6157
6158 static int
same_die_p_wrap(dw_die_ref die1,dw_die_ref die2)6159 same_die_p_wrap (dw_die_ref die1, dw_die_ref die2)
6160 {
6161 int mark = 0;
6162 int ret = same_die_p (die1, die2, &mark);
6163
6164 unmark_all_dies (die1);
6165 unmark_all_dies (die2);
6166
6167 return ret;
6168 }
6169
6170 /* The prefix to attach to symbols on DIEs in the current comdat debug
6171 info section. */
6172 static char *comdat_symbol_id;
6173
6174 /* The index of the current symbol within the current comdat CU. */
6175 static unsigned int comdat_symbol_number;
6176
6177 /* Calculate the MD5 checksum of the compilation unit DIE UNIT_DIE and its
6178 children, and set comdat_symbol_id accordingly. */
6179
6180 static void
compute_section_prefix(dw_die_ref unit_die)6181 compute_section_prefix (dw_die_ref unit_die)
6182 {
6183 const char *die_name = get_AT_string (unit_die, DW_AT_name);
6184 const char *base = die_name ? lbasename (die_name) : "anonymous";
6185 char *name = alloca (strlen (base) + 64);
6186 char *p;
6187 int i, mark;
6188 unsigned char checksum[16];
6189 struct md5_ctx ctx;
6190
6191 /* Compute the checksum of the DIE, then append part of it as hex digits to
6192 the name filename of the unit. */
6193
6194 md5_init_ctx (&ctx);
6195 mark = 0;
6196 die_checksum (unit_die, &ctx, &mark);
6197 unmark_all_dies (unit_die);
6198 md5_finish_ctx (&ctx, checksum);
6199
6200 sprintf (name, "%s.", base);
6201 clean_symbol_name (name);
6202
6203 p = name + strlen (name);
6204 for (i = 0; i < 4; i++)
6205 {
6206 sprintf (p, "%.2x", checksum[i]);
6207 p += 2;
6208 }
6209
6210 comdat_symbol_id = unit_die->die_symbol = xstrdup (name);
6211 comdat_symbol_number = 0;
6212 }
6213
6214 /* Returns nonzero if DIE represents a type, in the sense of TYPE_P. */
6215
6216 static int
is_type_die(dw_die_ref die)6217 is_type_die (dw_die_ref die)
6218 {
6219 switch (die->die_tag)
6220 {
6221 case DW_TAG_array_type:
6222 case DW_TAG_class_type:
6223 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
6224 case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
6225 case DW_TAG_reference_type:
6226 case DW_TAG_string_type:
6227 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
6228 case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
6229 case DW_TAG_union_type:
6230 case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
6231 case DW_TAG_set_type:
6232 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
6233 case DW_TAG_base_type:
6234 case DW_TAG_const_type:
6235 case DW_TAG_file_type:
6236 case DW_TAG_packed_type:
6237 case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
6238 case DW_TAG_typedef:
6239 return 1;
6240 default:
6241 return 0;
6242 }
6243 }
6244
6245 /* Returns 1 iff C is the sort of DIE that should go into a COMDAT CU.
6246 Basically, we want to choose the bits that are likely to be shared between
6247 compilations (types) and leave out the bits that are specific to individual
6248 compilations (functions). */
6249
6250 static int
is_comdat_die(dw_die_ref c)6251 is_comdat_die (dw_die_ref c)
6252 {
6253 /* I think we want to leave base types and __vtbl_ptr_type in the main CU, as
6254 we do for stabs. The advantage is a greater likelihood of sharing between
6255 objects that don't include headers in the same order (and therefore would
6256 put the base types in a different comdat). jason 8/28/00 */
6257
6258 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_base_type)
6259 return 0;
6260
6261 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_pointer_type
6262 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_reference_type
6263 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_const_type
6264 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_volatile_type)
6265 {
6266 dw_die_ref t = get_AT_ref (c, DW_AT_type);
6267
6268 return t ? is_comdat_die (t) : 0;
6269 }
6270
6271 return is_type_die (c);
6272 }
6273
6274 /* Returns 1 iff C is the sort of DIE that might be referred to from another
6275 compilation unit. */
6276
6277 static int
is_symbol_die(dw_die_ref c)6278 is_symbol_die (dw_die_ref c)
6279 {
6280 return (is_type_die (c)
6281 || (get_AT (c, DW_AT_declaration)
6282 && !get_AT (c, DW_AT_specification))
6283 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace);
6284 }
6285
6286 static char *
gen_internal_sym(const char * prefix)6287 gen_internal_sym (const char *prefix)
6288 {
6289 char buf[256];
6290
6291 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (buf, prefix, label_num++);
6292 return xstrdup (buf);
6293 }
6294
6295 /* Assign symbols to all worthy DIEs under DIE. */
6296
6297 static void
assign_symbol_names(dw_die_ref die)6298 assign_symbol_names (dw_die_ref die)
6299 {
6300 dw_die_ref c;
6301
6302 if (is_symbol_die (die))
6303 {
6304 if (comdat_symbol_id)
6305 {
6306 char *p = alloca (strlen (comdat_symbol_id) + 64);
6307
6308 sprintf (p, "%s.%s.%x", DIE_LABEL_PREFIX,
6309 comdat_symbol_id, comdat_symbol_number++);
6310 die->die_symbol = xstrdup (p);
6311 }
6312 else
6313 die->die_symbol = gen_internal_sym ("LDIE");
6314 }
6315
6316 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, assign_symbol_names (c));
6317 }
6318
6319 struct cu_hash_table_entry
6320 {
6321 dw_die_ref cu;
6322 unsigned min_comdat_num, max_comdat_num;
6323 struct cu_hash_table_entry *next;
6324 };
6325
6326 /* Routines to manipulate hash table of CUs. */
6327 static hashval_t
htab_cu_hash(const void * of)6328 htab_cu_hash (const void *of)
6329 {
6330 const struct cu_hash_table_entry *entry = of;
6331
6332 return htab_hash_string (entry->cu->die_symbol);
6333 }
6334
6335 static int
htab_cu_eq(const void * of1,const void * of2)6336 htab_cu_eq (const void *of1, const void *of2)
6337 {
6338 const struct cu_hash_table_entry *entry1 = of1;
6339 const struct die_struct *entry2 = of2;
6340
6341 return !strcmp (entry1->cu->die_symbol, entry2->die_symbol);
6342 }
6343
6344 static void
htab_cu_del(void * what)6345 htab_cu_del (void *what)
6346 {
6347 struct cu_hash_table_entry *next, *entry = what;
6348
6349 while (entry)
6350 {
6351 next = entry->next;
6352 free (entry);
6353 entry = next;
6354 }
6355 }
6356
6357 /* Check whether we have already seen this CU and set up SYM_NUM
6358 accordingly. */
6359 static int
check_duplicate_cu(dw_die_ref cu,htab_t htable,unsigned int * sym_num)6360 check_duplicate_cu (dw_die_ref cu, htab_t htable, unsigned int *sym_num)
6361 {
6362 struct cu_hash_table_entry dummy;
6363 struct cu_hash_table_entry **slot, *entry, *last = &dummy;
6364
6365 dummy.max_comdat_num = 0;
6366
6367 slot = (struct cu_hash_table_entry **)
6368 htab_find_slot_with_hash (htable, cu, htab_hash_string (cu->die_symbol),
6369 INSERT);
6370 entry = *slot;
6371
6372 for (; entry; last = entry, entry = entry->next)
6373 {
6374 if (same_die_p_wrap (cu, entry->cu))
6375 break;
6376 }
6377
6378 if (entry)
6379 {
6380 *sym_num = entry->min_comdat_num;
6381 return 1;
6382 }
6383
6384 entry = XCNEW (struct cu_hash_table_entry);
6385 entry->cu = cu;
6386 entry->min_comdat_num = *sym_num = last->max_comdat_num;
6387 entry->next = *slot;
6388 *slot = entry;
6389
6390 return 0;
6391 }
6392
6393 /* Record SYM_NUM to record of CU in HTABLE. */
6394 static void
record_comdat_symbol_number(dw_die_ref cu,htab_t htable,unsigned int sym_num)6395 record_comdat_symbol_number (dw_die_ref cu, htab_t htable, unsigned int sym_num)
6396 {
6397 struct cu_hash_table_entry **slot, *entry;
6398
6399 slot = (struct cu_hash_table_entry **)
6400 htab_find_slot_with_hash (htable, cu, htab_hash_string (cu->die_symbol),
6401 NO_INSERT);
6402 entry = *slot;
6403
6404 entry->max_comdat_num = sym_num;
6405 }
6406
6407 /* Traverse the DIE (which is always comp_unit_die), and set up
6408 additional compilation units for each of the include files we see
6409 bracketed by BINCL/EINCL. */
6410
6411 static void
break_out_includes(dw_die_ref die)6412 break_out_includes (dw_die_ref die)
6413 {
6414 dw_die_ref c;
6415 dw_die_ref unit = NULL;
6416 limbo_die_node *node, **pnode;
6417 htab_t cu_hash_table;
6418
6419 c = die->die_child;
6420 if (c) do {
6421 dw_die_ref prev = c;
6422 c = c->die_sib;
6423 while (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL
6424 || (unit && is_comdat_die (c)))
6425 {
6426 dw_die_ref next = c->die_sib;
6427
6428 /* This DIE is for a secondary CU; remove it from the main one. */
6429 remove_child_with_prev (c, prev);
6430
6431 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL)
6432 unit = push_new_compile_unit (unit, c);
6433 else if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL)
6434 unit = pop_compile_unit (unit);
6435 else
6436 add_child_die (unit, c);
6437 c = next;
6438 if (c == die->die_child)
6439 break;
6440 }
6441 } while (c != die->die_child);
6442
6443 #if 0
6444 /* We can only use this in debugging, since the frontend doesn't check
6445 to make sure that we leave every include file we enter. */
6446 gcc_assert (!unit);
6447 #endif
6448
6449 assign_symbol_names (die);
6450 cu_hash_table = htab_create (10, htab_cu_hash, htab_cu_eq, htab_cu_del);
6451 for (node = limbo_die_list, pnode = &limbo_die_list;
6452 node;
6453 node = node->next)
6454 {
6455 int is_dupl;
6456
6457 compute_section_prefix (node->die);
6458 is_dupl = check_duplicate_cu (node->die, cu_hash_table,
6459 &comdat_symbol_number);
6460 assign_symbol_names (node->die);
6461 if (is_dupl)
6462 *pnode = node->next;
6463 else
6464 {
6465 pnode = &node->next;
6466 record_comdat_symbol_number (node->die, cu_hash_table,
6467 comdat_symbol_number);
6468 }
6469 }
6470 htab_delete (cu_hash_table);
6471 }
6472
6473 /* Traverse the DIE and add a sibling attribute if it may have the
6474 effect of speeding up access to siblings. To save some space,
6475 avoid generating sibling attributes for DIE's without children. */
6476
6477 static void
add_sibling_attributes(dw_die_ref die)6478 add_sibling_attributes (dw_die_ref die)
6479 {
6480 dw_die_ref c;
6481
6482 if (! die->die_child)
6483 return;
6484
6485 if (die->die_parent && die != die->die_parent->die_child)
6486 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_sibling, die->die_sib);
6487
6488 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, add_sibling_attributes (c));
6489 }
6490
6491 /* Output all location lists for the DIE and its children. */
6492
6493 static void
output_location_lists(dw_die_ref die)6494 output_location_lists (dw_die_ref die)
6495 {
6496 dw_die_ref c;
6497 dw_attr_ref a;
6498 unsigned ix;
6499
6500 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
6501 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list)
6502 output_loc_list (AT_loc_list (a));
6503
6504 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, output_location_lists (c));
6505 }
6506
6507 /* The format of each DIE (and its attribute value pairs) is encoded in an
6508 abbreviation table. This routine builds the abbreviation table and assigns
6509 a unique abbreviation id for each abbreviation entry. The children of each
6510 die are visited recursively. */
6511
6512 static void
build_abbrev_table(dw_die_ref die)6513 build_abbrev_table (dw_die_ref die)
6514 {
6515 unsigned long abbrev_id;
6516 unsigned int n_alloc;
6517 dw_die_ref c;
6518 dw_attr_ref a;
6519 unsigned ix;
6520
6521 /* Scan the DIE references, and mark as external any that refer to
6522 DIEs from other CUs (i.e. those which are not marked). */
6523 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
6524 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref
6525 && AT_ref (a)->die_mark == 0)
6526 {
6527 gcc_assert (AT_ref (a)->die_symbol);
6528
6529 set_AT_ref_external (a, 1);
6530 }
6531
6532 for (abbrev_id = 1; abbrev_id < abbrev_die_table_in_use; ++abbrev_id)
6533 {
6534 dw_die_ref abbrev = abbrev_die_table[abbrev_id];
6535 dw_attr_ref die_a, abbrev_a;
6536 unsigned ix;
6537 bool ok = true;
6538
6539 if (abbrev->die_tag != die->die_tag)
6540 continue;
6541 if ((abbrev->die_child != NULL) != (die->die_child != NULL))
6542 continue;
6543
6544 if (VEC_length (dw_attr_node, abbrev->die_attr)
6545 != VEC_length (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr))
6546 continue;
6547
6548 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, die_a); ix++)
6549 {
6550 abbrev_a = VEC_index (dw_attr_node, abbrev->die_attr, ix);
6551 if ((abbrev_a->dw_attr != die_a->dw_attr)
6552 || (value_format (abbrev_a) != value_format (die_a)))
6553 {
6554 ok = false;
6555 break;
6556 }
6557 }
6558 if (ok)
6559 break;
6560 }
6561
6562 if (abbrev_id >= abbrev_die_table_in_use)
6563 {
6564 if (abbrev_die_table_in_use >= abbrev_die_table_allocated)
6565 {
6566 n_alloc = abbrev_die_table_allocated + ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
6567 abbrev_die_table = ggc_realloc (abbrev_die_table,
6568 sizeof (dw_die_ref) * n_alloc);
6569
6570 memset (&abbrev_die_table[abbrev_die_table_allocated], 0,
6571 (n_alloc - abbrev_die_table_allocated) * sizeof (dw_die_ref));
6572 abbrev_die_table_allocated = n_alloc;
6573 }
6574
6575 ++abbrev_die_table_in_use;
6576 abbrev_die_table[abbrev_id] = die;
6577 }
6578
6579 die->die_abbrev = abbrev_id;
6580 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, build_abbrev_table (c));
6581 }
6582
6583 /* Return the power-of-two number of bytes necessary to represent VALUE. */
6584
6585 static int
constant_size(long unsigned int value)6586 constant_size (long unsigned int value)
6587 {
6588 int log;
6589
6590 if (value == 0)
6591 log = 0;
6592 else
6593 log = floor_log2 (value);
6594
6595 log = log / 8;
6596 log = 1 << (floor_log2 (log) + 1);
6597
6598 return log;
6599 }
6600
6601 /* Return the size of a DIE as it is represented in the
6602 .debug_info section. */
6603
6604 static unsigned long
size_of_die(dw_die_ref die)6605 size_of_die (dw_die_ref die)
6606 {
6607 unsigned long size = 0;
6608 dw_attr_ref a;
6609 unsigned ix;
6610
6611 size += size_of_uleb128 (die->die_abbrev);
6612 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
6613 {
6614 switch (AT_class (a))
6615 {
6616 case dw_val_class_addr:
6617 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
6618 break;
6619 case dw_val_class_offset:
6620 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6621 break;
6622 case dw_val_class_loc:
6623 {
6624 unsigned long lsize = size_of_locs (AT_loc (a));
6625
6626 /* Block length. */
6627 size += constant_size (lsize);
6628 size += lsize;
6629 }
6630 break;
6631 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
6632 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6633 break;
6634 case dw_val_class_range_list:
6635 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6636 break;
6637 case dw_val_class_const:
6638 size += size_of_sleb128 (AT_int (a));
6639 break;
6640 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
6641 size += constant_size (AT_unsigned (a));
6642 break;
6643 case dw_val_class_long_long:
6644 size += 1 + 2*HOST_BITS_PER_LONG/HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR; /* block */
6645 break;
6646 case dw_val_class_vec:
6647 size += 1 + (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length
6648 * a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size); /* block */
6649 break;
6650 case dw_val_class_flag:
6651 size += 1;
6652 break;
6653 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
6654 if (AT_ref_external (a))
6655 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
6656 else
6657 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6658 break;
6659 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
6660 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6661 break;
6662 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
6663 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
6664 break;
6665 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
6666 case dw_val_class_macptr:
6667 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6668 break;
6669 case dw_val_class_str:
6670 if (AT_string_form (a) == DW_FORM_strp)
6671 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6672 else
6673 size += strlen (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->str) + 1;
6674 break;
6675 case dw_val_class_file:
6676 size += constant_size (maybe_emit_file (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file));
6677 break;
6678 default:
6679 gcc_unreachable ();
6680 }
6681 }
6682
6683 return size;
6684 }
6685
6686 /* Size the debugging information associated with a given DIE. Visits the
6687 DIE's children recursively. Updates the global variable next_die_offset, on
6688 each time through. Uses the current value of next_die_offset to update the
6689 die_offset field in each DIE. */
6690
6691 static void
calc_die_sizes(dw_die_ref die)6692 calc_die_sizes (dw_die_ref die)
6693 {
6694 dw_die_ref c;
6695
6696 die->die_offset = next_die_offset;
6697 next_die_offset += size_of_die (die);
6698
6699 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, calc_die_sizes (c));
6700
6701 if (die->die_child != NULL)
6702 /* Count the null byte used to terminate sibling lists. */
6703 next_die_offset += 1;
6704 }
6705
6706 /* Set the marks for a die and its children. We do this so
6707 that we know whether or not a reference needs to use FORM_ref_addr; only
6708 DIEs in the same CU will be marked. We used to clear out the offset
6709 and use that as the flag, but ran into ordering problems. */
6710
6711 static void
mark_dies(dw_die_ref die)6712 mark_dies (dw_die_ref die)
6713 {
6714 dw_die_ref c;
6715
6716 gcc_assert (!die->die_mark);
6717
6718 die->die_mark = 1;
6719 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, mark_dies (c));
6720 }
6721
6722 /* Clear the marks for a die and its children. */
6723
6724 static void
unmark_dies(dw_die_ref die)6725 unmark_dies (dw_die_ref die)
6726 {
6727 dw_die_ref c;
6728
6729 gcc_assert (die->die_mark);
6730
6731 die->die_mark = 0;
6732 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, unmark_dies (c));
6733 }
6734
6735 /* Clear the marks for a die, its children and referred dies. */
6736
6737 static void
unmark_all_dies(dw_die_ref die)6738 unmark_all_dies (dw_die_ref die)
6739 {
6740 dw_die_ref c;
6741 dw_attr_ref a;
6742 unsigned ix;
6743
6744 if (!die->die_mark)
6745 return;
6746 die->die_mark = 0;
6747
6748 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, unmark_all_dies (c));
6749
6750 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
6751 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
6752 unmark_all_dies (AT_ref (a));
6753 }
6754
6755 /* Return the size of the .debug_pubnames or .debug_pubtypes table
6756 generated for the compilation unit. */
6757
6758 static unsigned long
size_of_pubnames(VEC (pubname_entry,gc)* names)6759 size_of_pubnames (VEC (pubname_entry, gc) * names)
6760 {
6761 unsigned long size;
6762 unsigned i;
6763 pubname_ref p;
6764
6765 size = DWARF_PUBNAMES_HEADER_SIZE;
6766 for (i = 0; VEC_iterate (pubname_entry, names, i, p); i++)
6767 if (names != pubtype_table
6768 || p->die->die_offset != 0
6769 || !flag_eliminate_unused_debug_types)
6770 size += strlen (p->name) + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 1;
6771
6772 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6773 return size;
6774 }
6775
6776 /* Return the size of the information in the .debug_aranges section. */
6777
6778 static unsigned long
size_of_aranges(void)6779 size_of_aranges (void)
6780 {
6781 unsigned long size;
6782
6783 size = DWARF_ARANGES_HEADER_SIZE;
6784
6785 /* Count the address/length pair for this compilation unit. */
6786 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
6787 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * arange_table_in_use;
6788
6789 /* Count the two zero words used to terminated the address range table. */
6790 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
6791 return size;
6792 }
6793
6794 /* Select the encoding of an attribute value. */
6795
6796 static enum dwarf_form
value_format(dw_attr_ref a)6797 value_format (dw_attr_ref a)
6798 {
6799 switch (a->dw_attr_val.val_class)
6800 {
6801 case dw_val_class_addr:
6802 return DW_FORM_addr;
6803 case dw_val_class_range_list:
6804 case dw_val_class_offset:
6805 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
6806 switch (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE)
6807 {
6808 case 4:
6809 return DW_FORM_data4;
6810 case 8:
6811 return DW_FORM_data8;
6812 default:
6813 gcc_unreachable ();
6814 }
6815 case dw_val_class_loc:
6816 switch (constant_size (size_of_locs (AT_loc (a))))
6817 {
6818 case 1:
6819 return DW_FORM_block1;
6820 case 2:
6821 return DW_FORM_block2;
6822 default:
6823 gcc_unreachable ();
6824 }
6825 case dw_val_class_const:
6826 return DW_FORM_sdata;
6827 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
6828 switch (constant_size (AT_unsigned (a)))
6829 {
6830 case 1:
6831 return DW_FORM_data1;
6832 case 2:
6833 return DW_FORM_data2;
6834 case 4:
6835 return DW_FORM_data4;
6836 case 8:
6837 return DW_FORM_data8;
6838 default:
6839 gcc_unreachable ();
6840 }
6841 case dw_val_class_long_long:
6842 return DW_FORM_block1;
6843 case dw_val_class_vec:
6844 return DW_FORM_block1;
6845 case dw_val_class_flag:
6846 return DW_FORM_flag;
6847 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
6848 if (AT_ref_external (a))
6849 return DW_FORM_ref_addr;
6850 else
6851 return DW_FORM_ref;
6852 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
6853 return DW_FORM_data;
6854 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
6855 return DW_FORM_addr;
6856 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
6857 case dw_val_class_macptr:
6858 return DW_FORM_data;
6859 case dw_val_class_str:
6860 return AT_string_form (a);
6861 case dw_val_class_file:
6862 switch (constant_size (maybe_emit_file (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file)))
6863 {
6864 case 1:
6865 return DW_FORM_data1;
6866 case 2:
6867 return DW_FORM_data2;
6868 case 4:
6869 return DW_FORM_data4;
6870 default:
6871 gcc_unreachable ();
6872 }
6873
6874 default:
6875 gcc_unreachable ();
6876 }
6877 }
6878
6879 /* Output the encoding of an attribute value. */
6880
6881 static void
output_value_format(dw_attr_ref a)6882 output_value_format (dw_attr_ref a)
6883 {
6884 enum dwarf_form form = value_format (a);
6885
6886 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (form, "(%s)", dwarf_form_name (form));
6887 }
6888
6889 /* Output the .debug_abbrev section which defines the DIE abbreviation
6890 table. */
6891
6892 static void
output_abbrev_section(void)6893 output_abbrev_section (void)
6894 {
6895 unsigned long abbrev_id;
6896
6897 for (abbrev_id = 1; abbrev_id < abbrev_die_table_in_use; ++abbrev_id)
6898 {
6899 dw_die_ref abbrev = abbrev_die_table[abbrev_id];
6900 unsigned ix;
6901 dw_attr_ref a_attr;
6902
6903 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (abbrev_id, "(abbrev code)");
6904 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (abbrev->die_tag, "(TAG: %s)",
6905 dwarf_tag_name (abbrev->die_tag));
6906
6907 if (abbrev->die_child != NULL)
6908 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_children_yes, "DW_children_yes");
6909 else
6910 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_children_no, "DW_children_no");
6911
6912 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, abbrev->die_attr, ix, a_attr);
6913 ix++)
6914 {
6915 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (a_attr->dw_attr, "(%s)",
6916 dwarf_attr_name (a_attr->dw_attr));
6917 output_value_format (a_attr);
6918 }
6919
6920 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL);
6921 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL);
6922 }
6923
6924 /* Terminate the table. */
6925 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL);
6926 }
6927
6928 /* Output a symbol we can use to refer to this DIE from another CU. */
6929
6930 static inline void
output_die_symbol(dw_die_ref die)6931 output_die_symbol (dw_die_ref die)
6932 {
6933 char *sym = die->die_symbol;
6934
6935 if (sym == 0)
6936 return;
6937
6938 if (strncmp (sym, DIE_LABEL_PREFIX, sizeof (DIE_LABEL_PREFIX) - 1) == 0)
6939 /* We make these global, not weak; if the target doesn't support
6940 .linkonce, it doesn't support combining the sections, so debugging
6941 will break. */
6942 targetm.asm_out.globalize_label (asm_out_file, sym);
6943
6944 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, sym);
6945 }
6946
6947 /* Return a new location list, given the begin and end range, and the
6948 expression. gensym tells us whether to generate a new internal symbol for
6949 this location list node, which is done for the head of the list only. */
6950
6951 static inline dw_loc_list_ref
new_loc_list(dw_loc_descr_ref expr,const char * begin,const char * end,const char * section,unsigned int gensym)6952 new_loc_list (dw_loc_descr_ref expr, const char *begin, const char *end,
6953 const char *section, unsigned int gensym)
6954 {
6955 dw_loc_list_ref retlist = ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (dw_loc_list_node));
6956
6957 retlist->begin = begin;
6958 retlist->end = end;
6959 retlist->expr = expr;
6960 retlist->section = section;
6961 if (gensym)
6962 retlist->ll_symbol = gen_internal_sym ("LLST");
6963
6964 return retlist;
6965 }
6966
6967 /* Add a location description expression to a location list. */
6968
6969 static inline void
add_loc_descr_to_loc_list(dw_loc_list_ref * list_head,dw_loc_descr_ref descr,const char * begin,const char * end,const char * section)6970 add_loc_descr_to_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref *list_head, dw_loc_descr_ref descr,
6971 const char *begin, const char *end,
6972 const char *section)
6973 {
6974 dw_loc_list_ref *d;
6975
6976 /* Find the end of the chain. */
6977 for (d = list_head; (*d) != NULL; d = &(*d)->dw_loc_next)
6978 ;
6979
6980 /* Add a new location list node to the list. */
6981 *d = new_loc_list (descr, begin, end, section, 0);
6982 }
6983
6984 static void
dwarf2out_switch_text_section(void)6985 dwarf2out_switch_text_section (void)
6986 {
6987 dw_fde_ref fde;
6988
6989 gcc_assert (cfun);
6990
6991 fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use - 1];
6992 fde->dw_fde_switched_sections = true;
6993 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_label = cfun->hot_section_label;
6994 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_end_label = cfun->hot_section_end_label;
6995 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_label = cfun->cold_section_label;
6996 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_end_label = cfun->cold_section_end_label;
6997 have_multiple_function_sections = true;
6998
6999 /* Reset the current label on switching text sections, so that we
7000 don't attempt to advance_loc4 between labels in different sections. */
7001 fde->dw_fde_current_label = NULL;
7002 }
7003
7004 /* Output the location list given to us. */
7005
7006 static void
output_loc_list(dw_loc_list_ref list_head)7007 output_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref list_head)
7008 {
7009 dw_loc_list_ref curr = list_head;
7010
7011 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, list_head->ll_symbol);
7012
7013 /* Walk the location list, and output each range + expression. */
7014 for (curr = list_head; curr != NULL; curr = curr->dw_loc_next)
7015 {
7016 unsigned long size;
7017 if (!have_multiple_function_sections)
7018 {
7019 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->begin, curr->section,
7020 "Location list begin address (%s)",
7021 list_head->ll_symbol);
7022 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->end, curr->section,
7023 "Location list end address (%s)",
7024 list_head->ll_symbol);
7025 }
7026 else
7027 {
7028 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->begin,
7029 "Location list begin address (%s)",
7030 list_head->ll_symbol);
7031 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->end,
7032 "Location list end address (%s)",
7033 list_head->ll_symbol);
7034 }
7035 size = size_of_locs (curr->expr);
7036
7037 /* Output the block length for this list of location operations. */
7038 gcc_assert (size <= 0xffff);
7039 dw2_asm_output_data (2, size, "%s", "Location expression size");
7040
7041 output_loc_sequence (curr->expr);
7042 }
7043
7044 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0,
7045 "Location list terminator begin (%s)",
7046 list_head->ll_symbol);
7047 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0,
7048 "Location list terminator end (%s)",
7049 list_head->ll_symbol);
7050 }
7051
7052 /* Output the DIE and its attributes. Called recursively to generate
7053 the definitions of each child DIE. */
7054
7055 static void
output_die(dw_die_ref die)7056 output_die (dw_die_ref die)
7057 {
7058 dw_attr_ref a;
7059 dw_die_ref c;
7060 unsigned long size;
7061 unsigned ix;
7062
7063 /* If someone in another CU might refer to us, set up a symbol for
7064 them to point to. */
7065 if (die->die_symbol)
7066 output_die_symbol (die);
7067
7068 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (die->die_abbrev, "(DIE (0x%lx) %s)",
7069 (unsigned long)die->die_offset,
7070 dwarf_tag_name (die->die_tag));
7071
7072 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
7073 {
7074 const char *name = dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr);
7075
7076 switch (AT_class (a))
7077 {
7078 case dw_val_class_addr:
7079 dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, AT_addr (a), "%s", name);
7080 break;
7081
7082 case dw_val_class_offset:
7083 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, a->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset,
7084 "%s", name);
7085 break;
7086
7087 case dw_val_class_range_list:
7088 {
7089 char *p = strchr (ranges_section_label, '\0');
7090
7091 sprintf (p, "+" HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_HEX,
7092 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset);
7093 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, ranges_section_label,
7094 debug_ranges_section, "%s", name);
7095 *p = '\0';
7096 }
7097 break;
7098
7099 case dw_val_class_loc:
7100 size = size_of_locs (AT_loc (a));
7101
7102 /* Output the block length for this list of location operations. */
7103 dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (size), size, "%s", name);
7104
7105 output_loc_sequence (AT_loc (a));
7106 break;
7107
7108 case dw_val_class_const:
7109 /* ??? It would be slightly more efficient to use a scheme like is
7110 used for unsigned constants below, but gdb 4.x does not sign
7111 extend. Gdb 5.x does sign extend. */
7112 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (AT_int (a), "%s", name);
7113 break;
7114
7115 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
7116 dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (AT_unsigned (a)),
7117 AT_unsigned (a), "%s", name);
7118 break;
7119
7120 case dw_val_class_long_long:
7121 {
7122 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT first, second;
7123
7124 dw2_asm_output_data (1,
7125 2 * HOST_BITS_PER_LONG / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
7126 "%s", name);
7127
7128 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
7129 {
7130 first = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.hi;
7131 second = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.low;
7132 }
7133 else
7134 {
7135 first = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.low;
7136 second = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.hi;
7137 }
7138
7139 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_LONG / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
7140 first, "long long constant");
7141 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_LONG / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
7142 second, NULL);
7143 }
7144 break;
7145
7146 case dw_val_class_vec:
7147 {
7148 unsigned int elt_size = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size;
7149 unsigned int len = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length;
7150 unsigned int i;
7151 unsigned char *p;
7152
7153 dw2_asm_output_data (1, len * elt_size, "%s", name);
7154 if (elt_size > sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT))
7155 {
7156 elt_size /= 2;
7157 len *= 2;
7158 }
7159 for (i = 0, p = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.array;
7160 i < len;
7161 i++, p += elt_size)
7162 dw2_asm_output_data (elt_size, extract_int (p, elt_size),
7163 "fp or vector constant word %u", i);
7164 break;
7165 }
7166
7167 case dw_val_class_flag:
7168 dw2_asm_output_data (1, AT_flag (a), "%s", name);
7169 break;
7170
7171 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
7172 {
7173 char *sym = AT_loc_list (a)->ll_symbol;
7174
7175 gcc_assert (sym);
7176 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, sym, debug_loc_section,
7177 "%s", name);
7178 }
7179 break;
7180
7181 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
7182 if (AT_ref_external (a))
7183 {
7184 char *sym = AT_ref (a)->die_symbol;
7185
7186 gcc_assert (sym);
7187 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, sym, debug_info_section,
7188 "%s", name);
7189 }
7190 else
7191 {
7192 gcc_assert (AT_ref (a)->die_offset);
7193 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, AT_ref (a)->die_offset,
7194 "%s", name);
7195 }
7196 break;
7197
7198 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
7199 {
7200 char l1[20];
7201
7202 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, FDE_LABEL,
7203 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_fde_index * 2);
7204 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l1, debug_frame_section,
7205 "%s", name);
7206 }
7207 break;
7208
7209 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
7210 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, AT_lbl (a), "%s", name);
7211 break;
7212
7213 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
7214 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, AT_lbl (a),
7215 debug_line_section, "%s", name);
7216 break;
7217
7218 case dw_val_class_macptr:
7219 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, AT_lbl (a),
7220 debug_macinfo_section, "%s", name);
7221 break;
7222
7223 case dw_val_class_str:
7224 if (AT_string_form (a) == DW_FORM_strp)
7225 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
7226 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->label,
7227 debug_str_section,
7228 "%s: \"%s\"", name, AT_string (a));
7229 else
7230 dw2_asm_output_nstring (AT_string (a), -1, "%s", name);
7231 break;
7232
7233 case dw_val_class_file:
7234 {
7235 int f = maybe_emit_file (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file);
7236
7237 dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (f), f, "%s (%s)", name,
7238 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file->filename);
7239 break;
7240 }
7241
7242 default:
7243 gcc_unreachable ();
7244 }
7245 }
7246
7247 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, output_die (c));
7248
7249 /* Add null byte to terminate sibling list. */
7250 if (die->die_child != NULL)
7251 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "end of children of DIE 0x%lx",
7252 (unsigned long) die->die_offset);
7253 }
7254
7255 /* Output the compilation unit that appears at the beginning of the
7256 .debug_info section, and precedes the DIE descriptions. */
7257
7258 static void
output_compilation_unit_header(void)7259 output_compilation_unit_header (void)
7260 {
7261 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
7262 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
7263 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
7264 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
7265 next_die_offset - DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE,
7266 "Length of Compilation Unit Info");
7267 dw2_asm_output_data (2, DWARF_VERSION, "DWARF version number");
7268 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, abbrev_section_label,
7269 debug_abbrev_section,
7270 "Offset Into Abbrev. Section");
7271 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Pointer Size (in bytes)");
7272 }
7273
7274 /* Output the compilation unit DIE and its children. */
7275
7276 static void
output_comp_unit(dw_die_ref die,int output_if_empty)7277 output_comp_unit (dw_die_ref die, int output_if_empty)
7278 {
7279 const char *secname;
7280 char *oldsym, *tmp;
7281
7282 /* Unless we are outputting main CU, we may throw away empty ones. */
7283 if (!output_if_empty && die->die_child == NULL)
7284 return;
7285
7286 /* Even if there are no children of this DIE, we must output the information
7287 about the compilation unit. Otherwise, on an empty translation unit, we
7288 will generate a present, but empty, .debug_info section. IRIX 6.5 `nm'
7289 will then complain when examining the file. First mark all the DIEs in
7290 this CU so we know which get local refs. */
7291 mark_dies (die);
7292
7293 build_abbrev_table (die);
7294
7295 /* Initialize the beginning DIE offset - and calculate sizes/offsets. */
7296 next_die_offset = DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE;
7297 calc_die_sizes (die);
7298
7299 oldsym = die->die_symbol;
7300 if (oldsym)
7301 {
7302 tmp = alloca (strlen (oldsym) + 24);
7303
7304 sprintf (tmp, ".gnu.linkonce.wi.%s", oldsym);
7305 secname = tmp;
7306 die->die_symbol = NULL;
7307 switch_to_section (get_section (secname, SECTION_DEBUG, NULL));
7308 }
7309 else
7310 switch_to_section (debug_info_section);
7311
7312 /* Output debugging information. */
7313 output_compilation_unit_header ();
7314 output_die (die);
7315
7316 /* Leave the marks on the main CU, so we can check them in
7317 output_pubnames. */
7318 if (oldsym)
7319 {
7320 unmark_dies (die);
7321 die->die_symbol = oldsym;
7322 }
7323 }
7324
7325 /* Return the DWARF2/3 pubname associated with a decl. */
7326
7327 static const char *
dwarf2_name(tree decl,int scope)7328 dwarf2_name (tree decl, int scope)
7329 {
7330 return lang_hooks.dwarf_name (decl, scope ? 1 : 0);
7331 }
7332
7333 /* Add a new entry to .debug_pubnames if appropriate. */
7334
7335 static void
add_pubname(tree decl,dw_die_ref die)7336 add_pubname (tree decl, dw_die_ref die)
7337 {
7338 pubname_entry e;
7339
7340 if (! TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
7341 return;
7342
7343 e.die = die;
7344 e.name = xstrdup (dwarf2_name (decl, 1));
7345 VEC_safe_push (pubname_entry, gc, pubname_table, &e);
7346 }
7347
7348 /* Add a new entry to .debug_pubtypes if appropriate. */
7349
7350 static void
add_pubtype(tree decl,dw_die_ref die)7351 add_pubtype (tree decl, dw_die_ref die)
7352 {
7353 pubname_entry e;
7354
7355 e.name = NULL;
7356 if ((TREE_PUBLIC (decl)
7357 || die->die_parent == comp_unit_die)
7358 && (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_typedef || COMPLETE_TYPE_P (decl)))
7359 {
7360 e.die = die;
7361 if (TYPE_P (decl))
7362 {
7363 if (TYPE_NAME (decl))
7364 {
7365 if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (decl)) == IDENTIFIER_NODE)
7366 e.name = xstrdup ((const char *) IDENTIFIER_POINTER
7367 (TYPE_NAME (decl)));
7368 else if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (decl)) == TYPE_DECL
7369 && DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (decl)))
7370 e.name = xstrdup ((const char *) IDENTIFIER_POINTER
7371 (DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (decl))));
7372 else
7373 e.name = xstrdup ((const char *) get_AT_string (die, DW_AT_name));
7374 }
7375 }
7376 else
7377 e.name = xstrdup (dwarf2_name (decl, 1));
7378
7379 /* If we don't have a name for the type, there's no point in adding
7380 it to the table. */
7381 if (e.name && e.name[0] != '\0')
7382 VEC_safe_push (pubname_entry, gc, pubtype_table, &e);
7383 }
7384 }
7385
7386 /* Output the public names table used to speed up access to externally
7387 visible names; or the public types table used to find type definitions. */
7388
7389 static void
output_pubnames(VEC (pubname_entry,gc)* names)7390 output_pubnames (VEC (pubname_entry, gc) * names)
7391 {
7392 unsigned i;
7393 unsigned long pubnames_length = size_of_pubnames (names);
7394 pubname_ref pub;
7395
7396 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
7397 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
7398 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
7399 if (names == pubname_table)
7400 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, pubnames_length,
7401 "Length of Public Names Info");
7402 else
7403 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, pubnames_length,
7404 "Length of Public Type Names Info");
7405 dw2_asm_output_data (2, DWARF_VERSION, "DWARF Version");
7406 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_info_section_label,
7407 debug_info_section,
7408 "Offset of Compilation Unit Info");
7409 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, next_die_offset,
7410 "Compilation Unit Length");
7411
7412 for (i = 0; VEC_iterate (pubname_entry, names, i, pub); i++)
7413 {
7414 /* We shouldn't see pubnames for DIEs outside of the main CU. */
7415 if (names == pubname_table)
7416 gcc_assert (pub->die->die_mark);
7417
7418 if (names != pubtype_table
7419 || pub->die->die_offset != 0
7420 || !flag_eliminate_unused_debug_types)
7421 {
7422 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, pub->die->die_offset,
7423 "DIE offset");
7424
7425 dw2_asm_output_nstring (pub->name, -1, "external name");
7426 }
7427 }
7428
7429 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, 0, NULL);
7430 }
7431
7432 /* Add a new entry to .debug_aranges if appropriate. */
7433
7434 static void
add_arange(tree decl,dw_die_ref die)7435 add_arange (tree decl, dw_die_ref die)
7436 {
7437 if (! DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl))
7438 return;
7439
7440 if (arange_table_in_use == arange_table_allocated)
7441 {
7442 arange_table_allocated += ARANGE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
7443 arange_table = ggc_realloc (arange_table,
7444 (arange_table_allocated
7445 * sizeof (dw_die_ref)));
7446 memset (arange_table + arange_table_in_use, 0,
7447 ARANGE_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (dw_die_ref));
7448 }
7449
7450 arange_table[arange_table_in_use++] = die;
7451 }
7452
7453 /* Output the information that goes into the .debug_aranges table.
7454 Namely, define the beginning and ending address range of the
7455 text section generated for this compilation unit. */
7456
7457 static void
output_aranges(void)7458 output_aranges (void)
7459 {
7460 unsigned i;
7461 unsigned long aranges_length = size_of_aranges ();
7462
7463 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
7464 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
7465 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
7466 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, aranges_length,
7467 "Length of Address Ranges Info");
7468 dw2_asm_output_data (2, DWARF_VERSION, "DWARF Version");
7469 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_info_section_label,
7470 debug_info_section,
7471 "Offset of Compilation Unit Info");
7472 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Size of Address");
7473 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "Size of Segment Descriptor");
7474
7475 /* We need to align to twice the pointer size here. */
7476 if (DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE)
7477 {
7478 /* Pad using a 2 byte words so that padding is correct for any
7479 pointer size. */
7480 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 0, "Pad to %d byte boundary",
7481 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
7482 for (i = 2; i < (unsigned) DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE; i += 2)
7483 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 0, NULL);
7484 }
7485
7486 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, text_section_label, "Address");
7487 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, text_end_label,
7488 text_section_label, "Length");
7489 if (flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition)
7490 {
7491 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, cold_text_section_label,
7492 "Address");
7493 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, cold_end_label,
7494 cold_text_section_label, "Length");
7495 }
7496
7497 for (i = 0; i < arange_table_in_use; i++)
7498 {
7499 dw_die_ref die = arange_table[i];
7500
7501 /* We shouldn't see aranges for DIEs outside of the main CU. */
7502 gcc_assert (die->die_mark);
7503
7504 if (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram)
7505 {
7506 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, get_AT_low_pc (die),
7507 "Address");
7508 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, get_AT_hi_pc (die),
7509 get_AT_low_pc (die), "Length");
7510 }
7511 else
7512 {
7513 /* A static variable; extract the symbol from DW_AT_location.
7514 Note that this code isn't currently hit, as we only emit
7515 aranges for functions (jason 9/23/99). */
7516 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, DW_AT_location);
7517 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
7518
7519 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc);
7520
7521 loc = AT_loc (a);
7522 gcc_assert (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_addr);
7523
7524 dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
7525 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr, "Address");
7526 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
7527 get_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_byte_size),
7528 "Length");
7529 }
7530 }
7531
7532 /* Output the terminator words. */
7533 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
7534 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
7535 }
7536
7537 /* Add a new entry to .debug_ranges. Return the offset at which it
7538 was placed. */
7539
7540 static unsigned int
add_ranges(tree block)7541 add_ranges (tree block)
7542 {
7543 unsigned int in_use = ranges_table_in_use;
7544
7545 if (in_use == ranges_table_allocated)
7546 {
7547 ranges_table_allocated += RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT;
7548 ranges_table
7549 = ggc_realloc (ranges_table, (ranges_table_allocated
7550 * sizeof (struct dw_ranges_struct)));
7551 memset (ranges_table + ranges_table_in_use, 0,
7552 RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (struct dw_ranges_struct));
7553 }
7554
7555 ranges_table[in_use].block_num = (block ? BLOCK_NUMBER (block) : 0);
7556 ranges_table_in_use = in_use + 1;
7557
7558 return in_use * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
7559 }
7560
7561 static void
output_ranges(void)7562 output_ranges (void)
7563 {
7564 unsigned i;
7565 static const char *const start_fmt = "Offset 0x%x";
7566 const char *fmt = start_fmt;
7567
7568 for (i = 0; i < ranges_table_in_use; i++)
7569 {
7570 int block_num = ranges_table[i].block_num;
7571
7572 if (block_num)
7573 {
7574 char blabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
7575 char elabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
7576
7577 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (blabel, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL, block_num);
7578 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (elabel, BLOCK_END_LABEL, block_num);
7579
7580 /* If all code is in the text section, then the compilation
7581 unit base address defaults to DW_AT_low_pc, which is the
7582 base of the text section. */
7583 if (!have_multiple_function_sections)
7584 {
7585 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, blabel,
7586 text_section_label,
7587 fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
7588 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, elabel,
7589 text_section_label, NULL);
7590 }
7591
7592 /* Otherwise, we add a DW_AT_entry_pc attribute to force the
7593 compilation unit base address to zero, which allows us to
7594 use absolute addresses, and not worry about whether the
7595 target supports cross-section arithmetic. */
7596 else
7597 {
7598 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, blabel,
7599 fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
7600 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, elabel, NULL);
7601 }
7602
7603 fmt = NULL;
7604 }
7605 else
7606 {
7607 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
7608 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
7609 fmt = start_fmt;
7610 }
7611 }
7612 }
7613
7614 /* Data structure containing information about input files. */
7615 struct file_info
7616 {
7617 const char *path; /* Complete file name. */
7618 const char *fname; /* File name part. */
7619 int length; /* Length of entire string. */
7620 struct dwarf_file_data * file_idx; /* Index in input file table. */
7621 int dir_idx; /* Index in directory table. */
7622 };
7623
7624 /* Data structure containing information about directories with source
7625 files. */
7626 struct dir_info
7627 {
7628 const char *path; /* Path including directory name. */
7629 int length; /* Path length. */
7630 int prefix; /* Index of directory entry which is a prefix. */
7631 int count; /* Number of files in this directory. */
7632 int dir_idx; /* Index of directory used as base. */
7633 };
7634
7635 /* Callback function for file_info comparison. We sort by looking at
7636 the directories in the path. */
7637
7638 static int
file_info_cmp(const void * p1,const void * p2)7639 file_info_cmp (const void *p1, const void *p2)
7640 {
7641 const struct file_info *s1 = p1;
7642 const struct file_info *s2 = p2;
7643 unsigned char *cp1;
7644 unsigned char *cp2;
7645
7646 /* Take care of file names without directories. We need to make sure that
7647 we return consistent values to qsort since some will get confused if
7648 we return the same value when identical operands are passed in opposite
7649 orders. So if neither has a directory, return 0 and otherwise return
7650 1 or -1 depending on which one has the directory. */
7651 if ((s1->path == s1->fname || s2->path == s2->fname))
7652 return (s2->path == s2->fname) - (s1->path == s1->fname);
7653
7654 cp1 = (unsigned char *) s1->path;
7655 cp2 = (unsigned char *) s2->path;
7656
7657 while (1)
7658 {
7659 ++cp1;
7660 ++cp2;
7661 /* Reached the end of the first path? If so, handle like above. */
7662 if ((cp1 == (unsigned char *) s1->fname)
7663 || (cp2 == (unsigned char *) s2->fname))
7664 return ((cp2 == (unsigned char *) s2->fname)
7665 - (cp1 == (unsigned char *) s1->fname));
7666
7667 /* Character of current path component the same? */
7668 else if (*cp1 != *cp2)
7669 return *cp1 - *cp2;
7670 }
7671 }
7672
7673 struct file_name_acquire_data
7674 {
7675 struct file_info *files;
7676 int used_files;
7677 int max_files;
7678 };
7679
7680 /* Traversal function for the hash table. */
7681
7682 static int
file_name_acquire(void ** slot,void * data)7683 file_name_acquire (void ** slot, void *data)
7684 {
7685 struct file_name_acquire_data *fnad = data;
7686 struct dwarf_file_data *d = *slot;
7687 struct file_info *fi;
7688 const char *f;
7689
7690 gcc_assert (fnad->max_files >= d->emitted_number);
7691
7692 if (! d->emitted_number)
7693 return 1;
7694
7695 gcc_assert (fnad->max_files != fnad->used_files);
7696
7697 fi = fnad->files + fnad->used_files++;
7698
7699 /* Skip all leading "./". */
7700 f = d->filename;
7701 while (f[0] == '.' && f[1] == '/')
7702 f += 2;
7703
7704 /* Create a new array entry. */
7705 fi->path = f;
7706 fi->length = strlen (f);
7707 fi->file_idx = d;
7708
7709 /* Search for the file name part. */
7710 f = strrchr (f, '/');
7711 fi->fname = f == NULL ? fi->path : f + 1;
7712 return 1;
7713 }
7714
7715 /* Output the directory table and the file name table. We try to minimize
7716 the total amount of memory needed. A heuristic is used to avoid large
7717 slowdowns with many input files. */
7718
7719 static void
output_file_names(void)7720 output_file_names (void)
7721 {
7722 struct file_name_acquire_data fnad;
7723 int numfiles;
7724 struct file_info *files;
7725 struct dir_info *dirs;
7726 int *saved;
7727 int *savehere;
7728 int *backmap;
7729 int ndirs;
7730 int idx_offset;
7731 int i;
7732 int idx;
7733
7734 if (!last_emitted_file)
7735 {
7736 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End directory table");
7737 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End file name table");
7738 return;
7739 }
7740
7741 numfiles = last_emitted_file->emitted_number;
7742
7743 /* Allocate the various arrays we need. */
7744 files = alloca (numfiles * sizeof (struct file_info));
7745 dirs = alloca (numfiles * sizeof (struct dir_info));
7746
7747 fnad.files = files;
7748 fnad.used_files = 0;
7749 fnad.max_files = numfiles;
7750 htab_traverse (file_table, file_name_acquire, &fnad);
7751 gcc_assert (fnad.used_files == fnad.max_files);
7752
7753 qsort (files, numfiles, sizeof (files[0]), file_info_cmp);
7754
7755 /* Find all the different directories used. */
7756 dirs[0].path = files[0].path;
7757 dirs[0].length = files[0].fname - files[0].path;
7758 dirs[0].prefix = -1;
7759 dirs[0].count = 1;
7760 dirs[0].dir_idx = 0;
7761 files[0].dir_idx = 0;
7762 ndirs = 1;
7763
7764 for (i = 1; i < numfiles; i++)
7765 if (files[i].fname - files[i].path == dirs[ndirs - 1].length
7766 && memcmp (dirs[ndirs - 1].path, files[i].path,
7767 dirs[ndirs - 1].length) == 0)
7768 {
7769 /* Same directory as last entry. */
7770 files[i].dir_idx = ndirs - 1;
7771 ++dirs[ndirs - 1].count;
7772 }
7773 else
7774 {
7775 int j;
7776
7777 /* This is a new directory. */
7778 dirs[ndirs].path = files[i].path;
7779 dirs[ndirs].length = files[i].fname - files[i].path;
7780 dirs[ndirs].count = 1;
7781 dirs[ndirs].dir_idx = ndirs;
7782 files[i].dir_idx = ndirs;
7783
7784 /* Search for a prefix. */
7785 dirs[ndirs].prefix = -1;
7786 for (j = 0; j < ndirs; j++)
7787 if (dirs[j].length < dirs[ndirs].length
7788 && dirs[j].length > 1
7789 && (dirs[ndirs].prefix == -1
7790 || dirs[j].length > dirs[dirs[ndirs].prefix].length)
7791 && memcmp (dirs[j].path, dirs[ndirs].path, dirs[j].length) == 0)
7792 dirs[ndirs].prefix = j;
7793
7794 ++ndirs;
7795 }
7796
7797 /* Now to the actual work. We have to find a subset of the directories which
7798 allow expressing the file name using references to the directory table
7799 with the least amount of characters. We do not do an exhaustive search
7800 where we would have to check out every combination of every single
7801 possible prefix. Instead we use a heuristic which provides nearly optimal
7802 results in most cases and never is much off. */
7803 saved = alloca (ndirs * sizeof (int));
7804 savehere = alloca (ndirs * sizeof (int));
7805
7806 memset (saved, '\0', ndirs * sizeof (saved[0]));
7807 for (i = 0; i < ndirs; i++)
7808 {
7809 int j;
7810 int total;
7811
7812 /* We can always save some space for the current directory. But this
7813 does not mean it will be enough to justify adding the directory. */
7814 savehere[i] = dirs[i].length;
7815 total = (savehere[i] - saved[i]) * dirs[i].count;
7816
7817 for (j = i + 1; j < ndirs; j++)
7818 {
7819 savehere[j] = 0;
7820 if (saved[j] < dirs[i].length)
7821 {
7822 /* Determine whether the dirs[i] path is a prefix of the
7823 dirs[j] path. */
7824 int k;
7825
7826 k = dirs[j].prefix;
7827 while (k != -1 && k != (int) i)
7828 k = dirs[k].prefix;
7829
7830 if (k == (int) i)
7831 {
7832 /* Yes it is. We can possibly save some memory by
7833 writing the filenames in dirs[j] relative to
7834 dirs[i]. */
7835 savehere[j] = dirs[i].length;
7836 total += (savehere[j] - saved[j]) * dirs[j].count;
7837 }
7838 }
7839 }
7840
7841 /* Check whether we can save enough to justify adding the dirs[i]
7842 directory. */
7843 if (total > dirs[i].length + 1)
7844 {
7845 /* It's worthwhile adding. */
7846 for (j = i; j < ndirs; j++)
7847 if (savehere[j] > 0)
7848 {
7849 /* Remember how much we saved for this directory so far. */
7850 saved[j] = savehere[j];
7851
7852 /* Remember the prefix directory. */
7853 dirs[j].dir_idx = i;
7854 }
7855 }
7856 }
7857
7858 /* Emit the directory name table. */
7859 idx = 1;
7860 idx_offset = dirs[0].length > 0 ? 1 : 0;
7861 for (i = 1 - idx_offset; i < ndirs; i++)
7862 dw2_asm_output_nstring (dirs[i].path, dirs[i].length - 1,
7863 "Directory Entry: 0x%x", i + idx_offset);
7864
7865 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End directory table");
7866
7867 /* We have to emit them in the order of emitted_number since that's
7868 used in the debug info generation. To do this efficiently we
7869 generate a back-mapping of the indices first. */
7870 backmap = alloca (numfiles * sizeof (int));
7871 for (i = 0; i < numfiles; i++)
7872 backmap[files[i].file_idx->emitted_number - 1] = i;
7873
7874 /* Now write all the file names. */
7875 for (i = 0; i < numfiles; i++)
7876 {
7877 int file_idx = backmap[i];
7878 int dir_idx = dirs[files[file_idx].dir_idx].dir_idx;
7879
7880 dw2_asm_output_nstring (files[file_idx].path + dirs[dir_idx].length, -1,
7881 "File Entry: 0x%x", (unsigned) i + 1);
7882
7883 /* Include directory index. */
7884 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (dir_idx + idx_offset, NULL);
7885
7886 /* Modification time. */
7887 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, NULL);
7888
7889 /* File length in bytes. */
7890 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, NULL);
7891 }
7892
7893 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End file name table");
7894 }
7895
7896
7897 /* Output the source line number correspondence information. This
7898 information goes into the .debug_line section. */
7899
7900 static void
output_line_info(void)7901 output_line_info (void)
7902 {
7903 char l1[20], l2[20], p1[20], p2[20];
7904 char line_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
7905 char prev_line_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
7906 unsigned opc;
7907 unsigned n_op_args;
7908 unsigned long lt_index;
7909 unsigned long current_line;
7910 long line_offset;
7911 long line_delta;
7912 unsigned long current_file;
7913 unsigned long function;
7914
7915 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, LINE_NUMBER_BEGIN_LABEL, 0);
7916 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, LINE_NUMBER_END_LABEL, 0);
7917 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (p1, LN_PROLOG_AS_LABEL, 0);
7918 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (p2, LN_PROLOG_END_LABEL, 0);
7919
7920 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
7921 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
7922 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
7923 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
7924 "Length of Source Line Info");
7925 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
7926
7927 dw2_asm_output_data (2, DWARF_VERSION, "DWARF Version");
7928 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, p2, p1, "Prolog Length");
7929 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, p1);
7930
7931 /* Define the architecture-dependent minimum instruction length (in
7932 bytes). In this implementation of DWARF, this field is used for
7933 information purposes only. Since GCC generates assembly language,
7934 we have no a priori knowledge of how many instruction bytes are
7935 generated for each source line, and therefore can use only the
7936 DW_LNE_set_address and DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc line information
7937 commands. Accordingly, we fix this as `1', which is "correct
7938 enough" for all architectures, and don't let the target override. */
7939 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 1,
7940 "Minimum Instruction Length");
7941
7942 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START,
7943 "Default is_stmt_start flag");
7944 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_BASE,
7945 "Line Base Value (Special Opcodes)");
7946 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_RANGE,
7947 "Line Range Value (Special Opcodes)");
7948 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE,
7949 "Special Opcode Base");
7950
7951 for (opc = 1; opc < DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE; opc++)
7952 {
7953 switch (opc)
7954 {
7955 case DW_LNS_advance_pc:
7956 case DW_LNS_advance_line:
7957 case DW_LNS_set_file:
7958 case DW_LNS_set_column:
7959 case DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc:
7960 n_op_args = 1;
7961 break;
7962 default:
7963 n_op_args = 0;
7964 break;
7965 }
7966
7967 dw2_asm_output_data (1, n_op_args, "opcode: 0x%x has %d args",
7968 opc, n_op_args);
7969 }
7970
7971 /* Write out the information about the files we use. */
7972 output_file_names ();
7973 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, p2);
7974
7975 /* We used to set the address register to the first location in the text
7976 section here, but that didn't accomplish anything since we already
7977 have a line note for the opening brace of the first function. */
7978
7979 /* Generate the line number to PC correspondence table, encoded as
7980 a series of state machine operations. */
7981 current_file = 1;
7982 current_line = 1;
7983
7984 if (cfun && in_cold_section_p)
7985 strcpy (prev_line_label, cfun->cold_section_label);
7986 else
7987 strcpy (prev_line_label, text_section_label);
7988 for (lt_index = 1; lt_index < line_info_table_in_use; ++lt_index)
7989 {
7990 dw_line_info_ref line_info = &line_info_table[lt_index];
7991
7992 #if 0
7993 /* Disable this optimization for now; GDB wants to see two line notes
7994 at the beginning of a function so it can find the end of the
7995 prologue. */
7996
7997 /* Don't emit anything for redundant notes. Just updating the
7998 address doesn't accomplish anything, because we already assume
7999 that anything after the last address is this line. */
8000 if (line_info->dw_line_num == current_line
8001 && line_info->dw_file_num == current_file)
8002 continue;
8003 #endif
8004
8005 /* Emit debug info for the address of the current line.
8006
8007 Unfortunately, we have little choice here currently, and must always
8008 use the most general form. GCC does not know the address delta
8009 itself, so we can't use DW_LNS_advance_pc. Many ports do have length
8010 attributes which will give an upper bound on the address range. We
8011 could perhaps use length attributes to determine when it is safe to
8012 use DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc. */
8013
8014 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (line_label, LINE_CODE_LABEL, lt_index);
8015 if (0)
8016 {
8017 /* This can handle deltas up to 0xffff. This takes 3 bytes. */
8018 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc,
8019 "DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc");
8020 dw2_asm_output_delta (2, line_label, prev_line_label, NULL);
8021 }
8022 else
8023 {
8024 /* This can handle any delta. This takes
8025 4+DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE bytes. */
8026 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
8027 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
8028 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
8029 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, line_label, NULL);
8030 }
8031
8032 strcpy (prev_line_label, line_label);
8033
8034 /* Emit debug info for the source file of the current line, if
8035 different from the previous line. */
8036 if (line_info->dw_file_num != current_file)
8037 {
8038 current_file = line_info->dw_file_num;
8039 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_set_file, "DW_LNS_set_file");
8040 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (current_file, "%lu", current_file);
8041 }
8042
8043 /* Emit debug info for the current line number, choosing the encoding
8044 that uses the least amount of space. */
8045 if (line_info->dw_line_num != current_line)
8046 {
8047 line_offset = line_info->dw_line_num - current_line;
8048 line_delta = line_offset - DWARF_LINE_BASE;
8049 current_line = line_info->dw_line_num;
8050 if (line_delta >= 0 && line_delta < (DWARF_LINE_RANGE - 1))
8051 /* This can handle deltas from -10 to 234, using the current
8052 definitions of DWARF_LINE_BASE and DWARF_LINE_RANGE. This
8053 takes 1 byte. */
8054 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE + line_delta,
8055 "line %lu", current_line);
8056 else
8057 {
8058 /* This can handle any delta. This takes at least 4 bytes,
8059 depending on the value being encoded. */
8060 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_advance_line,
8061 "advance to line %lu", current_line);
8062 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (line_offset, NULL);
8063 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy, "DW_LNS_copy");
8064 }
8065 }
8066 else
8067 /* We still need to start a new row, so output a copy insn. */
8068 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy, "DW_LNS_copy");
8069 }
8070
8071 /* Emit debug info for the address of the end of the function. */
8072 if (0)
8073 {
8074 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc,
8075 "DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc");
8076 dw2_asm_output_delta (2, text_end_label, prev_line_label, NULL);
8077 }
8078 else
8079 {
8080 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
8081 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
8082 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
8083 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, text_end_label, NULL);
8084 }
8085
8086 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_end_sequence");
8087 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1, NULL);
8088 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_end_sequence, NULL);
8089
8090 function = 0;
8091 current_file = 1;
8092 current_line = 1;
8093 for (lt_index = 0; lt_index < separate_line_info_table_in_use;)
8094 {
8095 dw_separate_line_info_ref line_info
8096 = &separate_line_info_table[lt_index];
8097
8098 #if 0
8099 /* Don't emit anything for redundant notes. */
8100 if (line_info->dw_line_num == current_line
8101 && line_info->dw_file_num == current_file
8102 && line_info->function == function)
8103 goto cont;
8104 #endif
8105
8106 /* Emit debug info for the address of the current line. If this is
8107 a new function, or the first line of a function, then we need
8108 to handle it differently. */
8109 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (line_label, SEPARATE_LINE_CODE_LABEL,
8110 lt_index);
8111 if (function != line_info->function)
8112 {
8113 function = line_info->function;
8114
8115 /* Set the address register to the first line in the function. */
8116 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
8117 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
8118 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
8119 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, line_label, NULL);
8120 }
8121 else
8122 {
8123 /* ??? See the DW_LNS_advance_pc comment above. */
8124 if (0)
8125 {
8126 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc,
8127 "DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc");
8128 dw2_asm_output_delta (2, line_label, prev_line_label, NULL);
8129 }
8130 else
8131 {
8132 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
8133 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
8134 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
8135 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, line_label, NULL);
8136 }
8137 }
8138
8139 strcpy (prev_line_label, line_label);
8140
8141 /* Emit debug info for the source file of the current line, if
8142 different from the previous line. */
8143 if (line_info->dw_file_num != current_file)
8144 {
8145 current_file = line_info->dw_file_num;
8146 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_set_file, "DW_LNS_set_file");
8147 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (current_file, "%lu", current_file);
8148 }
8149
8150 /* Emit debug info for the current line number, choosing the encoding
8151 that uses the least amount of space. */
8152 if (line_info->dw_line_num != current_line)
8153 {
8154 line_offset = line_info->dw_line_num - current_line;
8155 line_delta = line_offset - DWARF_LINE_BASE;
8156 current_line = line_info->dw_line_num;
8157 if (line_delta >= 0 && line_delta < (DWARF_LINE_RANGE - 1))
8158 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE + line_delta,
8159 "line %lu", current_line);
8160 else
8161 {
8162 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_advance_line,
8163 "advance to line %lu", current_line);
8164 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (line_offset, NULL);
8165 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy, "DW_LNS_copy");
8166 }
8167 }
8168 else
8169 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy, "DW_LNS_copy");
8170
8171 #if 0
8172 cont:
8173 #endif
8174
8175 lt_index++;
8176
8177 /* If we're done with a function, end its sequence. */
8178 if (lt_index == separate_line_info_table_in_use
8179 || separate_line_info_table[lt_index].function != function)
8180 {
8181 current_file = 1;
8182 current_line = 1;
8183
8184 /* Emit debug info for the address of the end of the function. */
8185 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (line_label, FUNC_END_LABEL, function);
8186 if (0)
8187 {
8188 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc,
8189 "DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc");
8190 dw2_asm_output_delta (2, line_label, prev_line_label, NULL);
8191 }
8192 else
8193 {
8194 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
8195 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
8196 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
8197 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, line_label, NULL);
8198 }
8199
8200 /* Output the marker for the end of this sequence. */
8201 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_end_sequence");
8202 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1, NULL);
8203 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_end_sequence, NULL);
8204 }
8205 }
8206
8207 /* Output the marker for the end of the line number info. */
8208 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
8209 }
8210
8211 /* Given a pointer to a tree node for some base type, return a pointer to
8212 a DIE that describes the given type.
8213
8214 This routine must only be called for GCC type nodes that correspond to
8215 Dwarf base (fundamental) types. */
8216
8217 static dw_die_ref
base_type_die(tree type)8218 base_type_die (tree type)
8219 {
8220 dw_die_ref base_type_result;
8221 enum dwarf_type encoding;
8222
8223 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ERROR_MARK || TREE_CODE (type) == VOID_TYPE)
8224 return 0;
8225
8226 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
8227 {
8228 case INTEGER_TYPE:
8229 if (TYPE_STRING_FLAG (type))
8230 {
8231 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
8232 encoding = DW_ATE_unsigned_char;
8233 else
8234 encoding = DW_ATE_signed_char;
8235 }
8236 else if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
8237 encoding = DW_ATE_unsigned;
8238 else
8239 encoding = DW_ATE_signed;
8240 break;
8241
8242 case REAL_TYPE:
8243 if (DECIMAL_FLOAT_MODE_P (TYPE_MODE (type)))
8244 encoding = DW_ATE_decimal_float;
8245 else
8246 encoding = DW_ATE_float;
8247 break;
8248
8249 /* Dwarf2 doesn't know anything about complex ints, so use
8250 a user defined type for it. */
8251 case COMPLEX_TYPE:
8252 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (type)) == REAL_TYPE)
8253 encoding = DW_ATE_complex_float;
8254 else
8255 encoding = DW_ATE_lo_user;
8256 break;
8257
8258 case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
8259 /* GNU FORTRAN/Ada/C++ BOOLEAN type. */
8260 encoding = DW_ATE_boolean;
8261 break;
8262
8263 default:
8264 /* No other TREE_CODEs are Dwarf fundamental types. */
8265 gcc_unreachable ();
8266 }
8267
8268 base_type_result = new_die (DW_TAG_base_type, comp_unit_die, type);
8269
8270 /* This probably indicates a bug. */
8271 if (! TYPE_NAME (type))
8272 add_name_attribute (base_type_result, "__unknown__");
8273
8274 add_AT_unsigned (base_type_result, DW_AT_byte_size,
8275 int_size_in_bytes (type));
8276 add_AT_unsigned (base_type_result, DW_AT_encoding, encoding);
8277
8278 return base_type_result;
8279 }
8280
8281 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return a pointer to
8282 the Dwarf "root" type for the given input type. The Dwarf "root" type of
8283 a given type is generally the same as the given type, except that if the
8284 given type is a pointer or reference type, then the root type of the given
8285 type is the root type of the "basis" type for the pointer or reference
8286 type. (This definition of the "root" type is recursive.) Also, the root
8287 type of a `const' qualified type or a `volatile' qualified type is the
8288 root type of the given type without the qualifiers. */
8289
8290 static tree
root_type(tree type)8291 root_type (tree type)
8292 {
8293 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ERROR_MARK)
8294 return error_mark_node;
8295
8296 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
8297 {
8298 case ERROR_MARK:
8299 return error_mark_node;
8300
8301 case POINTER_TYPE:
8302 case REFERENCE_TYPE:
8303 return type_main_variant (root_type (TREE_TYPE (type)));
8304
8305 default:
8306 return type_main_variant (type);
8307 }
8308 }
8309
8310 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return nonzero if the
8311 given input type is a Dwarf "fundamental" type. Otherwise return null. */
8312
8313 static inline int
is_base_type(tree type)8314 is_base_type (tree type)
8315 {
8316 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
8317 {
8318 case ERROR_MARK:
8319 case VOID_TYPE:
8320 case INTEGER_TYPE:
8321 case REAL_TYPE:
8322 case COMPLEX_TYPE:
8323 case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
8324 return 1;
8325
8326 case ARRAY_TYPE:
8327 case RECORD_TYPE:
8328 case UNION_TYPE:
8329 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
8330 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
8331 case FUNCTION_TYPE:
8332 case METHOD_TYPE:
8333 case POINTER_TYPE:
8334 case REFERENCE_TYPE:
8335 case OFFSET_TYPE:
8336 case LANG_TYPE:
8337 case VECTOR_TYPE:
8338 return 0;
8339
8340 default:
8341 gcc_unreachable ();
8342 }
8343
8344 return 0;
8345 }
8346
8347 /* Given a pointer to a tree node, assumed to be some kind of a ..._TYPE
8348 node, return the size in bits for the type if it is a constant, or else
8349 return the alignment for the type if the type's size is not constant, or
8350 else return BITS_PER_WORD if the type actually turns out to be an
8351 ERROR_MARK node. */
8352
8353 static inline unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
simple_type_size_in_bits(tree type)8354 simple_type_size_in_bits (tree type)
8355 {
8356 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ERROR_MARK)
8357 return BITS_PER_WORD;
8358 else if (TYPE_SIZE (type) == NULL_TREE)
8359 return 0;
8360 else if (host_integerp (TYPE_SIZE (type), 1))
8361 return tree_low_cst (TYPE_SIZE (type), 1);
8362 else
8363 return TYPE_ALIGN (type);
8364 }
8365
8366 /* Return true if the debug information for the given type should be
8367 emitted as a subrange type. */
8368
8369 static inline bool
is_subrange_type(tree type)8370 is_subrange_type (tree type)
8371 {
8372 tree subtype = TREE_TYPE (type);
8373
8374 /* Subrange types are identified by the fact that they are integer
8375 types, and that they have a subtype which is either an integer type
8376 or an enumeral type. */
8377
8378 if (TREE_CODE (type) != INTEGER_TYPE
8379 || subtype == NULL_TREE)
8380 return false;
8381
8382 if (TREE_CODE (subtype) != INTEGER_TYPE
8383 && TREE_CODE (subtype) != ENUMERAL_TYPE)
8384 return false;
8385
8386 if (TREE_CODE (type) == TREE_CODE (subtype)
8387 && int_size_in_bytes (type) == int_size_in_bytes (subtype)
8388 && TYPE_MIN_VALUE (type) != NULL
8389 && TYPE_MIN_VALUE (subtype) != NULL
8390 && tree_int_cst_equal (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (type), TYPE_MIN_VALUE (subtype))
8391 && TYPE_MAX_VALUE (type) != NULL
8392 && TYPE_MAX_VALUE (subtype) != NULL
8393 && tree_int_cst_equal (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (type), TYPE_MAX_VALUE (subtype)))
8394 {
8395 /* The type and its subtype have the same representation. If in
8396 addition the two types also have the same name, then the given
8397 type is not a subrange type, but rather a plain base type. */
8398 /* FIXME: brobecker/2004-03-22:
8399 Sizetype INTEGER_CSTs nodes are canonicalized. It should
8400 therefore be sufficient to check the TYPE_SIZE node pointers
8401 rather than checking the actual size. Unfortunately, we have
8402 found some cases, such as in the Ada "integer" type, where
8403 this is not the case. Until this problem is solved, we need to
8404 keep checking the actual size. */
8405 tree type_name = TYPE_NAME (type);
8406 tree subtype_name = TYPE_NAME (subtype);
8407
8408 if (type_name != NULL && TREE_CODE (type_name) == TYPE_DECL)
8409 type_name = DECL_NAME (type_name);
8410
8411 if (subtype_name != NULL && TREE_CODE (subtype_name) == TYPE_DECL)
8412 subtype_name = DECL_NAME (subtype_name);
8413
8414 if (type_name == subtype_name)
8415 return false;
8416 }
8417
8418 return true;
8419 }
8420
8421 /* Given a pointer to a tree node for a subrange type, return a pointer
8422 to a DIE that describes the given type. */
8423
8424 static dw_die_ref
subrange_type_die(tree type,dw_die_ref context_die)8425 subrange_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
8426 {
8427 dw_die_ref subrange_die;
8428 const HOST_WIDE_INT size_in_bytes = int_size_in_bytes (type);
8429
8430 if (context_die == NULL)
8431 context_die = comp_unit_die;
8432
8433 subrange_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subrange_type, context_die, type);
8434
8435 if (int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (type)) != size_in_bytes)
8436 {
8437 /* The size of the subrange type and its base type do not match,
8438 so we need to generate a size attribute for the subrange type. */
8439 add_AT_unsigned (subrange_die, DW_AT_byte_size, size_in_bytes);
8440 }
8441
8442 if (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (type) != NULL)
8443 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound,
8444 TYPE_MIN_VALUE (type));
8445 if (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (type) != NULL)
8446 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound,
8447 TYPE_MAX_VALUE (type));
8448
8449 return subrange_die;
8450 }
8451
8452 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return a debugging
8453 entry that chains various modifiers in front of the given type. */
8454
8455 static dw_die_ref
modified_type_die(tree type,int is_const_type,int is_volatile_type,dw_die_ref context_die)8456 modified_type_die (tree type, int is_const_type, int is_volatile_type,
8457 dw_die_ref context_die)
8458 {
8459 enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (type);
8460 dw_die_ref mod_type_die;
8461 dw_die_ref sub_die = NULL;
8462 tree item_type = NULL;
8463 tree qualified_type;
8464 tree name;
8465
8466 if (code == ERROR_MARK)
8467 return NULL;
8468
8469 /* See if we already have the appropriately qualified variant of
8470 this type. */
8471 qualified_type
8472 = get_qualified_type (type,
8473 ((is_const_type ? TYPE_QUAL_CONST : 0)
8474 | (is_volatile_type ? TYPE_QUAL_VOLATILE : 0)));
8475
8476 /* If we do, then we can just use its DIE, if it exists. */
8477 if (qualified_type)
8478 {
8479 mod_type_die = lookup_type_die (qualified_type);
8480 if (mod_type_die)
8481 return mod_type_die;
8482 }
8483
8484 name = qualified_type ? TYPE_NAME (qualified_type) : NULL;
8485
8486 /* Handle C typedef types. */
8487 if (name && TREE_CODE (name) == TYPE_DECL && DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (name))
8488 {
8489 tree dtype = TREE_TYPE (name);
8490
8491 if (qualified_type == dtype)
8492 {
8493 /* For a named type, use the typedef. */
8494 gen_type_die (qualified_type, context_die);
8495 return lookup_type_die (qualified_type);
8496 }
8497 else if (is_const_type < TYPE_READONLY (dtype)
8498 || is_volatile_type < TYPE_VOLATILE (dtype)
8499 || (is_const_type <= TYPE_READONLY (dtype)
8500 && is_volatile_type <= TYPE_VOLATILE (dtype)
8501 && DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (name) != type))
8502 /* cv-unqualified version of named type. Just use the unnamed
8503 type to which it refers. */
8504 return modified_type_die (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (name),
8505 is_const_type, is_volatile_type,
8506 context_die);
8507 /* Else cv-qualified version of named type; fall through. */
8508 }
8509
8510 if (is_const_type)
8511 {
8512 mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_const_type, comp_unit_die, type);
8513 sub_die = modified_type_die (type, 0, is_volatile_type, context_die);
8514 }
8515 else if (is_volatile_type)
8516 {
8517 mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_volatile_type, comp_unit_die, type);
8518 sub_die = modified_type_die (type, 0, 0, context_die);
8519 }
8520 else if (code == POINTER_TYPE)
8521 {
8522 mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_pointer_type, comp_unit_die, type);
8523 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size,
8524 simple_type_size_in_bits (type) / BITS_PER_UNIT);
8525 item_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
8526 }
8527 else if (code == REFERENCE_TYPE)
8528 {
8529 mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_reference_type, comp_unit_die, type);
8530 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size,
8531 simple_type_size_in_bits (type) / BITS_PER_UNIT);
8532 item_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
8533 }
8534 else if (is_subrange_type (type))
8535 {
8536 mod_type_die = subrange_type_die (type, context_die);
8537 item_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
8538 }
8539 else if (is_base_type (type))
8540 mod_type_die = base_type_die (type);
8541 else
8542 {
8543 gen_type_die (type, context_die);
8544
8545 /* We have to get the type_main_variant here (and pass that to the
8546 `lookup_type_die' routine) because the ..._TYPE node we have
8547 might simply be a *copy* of some original type node (where the
8548 copy was created to help us keep track of typedef names) and
8549 that copy might have a different TYPE_UID from the original
8550 ..._TYPE node. */
8551 if (TREE_CODE (type) != VECTOR_TYPE)
8552 return lookup_type_die (type_main_variant (type));
8553 else
8554 /* Vectors have the debugging information in the type,
8555 not the main variant. */
8556 return lookup_type_die (type);
8557 }
8558
8559 /* Builtin types don't have a DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE. For those,
8560 don't output a DW_TAG_typedef, since there isn't one in the
8561 user's program; just attach a DW_AT_name to the type. */
8562 if (name
8563 && (TREE_CODE (name) != TYPE_DECL || TREE_TYPE (name) == qualified_type))
8564 {
8565 if (TREE_CODE (name) == TYPE_DECL)
8566 /* Could just call add_name_and_src_coords_attributes here,
8567 but since this is a builtin type it doesn't have any
8568 useful source coordinates anyway. */
8569 name = DECL_NAME (name);
8570 add_name_attribute (mod_type_die, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name));
8571 }
8572
8573 if (qualified_type)
8574 equate_type_number_to_die (qualified_type, mod_type_die);
8575
8576 if (item_type)
8577 /* We must do this after the equate_type_number_to_die call, in case
8578 this is a recursive type. This ensures that the modified_type_die
8579 recursion will terminate even if the type is recursive. Recursive
8580 types are possible in Ada. */
8581 sub_die = modified_type_die (item_type,
8582 TYPE_READONLY (item_type),
8583 TYPE_VOLATILE (item_type),
8584 context_die);
8585
8586 if (sub_die != NULL)
8587 add_AT_die_ref (mod_type_die, DW_AT_type, sub_die);
8588
8589 return mod_type_die;
8590 }
8591
8592 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return true if it is
8593 an enumerated type. */
8594
8595 static inline int
type_is_enum(tree type)8596 type_is_enum (tree type)
8597 {
8598 return TREE_CODE (type) == ENUMERAL_TYPE;
8599 }
8600
8601 /* Return the DBX register number described by a given RTL node. */
8602
8603 static unsigned int
dbx_reg_number(rtx rtl)8604 dbx_reg_number (rtx rtl)
8605 {
8606 unsigned regno = REGNO (rtl);
8607
8608 gcc_assert (regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER);
8609
8610 #ifdef LEAF_REG_REMAP
8611 if (current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs)
8612 {
8613 int leaf_reg = LEAF_REG_REMAP (regno);
8614 if (leaf_reg != -1)
8615 regno = (unsigned) leaf_reg;
8616 }
8617 #endif
8618
8619 return DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (regno);
8620 }
8621
8622 /* Optionally add a DW_OP_piece term to a location description expression.
8623 DW_OP_piece is only added if the location description expression already
8624 doesn't end with DW_OP_piece. */
8625
8626 static void
add_loc_descr_op_piece(dw_loc_descr_ref * list_head,int size)8627 add_loc_descr_op_piece (dw_loc_descr_ref *list_head, int size)
8628 {
8629 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
8630
8631 if (*list_head != NULL)
8632 {
8633 /* Find the end of the chain. */
8634 for (loc = *list_head; loc->dw_loc_next != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
8635 ;
8636
8637 if (loc->dw_loc_opc != DW_OP_piece)
8638 loc->dw_loc_next = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_piece, size, 0);
8639 }
8640 }
8641
8642 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a machine register or
8643 zero if there is none. */
8644
8645 static dw_loc_descr_ref
reg_loc_descriptor(rtx rtl)8646 reg_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl)
8647 {
8648 rtx regs;
8649
8650 if (REGNO (rtl) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
8651 return 0;
8652
8653 regs = targetm.dwarf_register_span (rtl);
8654
8655 if (hard_regno_nregs[REGNO (rtl)][GET_MODE (rtl)] > 1 || regs)
8656 return multiple_reg_loc_descriptor (rtl, regs);
8657 else
8658 return one_reg_loc_descriptor (dbx_reg_number (rtl));
8659 }
8660
8661 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a machine register for
8662 a given hard register number. */
8663
8664 static dw_loc_descr_ref
one_reg_loc_descriptor(unsigned int regno)8665 one_reg_loc_descriptor (unsigned int regno)
8666 {
8667 if (regno <= 31)
8668 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_reg0 + regno, 0, 0);
8669 else
8670 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_regx, regno, 0);
8671 }
8672
8673 /* Given an RTL of a register, return a location descriptor that
8674 designates a value that spans more than one register. */
8675
8676 static dw_loc_descr_ref
multiple_reg_loc_descriptor(rtx rtl,rtx regs)8677 multiple_reg_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, rtx regs)
8678 {
8679 int nregs, size, i;
8680 unsigned reg;
8681 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result = NULL;
8682
8683 reg = REGNO (rtl);
8684 #ifdef LEAF_REG_REMAP
8685 if (current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs)
8686 {
8687 int leaf_reg = LEAF_REG_REMAP (reg);
8688 if (leaf_reg != -1)
8689 reg = (unsigned) leaf_reg;
8690 }
8691 #endif
8692 gcc_assert ((unsigned) DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (reg) == dbx_reg_number (rtl));
8693 nregs = hard_regno_nregs[REGNO (rtl)][GET_MODE (rtl)];
8694
8695 /* Simple, contiguous registers. */
8696 if (regs == NULL_RTX)
8697 {
8698 size = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl)) / nregs;
8699
8700 loc_result = NULL;
8701 while (nregs--)
8702 {
8703 dw_loc_descr_ref t;
8704
8705 t = one_reg_loc_descriptor (DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (reg));
8706 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, t);
8707 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, size);
8708 ++reg;
8709 }
8710 return loc_result;
8711 }
8712
8713 /* Now onto stupid register sets in non contiguous locations. */
8714
8715 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (regs) == PARALLEL);
8716
8717 size = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XVECEXP (regs, 0, 0)));
8718 loc_result = NULL;
8719
8720 for (i = 0; i < XVECLEN (regs, 0); ++i)
8721 {
8722 dw_loc_descr_ref t;
8723
8724 t = one_reg_loc_descriptor (REGNO (XVECEXP (regs, 0, i)));
8725 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, t);
8726 size = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XVECEXP (regs, 0, 0)));
8727 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, size);
8728 }
8729 return loc_result;
8730 }
8731
8732 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a constant. */
8733
8734 static dw_loc_descr_ref
int_loc_descriptor(HOST_WIDE_INT i)8735 int_loc_descriptor (HOST_WIDE_INT i)
8736 {
8737 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
8738
8739 /* Pick the smallest representation of a constant, rather than just
8740 defaulting to the LEB encoding. */
8741 if (i >= 0)
8742 {
8743 if (i <= 31)
8744 op = DW_OP_lit0 + i;
8745 else if (i <= 0xff)
8746 op = DW_OP_const1u;
8747 else if (i <= 0xffff)
8748 op = DW_OP_const2u;
8749 else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32
8750 || i <= 0xffffffff)
8751 op = DW_OP_const4u;
8752 else
8753 op = DW_OP_constu;
8754 }
8755 else
8756 {
8757 if (i >= -0x80)
8758 op = DW_OP_const1s;
8759 else if (i >= -0x8000)
8760 op = DW_OP_const2s;
8761 else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32
8762 || i >= -0x80000000)
8763 op = DW_OP_const4s;
8764 else
8765 op = DW_OP_consts;
8766 }
8767
8768 return new_loc_descr (op, i, 0);
8769 }
8770
8771 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a base+offset location. */
8772
8773 static dw_loc_descr_ref
based_loc_descr(rtx reg,HOST_WIDE_INT offset)8774 based_loc_descr (rtx reg, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
8775 {
8776 unsigned int regno;
8777
8778 /* We only use "frame base" when we're sure we're talking about the
8779 post-prologue local stack frame. We do this by *not* running
8780 register elimination until this point, and recognizing the special
8781 argument pointer and soft frame pointer rtx's. */
8782 if (reg == arg_pointer_rtx || reg == frame_pointer_rtx)
8783 {
8784 rtx elim = eliminate_regs (reg, VOIDmode, NULL_RTX);
8785
8786 if (elim != reg)
8787 {
8788 if (GET_CODE (elim) == PLUS)
8789 {
8790 offset += INTVAL (XEXP (elim, 1));
8791 elim = XEXP (elim, 0);
8792 }
8793 gcc_assert (elim == (frame_pointer_needed ? hard_frame_pointer_rtx
8794 : stack_pointer_rtx));
8795 offset += frame_pointer_fb_offset;
8796
8797 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_fbreg, offset, 0);
8798 }
8799 }
8800
8801 regno = dbx_reg_number (reg);
8802 if (regno <= 31)
8803 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_breg0 + regno, offset, 0);
8804 else
8805 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bregx, regno, offset);
8806 }
8807
8808 /* Return true if this RTL expression describes a base+offset calculation. */
8809
8810 static inline int
is_based_loc(rtx rtl)8811 is_based_loc (rtx rtl)
8812 {
8813 return (GET_CODE (rtl) == PLUS
8814 && ((REG_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
8815 && REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
8816 && GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 1)) == CONST_INT)));
8817 }
8818
8819 /* The following routine converts the RTL for a variable or parameter
8820 (resident in memory) into an equivalent Dwarf representation of a
8821 mechanism for getting the address of that same variable onto the top of a
8822 hypothetical "address evaluation" stack.
8823
8824 When creating memory location descriptors, we are effectively transforming
8825 the RTL for a memory-resident object into its Dwarf postfix expression
8826 equivalent. This routine recursively descends an RTL tree, turning
8827 it into Dwarf postfix code as it goes.
8828
8829 MODE is the mode of the memory reference, needed to handle some
8830 autoincrement addressing modes.
8831
8832 CAN_USE_FBREG is a flag whether we can use DW_AT_frame_base in the
8833 location list for RTL.
8834
8835 Return 0 if we can't represent the location. */
8836
8837 static dw_loc_descr_ref
mem_loc_descriptor(rtx rtl,enum machine_mode mode)8838 mem_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, enum machine_mode mode)
8839 {
8840 dw_loc_descr_ref mem_loc_result = NULL;
8841 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
8842
8843 /* Note that for a dynamically sized array, the location we will generate a
8844 description of here will be the lowest numbered location which is
8845 actually within the array. That's *not* necessarily the same as the
8846 zeroth element of the array. */
8847
8848 rtl = targetm.delegitimize_address (rtl);
8849
8850 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
8851 {
8852 case POST_INC:
8853 case POST_DEC:
8854 case POST_MODIFY:
8855 /* POST_INC and POST_DEC can be handled just like a SUBREG. So we
8856 just fall into the SUBREG code. */
8857
8858 /* ... fall through ... */
8859
8860 case SUBREG:
8861 /* The case of a subreg may arise when we have a local (register)
8862 variable or a formal (register) parameter which doesn't quite fill
8863 up an entire register. For now, just assume that it is
8864 legitimate to make the Dwarf info refer to the whole register which
8865 contains the given subreg. */
8866 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
8867
8868 /* ... fall through ... */
8869
8870 case REG:
8871 /* Whenever a register number forms a part of the description of the
8872 method for calculating the (dynamic) address of a memory resident
8873 object, DWARF rules require the register number be referred to as
8874 a "base register". This distinction is not based in any way upon
8875 what category of register the hardware believes the given register
8876 belongs to. This is strictly DWARF terminology we're dealing with
8877 here. Note that in cases where the location of a memory-resident
8878 data object could be expressed as: OP_ADD (OP_BASEREG (basereg),
8879 OP_CONST (0)) the actual DWARF location descriptor that we generate
8880 may just be OP_BASEREG (basereg). This may look deceptively like
8881 the object in question was allocated to a register (rather than in
8882 memory) so DWARF consumers need to be aware of the subtle
8883 distinction between OP_REG and OP_BASEREG. */
8884 if (REGNO (rtl) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
8885 mem_loc_result = based_loc_descr (rtl, 0);
8886 break;
8887
8888 case MEM:
8889 mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), GET_MODE (rtl));
8890 if (mem_loc_result != 0)
8891 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0));
8892 break;
8893
8894 case LO_SUM:
8895 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 1);
8896
8897 /* ... fall through ... */
8898
8899 case LABEL_REF:
8900 /* Some ports can transform a symbol ref into a label ref, because
8901 the symbol ref is too far away and has to be dumped into a constant
8902 pool. */
8903 case CONST:
8904 case SYMBOL_REF:
8905 /* Alternatively, the symbol in the constant pool might be referenced
8906 by a different symbol. */
8907 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SYMBOL_REF && CONSTANT_POOL_ADDRESS_P (rtl))
8908 {
8909 bool marked;
8910 rtx tmp = get_pool_constant_mark (rtl, &marked);
8911
8912 if (GET_CODE (tmp) == SYMBOL_REF)
8913 {
8914 rtl = tmp;
8915 if (CONSTANT_POOL_ADDRESS_P (tmp))
8916 get_pool_constant_mark (tmp, &marked);
8917 else
8918 marked = true;
8919 }
8920
8921 /* If all references to this pool constant were optimized away,
8922 it was not output and thus we can't represent it.
8923 FIXME: might try to use DW_OP_const_value here, though
8924 DW_OP_piece complicates it. */
8925 if (!marked)
8926 return 0;
8927 }
8928
8929 mem_loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_addr, 0, 0);
8930 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
8931 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr = rtl;
8932 VEC_safe_push (rtx, gc, used_rtx_array, rtl);
8933 break;
8934
8935 case PRE_MODIFY:
8936 /* Extract the PLUS expression nested inside and fall into
8937 PLUS code below. */
8938 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 1);
8939 goto plus;
8940
8941 case PRE_INC:
8942 case PRE_DEC:
8943 /* Turn these into a PLUS expression and fall into the PLUS code
8944 below. */
8945 rtl = gen_rtx_PLUS (word_mode, XEXP (rtl, 0),
8946 GEN_INT (GET_CODE (rtl) == PRE_INC
8947 ? GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mode)
8948 : -GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mode)));
8949
8950 /* ... fall through ... */
8951
8952 case PLUS:
8953 plus:
8954 if (is_based_loc (rtl))
8955 mem_loc_result = based_loc_descr (XEXP (rtl, 0),
8956 INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)));
8957 else
8958 {
8959 mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode);
8960 if (mem_loc_result == 0)
8961 break;
8962
8963 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 1)) == CONST_INT
8964 && INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)) >= 0)
8965 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
8966 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst,
8967 INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)), 0));
8968 else
8969 {
8970 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
8971 mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode));
8972 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
8973 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
8974 }
8975 }
8976 break;
8977
8978 /* If a pseudo-reg is optimized away, it is possible for it to
8979 be replaced with a MEM containing a multiply or shift. */
8980 case MULT:
8981 op = DW_OP_mul;
8982 goto do_binop;
8983
8984 case ASHIFT:
8985 op = DW_OP_shl;
8986 goto do_binop;
8987
8988 case ASHIFTRT:
8989 op = DW_OP_shra;
8990 goto do_binop;
8991
8992 case LSHIFTRT:
8993 op = DW_OP_shr;
8994 goto do_binop;
8995
8996 do_binop:
8997 {
8998 dw_loc_descr_ref op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode);
8999 dw_loc_descr_ref op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode);
9000
9001 if (op0 == 0 || op1 == 0)
9002 break;
9003
9004 mem_loc_result = op0;
9005 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op1);
9006 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
9007 break;
9008 }
9009
9010 case CONST_INT:
9011 mem_loc_result = int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (rtl));
9012 break;
9013
9014 default:
9015 gcc_unreachable ();
9016 }
9017
9018 return mem_loc_result;
9019 }
9020
9021 /* Return a descriptor that describes the concatenation of two locations.
9022 This is typically a complex variable. */
9023
9024 static dw_loc_descr_ref
concat_loc_descriptor(rtx x0,rtx x1)9025 concat_loc_descriptor (rtx x0, rtx x1)
9026 {
9027 dw_loc_descr_ref cc_loc_result = NULL;
9028 dw_loc_descr_ref x0_ref = loc_descriptor (x0);
9029 dw_loc_descr_ref x1_ref = loc_descriptor (x1);
9030
9031 if (x0_ref == 0 || x1_ref == 0)
9032 return 0;
9033
9034 cc_loc_result = x0_ref;
9035 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&cc_loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x0)));
9036
9037 add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result, x1_ref);
9038 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&cc_loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x1)));
9039
9040 return cc_loc_result;
9041 }
9042
9043 /* Output a proper Dwarf location descriptor for a variable or parameter
9044 which is either allocated in a register or in a memory location. For a
9045 register, we just generate an OP_REG and the register number. For a
9046 memory location we provide a Dwarf postfix expression describing how to
9047 generate the (dynamic) address of the object onto the address stack.
9048
9049 If we don't know how to describe it, return 0. */
9050
9051 static dw_loc_descr_ref
loc_descriptor(rtx rtl)9052 loc_descriptor (rtx rtl)
9053 {
9054 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result = NULL;
9055
9056 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
9057 {
9058 case SUBREG:
9059 /* The case of a subreg may arise when we have a local (register)
9060 variable or a formal (register) parameter which doesn't quite fill
9061 up an entire register. For now, just assume that it is
9062 legitimate to make the Dwarf info refer to the whole register which
9063 contains the given subreg. */
9064 rtl = SUBREG_REG (rtl);
9065
9066 /* ... fall through ... */
9067
9068 case REG:
9069 loc_result = reg_loc_descriptor (rtl);
9070 break;
9071
9072 case MEM:
9073 loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), GET_MODE (rtl));
9074 break;
9075
9076 case CONCAT:
9077 loc_result = concat_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), XEXP (rtl, 1));
9078 break;
9079
9080 case VAR_LOCATION:
9081 /* Single part. */
9082 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 1)) != PARALLEL)
9083 {
9084 loc_result = loc_descriptor (XEXP (XEXP (rtl, 1), 0));
9085 break;
9086 }
9087
9088 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 1);
9089 /* FALLTHRU */
9090
9091 case PARALLEL:
9092 {
9093 rtvec par_elems = XVEC (rtl, 0);
9094 int num_elem = GET_NUM_ELEM (par_elems);
9095 enum machine_mode mode;
9096 int i;
9097
9098 /* Create the first one, so we have something to add to. */
9099 loc_result = loc_descriptor (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, 0), 0));
9100 mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, 0), 0));
9101 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (mode));
9102 for (i = 1; i < num_elem; i++)
9103 {
9104 dw_loc_descr_ref temp;
9105
9106 temp = loc_descriptor (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, i), 0));
9107 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, temp);
9108 mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, i), 0));
9109 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (mode));
9110 }
9111 }
9112 break;
9113
9114 default:
9115 gcc_unreachable ();
9116 }
9117
9118 return loc_result;
9119 }
9120
9121 /* Similar, but generate the descriptor from trees instead of rtl. This comes
9122 up particularly with variable length arrays. WANT_ADDRESS is 2 if this is
9123 a top-level invocation of loc_descriptor_from_tree; is 1 if this is not a
9124 top-level invocation, and we require the address of LOC; is 0 if we require
9125 the value of LOC. */
9126
9127 static dw_loc_descr_ref
loc_descriptor_from_tree_1(tree loc,int want_address)9128 loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (tree loc, int want_address)
9129 {
9130 dw_loc_descr_ref ret, ret1;
9131 int have_address = 0;
9132 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
9133
9134 /* ??? Most of the time we do not take proper care for sign/zero
9135 extending the values properly. Hopefully this won't be a real
9136 problem... */
9137
9138 switch (TREE_CODE (loc))
9139 {
9140 case ERROR_MARK:
9141 return 0;
9142
9143 case PLACEHOLDER_EXPR:
9144 /* This case involves extracting fields from an object to determine the
9145 position of other fields. We don't try to encode this here. The
9146 only user of this is Ada, which encodes the needed information using
9147 the names of types. */
9148 return 0;
9149
9150 case CALL_EXPR:
9151 return 0;
9152
9153 case PREINCREMENT_EXPR:
9154 case PREDECREMENT_EXPR:
9155 case POSTINCREMENT_EXPR:
9156 case POSTDECREMENT_EXPR:
9157 /* There are no opcodes for these operations. */
9158 return 0;
9159
9160 case ADDR_EXPR:
9161 /* If we already want an address, there's nothing we can do. */
9162 if (want_address)
9163 return 0;
9164
9165 /* Otherwise, process the argument and look for the address. */
9166 return loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 1);
9167
9168 case VAR_DECL:
9169 if (DECL_THREAD_LOCAL_P (loc))
9170 {
9171 rtx rtl;
9172
9173 /* If this is not defined, we have no way to emit the data. */
9174 if (!targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel)
9175 return 0;
9176
9177 /* The way DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address is specified, we can only
9178 look up addresses of objects in the current module. */
9179 if (DECL_EXTERNAL (loc))
9180 return 0;
9181
9182 rtl = rtl_for_decl_location (loc);
9183 if (rtl == NULL_RTX)
9184 return 0;
9185
9186 if (!MEM_P (rtl))
9187 return 0;
9188 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
9189 if (! CONSTANT_P (rtl))
9190 return 0;
9191
9192 ret = new_loc_descr (INTERNAL_DW_OP_tls_addr, 0, 0);
9193 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
9194 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr = rtl;
9195
9196 ret1 = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address, 0, 0);
9197 add_loc_descr (&ret, ret1);
9198
9199 have_address = 1;
9200 break;
9201 }
9202 /* FALLTHRU */
9203
9204 case PARM_DECL:
9205 if (DECL_HAS_VALUE_EXPR_P (loc))
9206 return loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (DECL_VALUE_EXPR (loc),
9207 want_address);
9208 /* FALLTHRU */
9209
9210 case RESULT_DECL:
9211 case FUNCTION_DECL:
9212 {
9213 rtx rtl = rtl_for_decl_location (loc);
9214
9215 if (rtl == NULL_RTX)
9216 return 0;
9217 else if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_INT)
9218 {
9219 HOST_WIDE_INT val = INTVAL (rtl);
9220 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc)))
9221 val &= GET_MODE_MASK (DECL_MODE (loc));
9222 ret = int_loc_descriptor (val);
9223 }
9224 else if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_STRING)
9225 return 0;
9226 else if (CONSTANT_P (rtl))
9227 {
9228 ret = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_addr, 0, 0);
9229 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
9230 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr = rtl;
9231 }
9232 else
9233 {
9234 enum machine_mode mode;
9235
9236 /* Certain constructs can only be represented at top-level. */
9237 if (want_address == 2)
9238 return loc_descriptor (rtl);
9239
9240 mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
9241 if (MEM_P (rtl))
9242 {
9243 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
9244 have_address = 1;
9245 }
9246 ret = mem_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode);
9247 }
9248 }
9249 break;
9250
9251 case INDIRECT_REF:
9252 ret = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
9253 have_address = 1;
9254 break;
9255
9256 case COMPOUND_EXPR:
9257 return loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), want_address);
9258
9259 case NOP_EXPR:
9260 case CONVERT_EXPR:
9261 case NON_LVALUE_EXPR:
9262 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
9263 case SAVE_EXPR:
9264 case MODIFY_EXPR:
9265 return loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), want_address);
9266
9267 case COMPONENT_REF:
9268 case BIT_FIELD_REF:
9269 case ARRAY_REF:
9270 case ARRAY_RANGE_REF:
9271 {
9272 tree obj, offset;
9273 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, bitpos, bytepos;
9274 enum machine_mode mode;
9275 int volatilep;
9276 int unsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc));
9277
9278 obj = get_inner_reference (loc, &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset, &mode,
9279 &unsignedp, &volatilep, false);
9280
9281 if (obj == loc)
9282 return 0;
9283
9284 ret = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (obj, 1);
9285 if (ret == 0
9286 || bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT != 0 || bitsize % BITS_PER_UNIT != 0)
9287 return 0;
9288
9289 if (offset != NULL_TREE)
9290 {
9291 /* Variable offset. */
9292 add_loc_descr (&ret, loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (offset, 0));
9293 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
9294 }
9295
9296 bytepos = bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT;
9297 if (bytepos > 0)
9298 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, bytepos, 0));
9299 else if (bytepos < 0)
9300 {
9301 add_loc_descr (&ret, int_loc_descriptor (bytepos));
9302 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
9303 }
9304
9305 have_address = 1;
9306 break;
9307 }
9308
9309 case INTEGER_CST:
9310 if (host_integerp (loc, 0))
9311 ret = int_loc_descriptor (tree_low_cst (loc, 0));
9312 else
9313 return 0;
9314 break;
9315
9316 case CONSTRUCTOR:
9317 {
9318 /* Get an RTL for this, if something has been emitted. */
9319 rtx rtl = lookup_constant_def (loc);
9320 enum machine_mode mode;
9321
9322 if (!rtl || !MEM_P (rtl))
9323 return 0;
9324 mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
9325 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
9326 ret = mem_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode);
9327 have_address = 1;
9328 break;
9329 }
9330
9331 case TRUTH_AND_EXPR:
9332 case TRUTH_ANDIF_EXPR:
9333 case BIT_AND_EXPR:
9334 op = DW_OP_and;
9335 goto do_binop;
9336
9337 case TRUTH_XOR_EXPR:
9338 case BIT_XOR_EXPR:
9339 op = DW_OP_xor;
9340 goto do_binop;
9341
9342 case TRUTH_OR_EXPR:
9343 case TRUTH_ORIF_EXPR:
9344 case BIT_IOR_EXPR:
9345 op = DW_OP_or;
9346 goto do_binop;
9347
9348 case FLOOR_DIV_EXPR:
9349 case CEIL_DIV_EXPR:
9350 case ROUND_DIV_EXPR:
9351 case TRUNC_DIV_EXPR:
9352 op = DW_OP_div;
9353 goto do_binop;
9354
9355 case MINUS_EXPR:
9356 op = DW_OP_minus;
9357 goto do_binop;
9358
9359 case FLOOR_MOD_EXPR:
9360 case CEIL_MOD_EXPR:
9361 case ROUND_MOD_EXPR:
9362 case TRUNC_MOD_EXPR:
9363 op = DW_OP_mod;
9364 goto do_binop;
9365
9366 case MULT_EXPR:
9367 op = DW_OP_mul;
9368 goto do_binop;
9369
9370 case LSHIFT_EXPR:
9371 op = DW_OP_shl;
9372 goto do_binop;
9373
9374 case RSHIFT_EXPR:
9375 op = (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc)) ? DW_OP_shr : DW_OP_shra);
9376 goto do_binop;
9377
9378 case PLUS_EXPR:
9379 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1)) == INTEGER_CST
9380 && host_integerp (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0))
9381 {
9382 ret = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
9383 if (ret == 0)
9384 return 0;
9385
9386 add_loc_descr (&ret,
9387 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst,
9388 tree_low_cst (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1),
9389 0),
9390 0));
9391 break;
9392 }
9393
9394 op = DW_OP_plus;
9395 goto do_binop;
9396
9397 case LE_EXPR:
9398 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
9399 return 0;
9400
9401 op = DW_OP_le;
9402 goto do_binop;
9403
9404 case GE_EXPR:
9405 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
9406 return 0;
9407
9408 op = DW_OP_ge;
9409 goto do_binop;
9410
9411 case LT_EXPR:
9412 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
9413 return 0;
9414
9415 op = DW_OP_lt;
9416 goto do_binop;
9417
9418 case GT_EXPR:
9419 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
9420 return 0;
9421
9422 op = DW_OP_gt;
9423 goto do_binop;
9424
9425 case EQ_EXPR:
9426 op = DW_OP_eq;
9427 goto do_binop;
9428
9429 case NE_EXPR:
9430 op = DW_OP_ne;
9431 goto do_binop;
9432
9433 do_binop:
9434 ret = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
9435 ret1 = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0);
9436 if (ret == 0 || ret1 == 0)
9437 return 0;
9438
9439 add_loc_descr (&ret, ret1);
9440 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
9441 break;
9442
9443 case TRUTH_NOT_EXPR:
9444 case BIT_NOT_EXPR:
9445 op = DW_OP_not;
9446 goto do_unop;
9447
9448 case ABS_EXPR:
9449 op = DW_OP_abs;
9450 goto do_unop;
9451
9452 case NEGATE_EXPR:
9453 op = DW_OP_neg;
9454 goto do_unop;
9455
9456 do_unop:
9457 ret = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
9458 if (ret == 0)
9459 return 0;
9460
9461 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
9462 break;
9463
9464 case MIN_EXPR:
9465 case MAX_EXPR:
9466 {
9467 const enum tree_code code =
9468 TREE_CODE (loc) == MIN_EXPR ? GT_EXPR : LT_EXPR;
9469
9470 loc = build3 (COND_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (loc),
9471 build2 (code, integer_type_node,
9472 TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1)),
9473 TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0));
9474 }
9475
9476 /* ... fall through ... */
9477
9478 case COND_EXPR:
9479 {
9480 dw_loc_descr_ref lhs
9481 = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0);
9482 dw_loc_descr_ref rhs
9483 = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 2), 0);
9484 dw_loc_descr_ref bra_node, jump_node, tmp;
9485
9486 ret = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
9487 if (ret == 0 || lhs == 0 || rhs == 0)
9488 return 0;
9489
9490 bra_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
9491 add_loc_descr (&ret, bra_node);
9492
9493 add_loc_descr (&ret, rhs);
9494 jump_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_skip, 0, 0);
9495 add_loc_descr (&ret, jump_node);
9496
9497 add_loc_descr (&ret, lhs);
9498 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
9499 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = lhs;
9500
9501 /* ??? Need a node to point the skip at. Use a nop. */
9502 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_nop, 0, 0);
9503 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
9504 jump_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
9505 jump_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = tmp;
9506 }
9507 break;
9508
9509 case FIX_TRUNC_EXPR:
9510 case FIX_CEIL_EXPR:
9511 case FIX_FLOOR_EXPR:
9512 case FIX_ROUND_EXPR:
9513 return 0;
9514
9515 default:
9516 /* Leave front-end specific codes as simply unknown. This comes
9517 up, for instance, with the C STMT_EXPR. */
9518 if ((unsigned int) TREE_CODE (loc)
9519 >= (unsigned int) LAST_AND_UNUSED_TREE_CODE)
9520 return 0;
9521
9522 #ifdef ENABLE_CHECKING
9523 /* Otherwise this is a generic code; we should just lists all of
9524 these explicitly. We forgot one. */
9525 gcc_unreachable ();
9526 #else
9527 /* In a release build, we want to degrade gracefully: better to
9528 generate incomplete debugging information than to crash. */
9529 return NULL;
9530 #endif
9531 }
9532
9533 /* Show if we can't fill the request for an address. */
9534 if (want_address && !have_address)
9535 return 0;
9536
9537 /* If we've got an address and don't want one, dereference. */
9538 if (!want_address && have_address && ret)
9539 {
9540 HOST_WIDE_INT size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc));
9541
9542 if (size > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE || size == -1)
9543 return 0;
9544 else if (size == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
9545 op = DW_OP_deref;
9546 else
9547 op = DW_OP_deref_size;
9548
9549 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (op, size, 0));
9550 }
9551
9552 return ret;
9553 }
9554
9555 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
loc_descriptor_from_tree(tree loc)9556 loc_descriptor_from_tree (tree loc)
9557 {
9558 return loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (loc, 2);
9559 }
9560
9561 /* Given a value, round it up to the lowest multiple of `boundary'
9562 which is not less than the value itself. */
9563
9564 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT
ceiling(HOST_WIDE_INT value,unsigned int boundary)9565 ceiling (HOST_WIDE_INT value, unsigned int boundary)
9566 {
9567 return (((value + boundary - 1) / boundary) * boundary);
9568 }
9569
9570 /* Given a pointer to what is assumed to be a FIELD_DECL node, return a
9571 pointer to the declared type for the relevant field variable, or return
9572 `integer_type_node' if the given node turns out to be an
9573 ERROR_MARK node. */
9574
9575 static inline tree
field_type(tree decl)9576 field_type (tree decl)
9577 {
9578 tree type;
9579
9580 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == ERROR_MARK)
9581 return integer_type_node;
9582
9583 type = DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl);
9584 if (type == NULL_TREE)
9585 type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
9586
9587 return type;
9588 }
9589
9590 /* Given a pointer to a tree node, return the alignment in bits for
9591 it, or else return BITS_PER_WORD if the node actually turns out to
9592 be an ERROR_MARK node. */
9593
9594 static inline unsigned
simple_type_align_in_bits(tree type)9595 simple_type_align_in_bits (tree type)
9596 {
9597 return (TREE_CODE (type) != ERROR_MARK) ? TYPE_ALIGN (type) : BITS_PER_WORD;
9598 }
9599
9600 static inline unsigned
simple_decl_align_in_bits(tree decl)9601 simple_decl_align_in_bits (tree decl)
9602 {
9603 return (TREE_CODE (decl) != ERROR_MARK) ? DECL_ALIGN (decl) : BITS_PER_WORD;
9604 }
9605
9606 /* Given a pointer to a FIELD_DECL, compute and return the byte offset of the
9607 lowest addressed byte of the "containing object" for the given FIELD_DECL,
9608 or return 0 if we are unable to determine what that offset is, either
9609 because the argument turns out to be a pointer to an ERROR_MARK node, or
9610 because the offset is actually variable. (We can't handle the latter case
9611 just yet). */
9612
9613 static HOST_WIDE_INT
field_byte_offset(tree decl)9614 field_byte_offset (tree decl)
9615 {
9616 unsigned int type_align_in_bits;
9617 unsigned int decl_align_in_bits;
9618 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT type_size_in_bits;
9619 HOST_WIDE_INT object_offset_in_bits;
9620 tree type;
9621 tree field_size_tree;
9622 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos_int;
9623 HOST_WIDE_INT deepest_bitpos;
9624 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT field_size_in_bits;
9625
9626 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == ERROR_MARK)
9627 return 0;
9628
9629 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL);
9630
9631 type = field_type (decl);
9632 field_size_tree = DECL_SIZE (decl);
9633
9634 /* The size could be unspecified if there was an error, or for
9635 a flexible array member. */
9636 if (! field_size_tree)
9637 field_size_tree = bitsize_zero_node;
9638
9639 /* We cannot yet cope with fields whose positions are variable, so
9640 for now, when we see such things, we simply return 0. Someday, we may
9641 be able to handle such cases, but it will be damn difficult. */
9642 if (! host_integerp (bit_position (decl), 0))
9643 return 0;
9644
9645 bitpos_int = int_bit_position (decl);
9646
9647 /* If we don't know the size of the field, pretend it's a full word. */
9648 if (host_integerp (field_size_tree, 1))
9649 field_size_in_bits = tree_low_cst (field_size_tree, 1);
9650 else
9651 field_size_in_bits = BITS_PER_WORD;
9652
9653 type_size_in_bits = simple_type_size_in_bits (type);
9654 type_align_in_bits = simple_type_align_in_bits (type);
9655 decl_align_in_bits = simple_decl_align_in_bits (decl);
9656
9657 /* The GCC front-end doesn't make any attempt to keep track of the starting
9658 bit offset (relative to the start of the containing structure type) of the
9659 hypothetical "containing object" for a bit-field. Thus, when computing
9660 the byte offset value for the start of the "containing object" of a
9661 bit-field, we must deduce this information on our own. This can be rather
9662 tricky to do in some cases. For example, handling the following structure
9663 type definition when compiling for an i386/i486 target (which only aligns
9664 long long's to 32-bit boundaries) can be very tricky:
9665
9666 struct S { int field1; long long field2:31; };
9667
9668 Fortunately, there is a simple rule-of-thumb which can be used in such
9669 cases. When compiling for an i386/i486, GCC will allocate 8 bytes for the
9670 structure shown above. It decides to do this based upon one simple rule
9671 for bit-field allocation. GCC allocates each "containing object" for each
9672 bit-field at the first (i.e. lowest addressed) legitimate alignment
9673 boundary (based upon the required minimum alignment for the declared type
9674 of the field) which it can possibly use, subject to the condition that
9675 there is still enough available space remaining in the containing object
9676 (when allocated at the selected point) to fully accommodate all of the
9677 bits of the bit-field itself.
9678
9679 This simple rule makes it obvious why GCC allocates 8 bytes for each
9680 object of the structure type shown above. When looking for a place to
9681 allocate the "containing object" for `field2', the compiler simply tries
9682 to allocate a 64-bit "containing object" at each successive 32-bit
9683 boundary (starting at zero) until it finds a place to allocate that 64-
9684 bit field such that at least 31 contiguous (and previously unallocated)
9685 bits remain within that selected 64 bit field. (As it turns out, for the
9686 example above, the compiler finds it is OK to allocate the "containing
9687 object" 64-bit field at bit-offset zero within the structure type.)
9688
9689 Here we attempt to work backwards from the limited set of facts we're
9690 given, and we try to deduce from those facts, where GCC must have believed
9691 that the containing object started (within the structure type). The value
9692 we deduce is then used (by the callers of this routine) to generate
9693 DW_AT_location and DW_AT_bit_offset attributes for fields (both bit-fields
9694 and, in the case of DW_AT_location, regular fields as well). */
9695
9696 /* Figure out the bit-distance from the start of the structure to the
9697 "deepest" bit of the bit-field. */
9698 deepest_bitpos = bitpos_int + field_size_in_bits;
9699
9700 /* This is the tricky part. Use some fancy footwork to deduce where the
9701 lowest addressed bit of the containing object must be. */
9702 object_offset_in_bits = deepest_bitpos - type_size_in_bits;
9703
9704 /* Round up to type_align by default. This works best for bitfields. */
9705 object_offset_in_bits += type_align_in_bits - 1;
9706 object_offset_in_bits /= type_align_in_bits;
9707 object_offset_in_bits *= type_align_in_bits;
9708
9709 if (object_offset_in_bits > bitpos_int)
9710 {
9711 /* Sigh, the decl must be packed. */
9712 object_offset_in_bits = deepest_bitpos - type_size_in_bits;
9713
9714 /* Round up to decl_align instead. */
9715 object_offset_in_bits += decl_align_in_bits - 1;
9716 object_offset_in_bits /= decl_align_in_bits;
9717 object_offset_in_bits *= decl_align_in_bits;
9718 }
9719
9720 return object_offset_in_bits / BITS_PER_UNIT;
9721 }
9722
9723 /* The following routines define various Dwarf attributes and any data
9724 associated with them. */
9725
9726 /* Add a location description attribute value to a DIE.
9727
9728 This emits location attributes suitable for whole variables and
9729 whole parameters. Note that the location attributes for struct fields are
9730 generated by the routine `data_member_location_attribute' below. */
9731
9732 static inline void
add_AT_location_description(dw_die_ref die,enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,dw_loc_descr_ref descr)9733 add_AT_location_description (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
9734 dw_loc_descr_ref descr)
9735 {
9736 if (descr != 0)
9737 add_AT_loc (die, attr_kind, descr);
9738 }
9739
9740 /* Attach the specialized form of location attribute used for data members of
9741 struct and union types. In the special case of a FIELD_DECL node which
9742 represents a bit-field, the "offset" part of this special location
9743 descriptor must indicate the distance in bytes from the lowest-addressed
9744 byte of the containing struct or union type to the lowest-addressed byte of
9745 the "containing object" for the bit-field. (See the `field_byte_offset'
9746 function above).
9747
9748 For any given bit-field, the "containing object" is a hypothetical object
9749 (of some integral or enum type) within which the given bit-field lives. The
9750 type of this hypothetical "containing object" is always the same as the
9751 declared type of the individual bit-field itself (for GCC anyway... the
9752 DWARF spec doesn't actually mandate this). Note that it is the size (in
9753 bytes) of the hypothetical "containing object" which will be given in the
9754 DW_AT_byte_size attribute for this bit-field. (See the
9755 `byte_size_attribute' function below.) It is also used when calculating the
9756 value of the DW_AT_bit_offset attribute. (See the `bit_offset_attribute'
9757 function below.) */
9758
9759 static void
add_data_member_location_attribute(dw_die_ref die,tree decl)9760 add_data_member_location_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
9761 {
9762 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
9763 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descr = 0;
9764
9765 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == TREE_BINFO)
9766 {
9767 /* We're working on the TAG_inheritance for a base class. */
9768 if (BINFO_VIRTUAL_P (decl) && is_cxx ())
9769 {
9770 /* For C++ virtual bases we can't just use BINFO_OFFSET, as they
9771 aren't at a fixed offset from all (sub)objects of the same
9772 type. We need to extract the appropriate offset from our
9773 vtable. The following dwarf expression means
9774
9775 BaseAddr = ObAddr + *((*ObAddr) - Offset)
9776
9777 This is specific to the V3 ABI, of course. */
9778
9779 dw_loc_descr_ref tmp;
9780
9781 /* Make a copy of the object address. */
9782 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0);
9783 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
9784
9785 /* Extract the vtable address. */
9786 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
9787 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
9788
9789 /* Calculate the address of the offset. */
9790 offset = tree_low_cst (BINFO_VPTR_FIELD (decl), 0);
9791 gcc_assert (offset < 0);
9792
9793 tmp = int_loc_descriptor (-offset);
9794 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
9795 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0);
9796 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
9797
9798 /* Extract the offset. */
9799 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
9800 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
9801
9802 /* Add it to the object address. */
9803 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0);
9804 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
9805 }
9806 else
9807 offset = tree_low_cst (BINFO_OFFSET (decl), 0);
9808 }
9809 else
9810 offset = field_byte_offset (decl);
9811
9812 if (! loc_descr)
9813 {
9814 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
9815
9816 /* The DWARF2 standard says that we should assume that the structure
9817 address is already on the stack, so we can specify a structure field
9818 address by using DW_OP_plus_uconst. */
9819
9820 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
9821 /* ??? The SGI dwarf reader does not handle the DW_OP_plus_uconst
9822 operator correctly. It works only if we leave the offset on the
9823 stack. */
9824 op = DW_OP_constu;
9825 #else
9826 op = DW_OP_plus_uconst;
9827 #endif
9828
9829 loc_descr = new_loc_descr (op, offset, 0);
9830 }
9831
9832 add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_data_member_location, loc_descr);
9833 }
9834
9835 /* Writes integer values to dw_vec_const array. */
9836
9837 static void
insert_int(HOST_WIDE_INT val,unsigned int size,unsigned char * dest)9838 insert_int (HOST_WIDE_INT val, unsigned int size, unsigned char *dest)
9839 {
9840 while (size != 0)
9841 {
9842 *dest++ = val & 0xff;
9843 val >>= 8;
9844 --size;
9845 }
9846 }
9847
9848 /* Reads integers from dw_vec_const array. Inverse of insert_int. */
9849
9850 static HOST_WIDE_INT
extract_int(const unsigned char * src,unsigned int size)9851 extract_int (const unsigned char *src, unsigned int size)
9852 {
9853 HOST_WIDE_INT val = 0;
9854
9855 src += size;
9856 while (size != 0)
9857 {
9858 val <<= 8;
9859 val |= *--src & 0xff;
9860 --size;
9861 }
9862 return val;
9863 }
9864
9865 /* Writes floating point values to dw_vec_const array. */
9866
9867 static void
insert_float(rtx rtl,unsigned char * array)9868 insert_float (rtx rtl, unsigned char *array)
9869 {
9870 REAL_VALUE_TYPE rv;
9871 long val[4];
9872 int i;
9873
9874 REAL_VALUE_FROM_CONST_DOUBLE (rv, rtl);
9875 real_to_target (val, &rv, GET_MODE (rtl));
9876
9877 /* real_to_target puts 32-bit pieces in each long. Pack them. */
9878 for (i = 0; i < GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl)) / 4; i++)
9879 {
9880 insert_int (val[i], 4, array);
9881 array += 4;
9882 }
9883 }
9884
9885 /* Attach a DW_AT_const_value attribute for a variable or a parameter which
9886 does not have a "location" either in memory or in a register. These
9887 things can arise in GNU C when a constant is passed as an actual parameter
9888 to an inlined function. They can also arise in C++ where declared
9889 constants do not necessarily get memory "homes". */
9890
9891 static void
add_const_value_attribute(dw_die_ref die,rtx rtl)9892 add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref die, rtx rtl)
9893 {
9894 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
9895 {
9896 case CONST_INT:
9897 {
9898 HOST_WIDE_INT val = INTVAL (rtl);
9899
9900 if (val < 0)
9901 add_AT_int (die, DW_AT_const_value, val);
9902 else
9903 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_const_value, (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) val);
9904 }
9905 break;
9906
9907 case CONST_DOUBLE:
9908 /* Note that a CONST_DOUBLE rtx could represent either an integer or a
9909 floating-point constant. A CONST_DOUBLE is used whenever the
9910 constant requires more than one word in order to be adequately
9911 represented. We output CONST_DOUBLEs as blocks. */
9912 {
9913 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
9914
9915 if (SCALAR_FLOAT_MODE_P (mode))
9916 {
9917 unsigned int length = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
9918 unsigned char *array = ggc_alloc (length);
9919
9920 insert_float (rtl, array);
9921 add_AT_vec (die, DW_AT_const_value, length / 4, 4, array);
9922 }
9923 else
9924 {
9925 /* ??? We really should be using HOST_WIDE_INT throughout. */
9926 gcc_assert (HOST_BITS_PER_LONG == HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT);
9927
9928 add_AT_long_long (die, DW_AT_const_value,
9929 CONST_DOUBLE_HIGH (rtl), CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (rtl));
9930 }
9931 }
9932 break;
9933
9934 case CONST_VECTOR:
9935 {
9936 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
9937 unsigned int elt_size = GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mode);
9938 unsigned int length = CONST_VECTOR_NUNITS (rtl);
9939 unsigned char *array = ggc_alloc (length * elt_size);
9940 unsigned int i;
9941 unsigned char *p;
9942
9943 switch (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode))
9944 {
9945 case MODE_VECTOR_INT:
9946 for (i = 0, p = array; i < length; i++, p += elt_size)
9947 {
9948 rtx elt = CONST_VECTOR_ELT (rtl, i);
9949 HOST_WIDE_INT lo, hi;
9950
9951 switch (GET_CODE (elt))
9952 {
9953 case CONST_INT:
9954 lo = INTVAL (elt);
9955 hi = -(lo < 0);
9956 break;
9957
9958 case CONST_DOUBLE:
9959 lo = CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (elt);
9960 hi = CONST_DOUBLE_HIGH (elt);
9961 break;
9962
9963 default:
9964 gcc_unreachable ();
9965 }
9966
9967 if (elt_size <= sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT))
9968 insert_int (lo, elt_size, p);
9969 else
9970 {
9971 unsigned char *p0 = p;
9972 unsigned char *p1 = p + sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT);
9973
9974 gcc_assert (elt_size == 2 * sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT));
9975 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
9976 {
9977 p0 = p1;
9978 p1 = p;
9979 }
9980 insert_int (lo, sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT), p0);
9981 insert_int (hi, sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT), p1);
9982 }
9983 }
9984 break;
9985
9986 case MODE_VECTOR_FLOAT:
9987 for (i = 0, p = array; i < length; i++, p += elt_size)
9988 {
9989 rtx elt = CONST_VECTOR_ELT (rtl, i);
9990 insert_float (elt, p);
9991 }
9992 break;
9993
9994 default:
9995 gcc_unreachable ();
9996 }
9997
9998 add_AT_vec (die, DW_AT_const_value, length, elt_size, array);
9999 }
10000 break;
10001
10002 case CONST_STRING:
10003 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_const_value, XSTR (rtl, 0));
10004 break;
10005
10006 case SYMBOL_REF:
10007 case LABEL_REF:
10008 case CONST:
10009 add_AT_addr (die, DW_AT_const_value, rtl);
10010 VEC_safe_push (rtx, gc, used_rtx_array, rtl);
10011 break;
10012
10013 case PLUS:
10014 /* In cases where an inlined instance of an inline function is passed
10015 the address of an `auto' variable (which is local to the caller) we
10016 can get a situation where the DECL_RTL of the artificial local
10017 variable (for the inlining) which acts as a stand-in for the
10018 corresponding formal parameter (of the inline function) will look
10019 like (plus:SI (reg:SI FRAME_PTR) (const_int ...)). This is not
10020 exactly a compile-time constant expression, but it isn't the address
10021 of the (artificial) local variable either. Rather, it represents the
10022 *value* which the artificial local variable always has during its
10023 lifetime. We currently have no way to represent such quasi-constant
10024 values in Dwarf, so for now we just punt and generate nothing. */
10025 break;
10026
10027 default:
10028 /* No other kinds of rtx should be possible here. */
10029 gcc_unreachable ();
10030 }
10031
10032 }
10033
10034 /* Determine whether the evaluation of EXPR references any variables
10035 or functions which aren't otherwise used (and therefore may not be
10036 output). */
10037 static tree
reference_to_unused(tree * tp,int * walk_subtrees,void * data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)10038 reference_to_unused (tree * tp, int * walk_subtrees,
10039 void * data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
10040 {
10041 if (! EXPR_P (*tp) && ! CONSTANT_CLASS_P (*tp))
10042 *walk_subtrees = 0;
10043
10044 if (DECL_P (*tp) && ! TREE_PUBLIC (*tp) && ! TREE_USED (*tp)
10045 && ! TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (*tp))
10046 return *tp;
10047 else if (!flag_unit_at_a_time)
10048 return NULL_TREE;
10049 else if (!cgraph_global_info_ready
10050 && (TREE_CODE (*tp) == VAR_DECL || TREE_CODE (*tp) == FUNCTION_DECL))
10051 return *tp;
10052 else if (DECL_P (*tp) && TREE_CODE (*tp) == VAR_DECL)
10053 {
10054 struct cgraph_varpool_node *node = cgraph_varpool_node (*tp);
10055 if (!node->needed)
10056 return *tp;
10057 }
10058 else if (DECL_P (*tp) && TREE_CODE (*tp) == FUNCTION_DECL
10059 && (!DECL_EXTERNAL (*tp) || DECL_DECLARED_INLINE_P (*tp)))
10060 {
10061 struct cgraph_node *node = cgraph_node (*tp);
10062 if (!node->output)
10063 return *tp;
10064 }
10065
10066 return NULL_TREE;
10067 }
10068
10069 /* Generate an RTL constant from a decl initializer INIT with decl type TYPE,
10070 for use in a later add_const_value_attribute call. */
10071
10072 static rtx
rtl_for_decl_init(tree init,tree type)10073 rtl_for_decl_init (tree init, tree type)
10074 {
10075 rtx rtl = NULL_RTX;
10076
10077 /* If a variable is initialized with a string constant without embedded
10078 zeros, build CONST_STRING. */
10079 if (TREE_CODE (init) == STRING_CST && TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
10080 {
10081 tree enttype = TREE_TYPE (type);
10082 tree domain = TYPE_DOMAIN (type);
10083 enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (enttype);
10084
10085 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == 1
10086 && domain
10087 && integer_zerop (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain))
10088 && compare_tree_int (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain),
10089 TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init) - 1) == 0
10090 && ((size_t) TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init)
10091 == strlen (TREE_STRING_POINTER (init)) + 1))
10092 rtl = gen_rtx_CONST_STRING (VOIDmode,
10093 ggc_strdup (TREE_STRING_POINTER (init)));
10094 }
10095 /* Other aggregates, and complex values, could be represented using
10096 CONCAT: FIXME! */
10097 else if (AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (type) || TREE_CODE (type) == COMPLEX_TYPE)
10098 ;
10099 /* Vectors only work if their mode is supported by the target.
10100 FIXME: generic vectors ought to work too. */
10101 else if (TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE && TYPE_MODE (type) == BLKmode)
10102 ;
10103 /* If the initializer is something that we know will expand into an
10104 immediate RTL constant, expand it now. We must be careful not to
10105 reference variables which won't be output. */
10106 else if (initializer_constant_valid_p (init, type)
10107 && ! walk_tree (&init, reference_to_unused, NULL, NULL))
10108 {
10109 /* Convert vector CONSTRUCTOR initializers to VECTOR_CST if
10110 possible. */
10111 if (TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE)
10112 switch (TREE_CODE (init))
10113 {
10114 case VECTOR_CST:
10115 break;
10116 case CONSTRUCTOR:
10117 if (TREE_CONSTANT (init))
10118 {
10119 VEC(constructor_elt,gc) *elts = CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (init);
10120 bool constant_p = true;
10121 tree value;
10122 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT ix;
10123
10124 /* Even when ctor is constant, it might contain non-*_CST
10125 elements (e.g. { 1.0/0.0 - 1.0/0.0, 0.0 }) and those don't
10126 belong into VECTOR_CST nodes. */
10127 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_VALUE (elts, ix, value)
10128 if (!CONSTANT_CLASS_P (value))
10129 {
10130 constant_p = false;
10131 break;
10132 }
10133
10134 if (constant_p)
10135 {
10136 init = build_vector_from_ctor (type, elts);
10137 break;
10138 }
10139 }
10140 /* FALLTHRU */
10141
10142 default:
10143 return NULL;
10144 }
10145
10146 rtl = expand_expr (init, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_INITIALIZER);
10147
10148 /* If expand_expr returns a MEM, it wasn't immediate. */
10149 gcc_assert (!rtl || !MEM_P (rtl));
10150 }
10151
10152 return rtl;
10153 }
10154
10155 /* Generate RTL for the variable DECL to represent its location. */
10156
10157 static rtx
rtl_for_decl_location(tree decl)10158 rtl_for_decl_location (tree decl)
10159 {
10160 rtx rtl;
10161
10162 /* Here we have to decide where we are going to say the parameter "lives"
10163 (as far as the debugger is concerned). We only have a couple of
10164 choices. GCC provides us with DECL_RTL and with DECL_INCOMING_RTL.
10165
10166 DECL_RTL normally indicates where the parameter lives during most of the
10167 activation of the function. If optimization is enabled however, this
10168 could be either NULL or else a pseudo-reg. Both of those cases indicate
10169 that the parameter doesn't really live anywhere (as far as the code
10170 generation parts of GCC are concerned) during most of the function's
10171 activation. That will happen (for example) if the parameter is never
10172 referenced within the function.
10173
10174 We could just generate a location descriptor here for all non-NULL
10175 non-pseudo values of DECL_RTL and ignore all of the rest, but we can be
10176 a little nicer than that if we also consider DECL_INCOMING_RTL in cases
10177 where DECL_RTL is NULL or is a pseudo-reg.
10178
10179 Note however that we can only get away with using DECL_INCOMING_RTL as
10180 a backup substitute for DECL_RTL in certain limited cases. In cases
10181 where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) indicates the same type as TREE_TYPE (decl),
10182 we can be sure that the parameter was passed using the same type as it is
10183 declared to have within the function, and that its DECL_INCOMING_RTL
10184 points us to a place where a value of that type is passed.
10185
10186 In cases where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) and TREE_TYPE (decl) are different,
10187 we cannot (in general) use DECL_INCOMING_RTL as a substitute for DECL_RTL
10188 because in these cases DECL_INCOMING_RTL points us to a value of some
10189 type which is *different* from the type of the parameter itself. Thus,
10190 if we tried to use DECL_INCOMING_RTL to generate a location attribute in
10191 such cases, the debugger would end up (for example) trying to fetch a
10192 `float' from a place which actually contains the first part of a
10193 `double'. That would lead to really incorrect and confusing
10194 output at debug-time.
10195
10196 So, in general, we *do not* use DECL_INCOMING_RTL as a backup for DECL_RTL
10197 in cases where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) != TREE_TYPE (decl). There
10198 are a couple of exceptions however. On little-endian machines we can
10199 get away with using DECL_INCOMING_RTL even when DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) is
10200 not the same as TREE_TYPE (decl), but only when DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) is
10201 an integral type that is smaller than TREE_TYPE (decl). These cases arise
10202 when (on a little-endian machine) a non-prototyped function has a
10203 parameter declared to be of type `short' or `char'. In such cases,
10204 TREE_TYPE (decl) will be `short' or `char', DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) will
10205 be `int', and DECL_INCOMING_RTL will point to the lowest-order byte of the
10206 passed `int' value. If the debugger then uses that address to fetch
10207 a `short' or a `char' (on a little-endian machine) the result will be
10208 the correct data, so we allow for such exceptional cases below.
10209
10210 Note that our goal here is to describe the place where the given formal
10211 parameter lives during most of the function's activation (i.e. between the
10212 end of the prologue and the start of the epilogue). We'll do that as best
10213 as we can. Note however that if the given formal parameter is modified
10214 sometime during the execution of the function, then a stack backtrace (at
10215 debug-time) will show the function as having been called with the *new*
10216 value rather than the value which was originally passed in. This happens
10217 rarely enough that it is not a major problem, but it *is* a problem, and
10218 I'd like to fix it.
10219
10220 A future version of dwarf2out.c may generate two additional attributes for
10221 any given DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE which will describe the "passed
10222 type" and the "passed location" for the given formal parameter in addition
10223 to the attributes we now generate to indicate the "declared type" and the
10224 "active location" for each parameter. This additional set of attributes
10225 could be used by debuggers for stack backtraces. Separately, note that
10226 sometimes DECL_RTL can be NULL and DECL_INCOMING_RTL can be NULL also.
10227 This happens (for example) for inlined-instances of inline function formal
10228 parameters which are never referenced. This really shouldn't be
10229 happening. All PARM_DECL nodes should get valid non-NULL
10230 DECL_INCOMING_RTL values. FIXME. */
10231
10232 /* Use DECL_RTL as the "location" unless we find something better. */
10233 rtl = DECL_RTL_IF_SET (decl);
10234
10235 /* When generating abstract instances, ignore everything except
10236 constants, symbols living in memory, and symbols living in
10237 fixed registers. */
10238 if (! reload_completed)
10239 {
10240 if (rtl
10241 && (CONSTANT_P (rtl)
10242 || (MEM_P (rtl)
10243 && CONSTANT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0)))
10244 || (REG_P (rtl)
10245 && TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL
10246 && TREE_STATIC (decl))))
10247 {
10248 rtl = targetm.delegitimize_address (rtl);
10249 return rtl;
10250 }
10251 rtl = NULL_RTX;
10252 }
10253 else if (TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL)
10254 {
10255 if (rtl == NULL_RTX || is_pseudo_reg (rtl))
10256 {
10257 tree declared_type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
10258 tree passed_type = DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl);
10259 enum machine_mode dmode = TYPE_MODE (declared_type);
10260 enum machine_mode pmode = TYPE_MODE (passed_type);
10261
10262 /* This decl represents a formal parameter which was optimized out.
10263 Note that DECL_INCOMING_RTL may be NULL in here, but we handle
10264 all cases where (rtl == NULL_RTX) just below. */
10265 if (dmode == pmode)
10266 rtl = DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl);
10267 else if (SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (dmode)
10268 && GET_MODE_SIZE (dmode) <= GET_MODE_SIZE (pmode)
10269 && DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl))
10270 {
10271 rtx inc = DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl);
10272 if (REG_P (inc))
10273 rtl = inc;
10274 else if (MEM_P (inc))
10275 {
10276 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
10277 rtl = adjust_address_nv (inc, dmode,
10278 GET_MODE_SIZE (pmode)
10279 - GET_MODE_SIZE (dmode));
10280 else
10281 rtl = inc;
10282 }
10283 }
10284 }
10285
10286 /* If the parm was passed in registers, but lives on the stack, then
10287 make a big endian correction if the mode of the type of the
10288 parameter is not the same as the mode of the rtl. */
10289 /* ??? This is the same series of checks that are made in dbxout.c before
10290 we reach the big endian correction code there. It isn't clear if all
10291 of these checks are necessary here, but keeping them all is the safe
10292 thing to do. */
10293 else if (MEM_P (rtl)
10294 && XEXP (rtl, 0) != const0_rtx
10295 && ! CONSTANT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
10296 /* Not passed in memory. */
10297 && !MEM_P (DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl))
10298 /* Not passed by invisible reference. */
10299 && (!REG_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
10300 || REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
10301 || REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
10302 #if ARG_POINTER_REGNUM != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
10303 || REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
10304 #endif
10305 )
10306 /* Big endian correction check. */
10307 && BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
10308 && TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) != GET_MODE (rtl)
10309 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)))
10310 < UNITS_PER_WORD))
10311 {
10312 int offset = (UNITS_PER_WORD
10313 - GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl))));
10314
10315 rtl = gen_rtx_MEM (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
10316 plus_constant (XEXP (rtl, 0), offset));
10317 }
10318 }
10319 else if (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL
10320 && rtl
10321 && MEM_P (rtl)
10322 && GET_MODE (rtl) != TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl))
10323 && BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
10324 {
10325 int rsize = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl));
10326 int dsize = GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)));
10327
10328 /* If a variable is declared "register" yet is smaller than
10329 a register, then if we store the variable to memory, it
10330 looks like we're storing a register-sized value, when in
10331 fact we are not. We need to adjust the offset of the
10332 storage location to reflect the actual value's bytes,
10333 else gdb will not be able to display it. */
10334 if (rsize > dsize)
10335 rtl = gen_rtx_MEM (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
10336 plus_constant (XEXP (rtl, 0), rsize-dsize));
10337 }
10338
10339 /* A variable with no DECL_RTL but a DECL_INITIAL is a compile-time constant,
10340 and will have been substituted directly into all expressions that use it.
10341 C does not have such a concept, but C++ and other languages do. */
10342 if (!rtl && TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL && DECL_INITIAL (decl))
10343 rtl = rtl_for_decl_init (DECL_INITIAL (decl), TREE_TYPE (decl));
10344
10345 if (rtl)
10346 rtl = targetm.delegitimize_address (rtl);
10347
10348 /* If we don't look past the constant pool, we risk emitting a
10349 reference to a constant pool entry that isn't referenced from
10350 code, and thus is not emitted. */
10351 if (rtl)
10352 rtl = avoid_constant_pool_reference (rtl);
10353
10354 return rtl;
10355 }
10356
10357 /* We need to figure out what section we should use as the base for the
10358 address ranges where a given location is valid.
10359 1. If this particular DECL has a section associated with it, use that.
10360 2. If this function has a section associated with it, use that.
10361 3. Otherwise, use the text section.
10362 XXX: If you split a variable across multiple sections, we won't notice. */
10363
10364 static const char *
secname_for_decl(tree decl)10365 secname_for_decl (tree decl)
10366 {
10367 const char *secname;
10368
10369 if (VAR_OR_FUNCTION_DECL_P (decl) && DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl))
10370 {
10371 tree sectree = DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl);
10372 secname = TREE_STRING_POINTER (sectree);
10373 }
10374 else if (current_function_decl && DECL_SECTION_NAME (current_function_decl))
10375 {
10376 tree sectree = DECL_SECTION_NAME (current_function_decl);
10377 secname = TREE_STRING_POINTER (sectree);
10378 }
10379 else if (cfun && in_cold_section_p)
10380 secname = cfun->cold_section_label;
10381 else
10382 secname = text_section_label;
10383
10384 return secname;
10385 }
10386
10387 /* Generate *either* a DW_AT_location attribute or else a DW_AT_const_value
10388 data attribute for a variable or a parameter. We generate the
10389 DW_AT_const_value attribute only in those cases where the given variable
10390 or parameter does not have a true "location" either in memory or in a
10391 register. This can happen (for example) when a constant is passed as an
10392 actual argument in a call to an inline function. (It's possible that
10393 these things can crop up in other ways also.) Note that one type of
10394 constant value which can be passed into an inlined function is a constant
10395 pointer. This can happen for example if an actual argument in an inlined
10396 function call evaluates to a compile-time constant address. */
10397
10398 static void
add_location_or_const_value_attribute(dw_die_ref die,tree decl,enum dwarf_attribute attr)10399 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl,
10400 enum dwarf_attribute attr)
10401 {
10402 rtx rtl;
10403 dw_loc_descr_ref descr;
10404 var_loc_list *loc_list;
10405 struct var_loc_node *node;
10406 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == ERROR_MARK)
10407 return;
10408
10409 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL || TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL
10410 || TREE_CODE (decl) == RESULT_DECL);
10411
10412 /* See if we possibly have multiple locations for this variable. */
10413 loc_list = lookup_decl_loc (decl);
10414
10415 /* If it truly has multiple locations, the first and last node will
10416 differ. */
10417 if (loc_list && loc_list->first != loc_list->last)
10418 {
10419 const char *endname, *secname;
10420 dw_loc_list_ref list;
10421 rtx varloc;
10422
10423 /* Now that we know what section we are using for a base,
10424 actually construct the list of locations.
10425 The first location information is what is passed to the
10426 function that creates the location list, and the remaining
10427 locations just get added on to that list.
10428 Note that we only know the start address for a location
10429 (IE location changes), so to build the range, we use
10430 the range [current location start, next location start].
10431 This means we have to special case the last node, and generate
10432 a range of [last location start, end of function label]. */
10433
10434 node = loc_list->first;
10435 varloc = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (node->var_loc_note);
10436 secname = secname_for_decl (decl);
10437
10438 list = new_loc_list (loc_descriptor (varloc),
10439 node->label, node->next->label, secname, 1);
10440 node = node->next;
10441
10442 for (; node->next; node = node->next)
10443 if (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (node->var_loc_note) != NULL_RTX)
10444 {
10445 /* The variable has a location between NODE->LABEL and
10446 NODE->NEXT->LABEL. */
10447 varloc = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (node->var_loc_note);
10448 add_loc_descr_to_loc_list (&list, loc_descriptor (varloc),
10449 node->label, node->next->label, secname);
10450 }
10451
10452 /* If the variable has a location at the last label
10453 it keeps its location until the end of function. */
10454 if (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (node->var_loc_note) != NULL_RTX)
10455 {
10456 char label_id[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
10457
10458 varloc = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (node->var_loc_note);
10459 if (!current_function_decl)
10460 endname = text_end_label;
10461 else
10462 {
10463 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_id, FUNC_END_LABEL,
10464 current_function_funcdef_no);
10465 endname = ggc_strdup (label_id);
10466 }
10467 add_loc_descr_to_loc_list (&list, loc_descriptor (varloc),
10468 node->label, endname, secname);
10469 }
10470
10471 /* Finally, add the location list to the DIE, and we are done. */
10472 add_AT_loc_list (die, attr, list);
10473 return;
10474 }
10475
10476 /* Try to get some constant RTL for this decl, and use that as the value of
10477 the location. */
10478
10479 rtl = rtl_for_decl_location (decl);
10480 if (rtl && (CONSTANT_P (rtl) || GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_STRING))
10481 {
10482 add_const_value_attribute (die, rtl);
10483 return;
10484 }
10485
10486 /* If we have tried to generate the location otherwise, and it
10487 didn't work out (we wouldn't be here if we did), and we have a one entry
10488 location list, try generating a location from that. */
10489 if (loc_list && loc_list->first)
10490 {
10491 node = loc_list->first;
10492 descr = loc_descriptor (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (node->var_loc_note));
10493 if (descr)
10494 {
10495 add_AT_location_description (die, attr, descr);
10496 return;
10497 }
10498 }
10499
10500 /* We couldn't get any rtl, so try directly generating the location
10501 description from the tree. */
10502 descr = loc_descriptor_from_tree (decl);
10503 if (descr)
10504 {
10505 add_AT_location_description (die, attr, descr);
10506 return;
10507 }
10508 /* None of that worked, so it must not really have a location;
10509 try adding a constant value attribute from the DECL_INITIAL. */
10510 tree_add_const_value_attribute (die, decl);
10511 }
10512
10513 /* If we don't have a copy of this variable in memory for some reason (such
10514 as a C++ member constant that doesn't have an out-of-line definition),
10515 we should tell the debugger about the constant value. */
10516
10517 static void
tree_add_const_value_attribute(dw_die_ref var_die,tree decl)10518 tree_add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref var_die, tree decl)
10519 {
10520 tree init = DECL_INITIAL (decl);
10521 tree type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
10522 rtx rtl;
10523
10524 if (TREE_READONLY (decl) && ! TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl) && init)
10525 /* OK */;
10526 else
10527 return;
10528
10529 rtl = rtl_for_decl_init (init, type);
10530 if (rtl)
10531 add_const_value_attribute (var_die, rtl);
10532 }
10533
10534 /* Convert the CFI instructions for the current function into a
10535 location list. This is used for DW_AT_frame_base when we targeting
10536 a dwarf2 consumer that does not support the dwarf3
10537 DW_OP_call_frame_cfa. OFFSET is a constant to be added to all CFA
10538 expressions. */
10539
10540 static dw_loc_list_ref
convert_cfa_to_fb_loc_list(HOST_WIDE_INT offset)10541 convert_cfa_to_fb_loc_list (HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
10542 {
10543 dw_fde_ref fde;
10544 dw_loc_list_ref list, *list_tail;
10545 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
10546 dw_cfa_location last_cfa, next_cfa;
10547 const char *start_label, *last_label, *section;
10548
10549 fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use - 1];
10550
10551 section = secname_for_decl (current_function_decl);
10552 list_tail = &list;
10553 list = NULL;
10554
10555 next_cfa.reg = INVALID_REGNUM;
10556 next_cfa.offset = 0;
10557 next_cfa.indirect = 0;
10558 next_cfa.base_offset = 0;
10559
10560 start_label = fde->dw_fde_begin;
10561
10562 /* ??? Bald assumption that the CIE opcode list does not contain
10563 advance opcodes. */
10564 for (cfi = cie_cfi_head; cfi; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
10565 lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, &next_cfa);
10566
10567 last_cfa = next_cfa;
10568 last_label = start_label;
10569
10570 for (cfi = fde->dw_fde_cfi; cfi; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
10571 switch (cfi->dw_cfi_opc)
10572 {
10573 case DW_CFA_set_loc:
10574 case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
10575 case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
10576 case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
10577 if (!cfa_equal_p (&last_cfa, &next_cfa))
10578 {
10579 *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&last_cfa, offset),
10580 start_label, last_label, section,
10581 list == NULL);
10582
10583 list_tail = &(*list_tail)->dw_loc_next;
10584 last_cfa = next_cfa;
10585 start_label = last_label;
10586 }
10587 last_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
10588 break;
10589
10590 case DW_CFA_advance_loc:
10591 /* The encoding is complex enough that we should never emit this. */
10592 case DW_CFA_remember_state:
10593 case DW_CFA_restore_state:
10594 /* We don't handle these two in this function. It would be possible
10595 if it were to be required. */
10596 gcc_unreachable ();
10597
10598 default:
10599 lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, &next_cfa);
10600 break;
10601 }
10602
10603 if (!cfa_equal_p (&last_cfa, &next_cfa))
10604 {
10605 *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&last_cfa, offset),
10606 start_label, last_label, section,
10607 list == NULL);
10608 list_tail = &(*list_tail)->dw_loc_next;
10609 start_label = last_label;
10610 }
10611 *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&next_cfa, offset),
10612 start_label, fde->dw_fde_end, section,
10613 list == NULL);
10614
10615 return list;
10616 }
10617
10618 /* Compute a displacement from the "steady-state frame pointer" to the
10619 frame base (often the same as the CFA), and store it in
10620 frame_pointer_fb_offset. OFFSET is added to the displacement
10621 before the latter is negated. */
10622
10623 static void
compute_frame_pointer_to_fb_displacement(HOST_WIDE_INT offset)10624 compute_frame_pointer_to_fb_displacement (HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
10625 {
10626 rtx reg, elim;
10627
10628 #ifdef FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET
10629 reg = frame_pointer_rtx;
10630 offset += FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (current_function_decl);
10631 #else
10632 reg = arg_pointer_rtx;
10633 offset += ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (current_function_decl);
10634 #endif
10635
10636 elim = eliminate_regs (reg, VOIDmode, NULL_RTX);
10637 if (GET_CODE (elim) == PLUS)
10638 {
10639 offset += INTVAL (XEXP (elim, 1));
10640 elim = XEXP (elim, 0);
10641 }
10642 gcc_assert (elim == (frame_pointer_needed ? hard_frame_pointer_rtx
10643 : stack_pointer_rtx));
10644
10645 frame_pointer_fb_offset = -offset;
10646 }
10647
10648 /* Generate a DW_AT_name attribute given some string value to be included as
10649 the value of the attribute. */
10650
10651 static void
add_name_attribute(dw_die_ref die,const char * name_string)10652 add_name_attribute (dw_die_ref die, const char *name_string)
10653 {
10654 if (name_string != NULL && *name_string != 0)
10655 {
10656 if (demangle_name_func)
10657 name_string = (*demangle_name_func) (name_string);
10658
10659 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_name, name_string);
10660 }
10661 }
10662
10663 /* Generate a DW_AT_comp_dir attribute for DIE. */
10664
10665 static void
add_comp_dir_attribute(dw_die_ref die)10666 add_comp_dir_attribute (dw_die_ref die)
10667 {
10668 const char *wd = get_src_pwd ();
10669 if (wd != NULL)
10670 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_comp_dir, wd);
10671 }
10672
10673 /* Given a tree node describing an array bound (either lower or upper) output
10674 a representation for that bound. */
10675
10676 static void
add_bound_info(dw_die_ref subrange_die,enum dwarf_attribute bound_attr,tree bound)10677 add_bound_info (dw_die_ref subrange_die, enum dwarf_attribute bound_attr, tree bound)
10678 {
10679 switch (TREE_CODE (bound))
10680 {
10681 case ERROR_MARK:
10682 return;
10683
10684 /* All fixed-bounds are represented by INTEGER_CST nodes. */
10685 case INTEGER_CST:
10686 if (! host_integerp (bound, 0)
10687 || (bound_attr == DW_AT_lower_bound
10688 && (((is_c_family () || is_java ()) && integer_zerop (bound))
10689 || (is_fortran () && integer_onep (bound)))))
10690 /* Use the default. */
10691 ;
10692 else
10693 add_AT_unsigned (subrange_die, bound_attr, tree_low_cst (bound, 0));
10694 break;
10695
10696 case CONVERT_EXPR:
10697 case NOP_EXPR:
10698 case NON_LVALUE_EXPR:
10699 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
10700 add_bound_info (subrange_die, bound_attr, TREE_OPERAND (bound, 0));
10701 break;
10702
10703 case SAVE_EXPR:
10704 break;
10705
10706 case VAR_DECL:
10707 case PARM_DECL:
10708 case RESULT_DECL:
10709 {
10710 dw_die_ref decl_die = lookup_decl_die (bound);
10711
10712 /* ??? Can this happen, or should the variable have been bound
10713 first? Probably it can, since I imagine that we try to create
10714 the types of parameters in the order in which they exist in
10715 the list, and won't have created a forward reference to a
10716 later parameter. */
10717 if (decl_die != NULL)
10718 add_AT_die_ref (subrange_die, bound_attr, decl_die);
10719 break;
10720 }
10721
10722 default:
10723 {
10724 /* Otherwise try to create a stack operation procedure to
10725 evaluate the value of the array bound. */
10726
10727 dw_die_ref ctx, decl_die;
10728 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
10729
10730 loc = loc_descriptor_from_tree (bound);
10731 if (loc == NULL)
10732 break;
10733
10734 if (current_function_decl == 0)
10735 ctx = comp_unit_die;
10736 else
10737 ctx = lookup_decl_die (current_function_decl);
10738
10739 decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_variable, ctx, bound);
10740 add_AT_flag (decl_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
10741 add_type_attribute (decl_die, TREE_TYPE (bound), 1, 0, ctx);
10742 add_AT_loc (decl_die, DW_AT_location, loc);
10743
10744 add_AT_die_ref (subrange_die, bound_attr, decl_die);
10745 break;
10746 }
10747 }
10748 }
10749
10750 /* Note that the block of subscript information for an array type also
10751 includes information about the element type of type given array type. */
10752
10753 static void
add_subscript_info(dw_die_ref type_die,tree type)10754 add_subscript_info (dw_die_ref type_die, tree type)
10755 {
10756 #ifndef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
10757 unsigned dimension_number;
10758 #endif
10759 tree lower, upper;
10760 dw_die_ref subrange_die;
10761
10762 /* The GNU compilers represent multidimensional array types as sequences of
10763 one dimensional array types whose element types are themselves array
10764 types. Here we squish that down, so that each multidimensional array
10765 type gets only one array_type DIE in the Dwarf debugging info. The draft
10766 Dwarf specification say that we are allowed to do this kind of
10767 compression in C (because there is no difference between an array or
10768 arrays and a multidimensional array in C) but for other source languages
10769 (e.g. Ada) we probably shouldn't do this. */
10770
10771 /* ??? The SGI dwarf reader fails for multidimensional arrays with a
10772 const enum type. E.g. const enum machine_mode insn_operand_mode[2][10].
10773 We work around this by disabling this feature. See also
10774 gen_array_type_die. */
10775 #ifndef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
10776 for (dimension_number = 0;
10777 TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE;
10778 type = TREE_TYPE (type), dimension_number++)
10779 #endif
10780 {
10781 tree domain = TYPE_DOMAIN (type);
10782
10783 /* Arrays come in three flavors: Unspecified bounds, fixed bounds,
10784 and (in GNU C only) variable bounds. Handle all three forms
10785 here. */
10786 subrange_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subrange_type, type_die, NULL);
10787 if (domain)
10788 {
10789 /* We have an array type with specified bounds. */
10790 lower = TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain);
10791 upper = TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain);
10792
10793 /* Define the index type. */
10794 if (TREE_TYPE (domain))
10795 {
10796 /* ??? This is probably an Ada unnamed subrange type. Ignore the
10797 TREE_TYPE field. We can't emit debug info for this
10798 because it is an unnamed integral type. */
10799 if (TREE_CODE (domain) == INTEGER_TYPE
10800 && TYPE_NAME (domain) == NULL_TREE
10801 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (domain)) == INTEGER_TYPE
10802 && TYPE_NAME (TREE_TYPE (domain)) == NULL_TREE)
10803 ;
10804 else
10805 add_type_attribute (subrange_die, TREE_TYPE (domain), 0, 0,
10806 type_die);
10807 }
10808
10809 /* ??? If upper is NULL, the array has unspecified length,
10810 but it does have a lower bound. This happens with Fortran
10811 dimension arr(N:*)
10812 Since the debugger is definitely going to need to know N
10813 to produce useful results, go ahead and output the lower
10814 bound solo, and hope the debugger can cope. */
10815
10816 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound, lower);
10817 if (upper)
10818 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound, upper);
10819 }
10820
10821 /* Otherwise we have an array type with an unspecified length. The
10822 DWARF-2 spec does not say how to handle this; let's just leave out the
10823 bounds. */
10824 }
10825 }
10826
10827 static void
add_byte_size_attribute(dw_die_ref die,tree tree_node)10828 add_byte_size_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree tree_node)
10829 {
10830 unsigned size;
10831
10832 switch (TREE_CODE (tree_node))
10833 {
10834 case ERROR_MARK:
10835 size = 0;
10836 break;
10837 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
10838 case RECORD_TYPE:
10839 case UNION_TYPE:
10840 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
10841 size = int_size_in_bytes (tree_node);
10842 break;
10843 case FIELD_DECL:
10844 /* For a data member of a struct or union, the DW_AT_byte_size is
10845 generally given as the number of bytes normally allocated for an
10846 object of the *declared* type of the member itself. This is true
10847 even for bit-fields. */
10848 size = simple_type_size_in_bits (field_type (tree_node)) / BITS_PER_UNIT;
10849 break;
10850 default:
10851 gcc_unreachable ();
10852 }
10853
10854 /* Note that `size' might be -1 when we get to this point. If it is, that
10855 indicates that the byte size of the entity in question is variable. We
10856 have no good way of expressing this fact in Dwarf at the present time.
10857 GCC/35998: Avoid passing negative sizes to Dtrace and gdb. */
10858 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_byte_size, (size != (unsigned)-1 ? size : 0));
10859 }
10860
10861 /* For a FIELD_DECL node which represents a bit-field, output an attribute
10862 which specifies the distance in bits from the highest order bit of the
10863 "containing object" for the bit-field to the highest order bit of the
10864 bit-field itself.
10865
10866 For any given bit-field, the "containing object" is a hypothetical object
10867 (of some integral or enum type) within which the given bit-field lives. The
10868 type of this hypothetical "containing object" is always the same as the
10869 declared type of the individual bit-field itself. The determination of the
10870 exact location of the "containing object" for a bit-field is rather
10871 complicated. It's handled by the `field_byte_offset' function (above).
10872
10873 Note that it is the size (in bytes) of the hypothetical "containing object"
10874 which will be given in the DW_AT_byte_size attribute for this bit-field.
10875 (See `byte_size_attribute' above). */
10876
10877 static inline void
add_bit_offset_attribute(dw_die_ref die,tree decl)10878 add_bit_offset_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
10879 {
10880 HOST_WIDE_INT object_offset_in_bytes = field_byte_offset (decl);
10881 tree type = DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl);
10882 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos_int;
10883 HOST_WIDE_INT highest_order_object_bit_offset;
10884 HOST_WIDE_INT highest_order_field_bit_offset;
10885 HOST_WIDE_INT unsigned bit_offset;
10886
10887 /* Must be a field and a bit field. */
10888 gcc_assert (type && TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL);
10889
10890 /* We can't yet handle bit-fields whose offsets are variable, so if we
10891 encounter such things, just return without generating any attribute
10892 whatsoever. Likewise for variable or too large size. */
10893 if (! host_integerp (bit_position (decl), 0)
10894 || ! host_integerp (DECL_SIZE (decl), 1))
10895 return;
10896
10897 bitpos_int = int_bit_position (decl);
10898
10899 /* Note that the bit offset is always the distance (in bits) from the
10900 highest-order bit of the "containing object" to the highest-order bit of
10901 the bit-field itself. Since the "high-order end" of any object or field
10902 is different on big-endian and little-endian machines, the computation
10903 below must take account of these differences. */
10904 highest_order_object_bit_offset = object_offset_in_bytes * BITS_PER_UNIT;
10905 highest_order_field_bit_offset = bitpos_int;
10906
10907 if (! BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
10908 {
10909 highest_order_field_bit_offset += tree_low_cst (DECL_SIZE (decl), 0);
10910 highest_order_object_bit_offset += simple_type_size_in_bits (type);
10911 }
10912
10913 bit_offset
10914 = (! BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
10915 ? highest_order_object_bit_offset - highest_order_field_bit_offset
10916 : highest_order_field_bit_offset - highest_order_object_bit_offset);
10917
10918 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_bit_offset, bit_offset);
10919 }
10920
10921 /* For a FIELD_DECL node which represents a bit field, output an attribute
10922 which specifies the length in bits of the given field. */
10923
10924 static inline void
add_bit_size_attribute(dw_die_ref die,tree decl)10925 add_bit_size_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
10926 {
10927 /* Must be a field and a bit field. */
10928 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL
10929 && DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl));
10930
10931 if (host_integerp (DECL_SIZE (decl), 1))
10932 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_bit_size, tree_low_cst (DECL_SIZE (decl), 1));
10933 }
10934
10935 /* If the compiled language is ANSI C, then add a 'prototyped'
10936 attribute, if arg types are given for the parameters of a function. */
10937
10938 static inline void
add_prototyped_attribute(dw_die_ref die,tree func_type)10939 add_prototyped_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree func_type)
10940 {
10941 if (get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language) == DW_LANG_C89
10942 && TYPE_ARG_TYPES (func_type) != NULL)
10943 add_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_prototyped, 1);
10944 }
10945
10946 /* Add an 'abstract_origin' attribute below a given DIE. The DIE is found
10947 by looking in either the type declaration or object declaration
10948 equate table. */
10949
10950 static inline void
add_abstract_origin_attribute(dw_die_ref die,tree origin)10951 add_abstract_origin_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree origin)
10952 {
10953 dw_die_ref origin_die = NULL;
10954
10955 if (TREE_CODE (origin) != FUNCTION_DECL)
10956 {
10957 /* We may have gotten separated from the block for the inlined
10958 function, if we're in an exception handler or some such; make
10959 sure that the abstract function has been written out.
10960
10961 Doing this for nested functions is wrong, however; functions are
10962 distinct units, and our context might not even be inline. */
10963 tree fn = origin;
10964
10965 if (TYPE_P (fn))
10966 fn = TYPE_STUB_DECL (fn);
10967
10968 fn = decl_function_context (fn);
10969 if (fn)
10970 dwarf2out_abstract_function (fn);
10971 }
10972
10973 if (DECL_P (origin))
10974 origin_die = lookup_decl_die (origin);
10975 else if (TYPE_P (origin))
10976 origin_die = lookup_type_die (origin);
10977
10978 /* XXX: Functions that are never lowered don't always have correct block
10979 trees (in the case of java, they simply have no block tree, in some other
10980 languages). For these functions, there is nothing we can really do to
10981 output correct debug info for inlined functions in all cases. Rather
10982 than die, we'll just produce deficient debug info now, in that we will
10983 have variables without a proper abstract origin. In the future, when all
10984 functions are lowered, we should re-add a gcc_assert (origin_die)
10985 here. */
10986
10987 if (origin_die)
10988 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin, origin_die);
10989 }
10990
10991 /* We do not currently support the pure_virtual attribute. */
10992
10993 static inline void
add_pure_or_virtual_attribute(dw_die_ref die,tree func_decl)10994 add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree func_decl)
10995 {
10996 if (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl))
10997 {
10998 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_virtuality, DW_VIRTUALITY_virtual);
10999
11000 if (host_integerp (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl), 0))
11001 add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_vtable_elem_location,
11002 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_constu,
11003 tree_low_cst (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl), 0),
11004 0));
11005
11006 /* GNU extension: Record what type this method came from originally. */
11007 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
11008 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_containing_type,
11009 lookup_type_die (DECL_CONTEXT (func_decl)));
11010 }
11011 }
11012
11013 /* Add source coordinate attributes for the given decl. */
11014
11015 static void
add_src_coords_attributes(dw_die_ref die,tree decl)11016 add_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
11017 {
11018 expanded_location s = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
11019
11020 add_AT_file (die, DW_AT_decl_file, lookup_filename (s.file));
11021 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_decl_line, s.line);
11022 }
11023
11024 /* Add a DW_AT_name attribute and source coordinate attribute for the
11025 given decl, but only if it actually has a name. */
11026
11027 static void
add_name_and_src_coords_attributes(dw_die_ref die,tree decl)11028 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
11029 {
11030 tree decl_name;
11031
11032 decl_name = DECL_NAME (decl);
11033 if (decl_name != NULL && IDENTIFIER_POINTER (decl_name) != NULL)
11034 {
11035 add_name_attribute (die, dwarf2_name (decl, 0));
11036 if (! DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
11037 add_src_coords_attributes (die, decl);
11038
11039 if ((TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL || TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL)
11040 && TREE_PUBLIC (decl)
11041 && DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl) != DECL_NAME (decl)
11042 && !DECL_ABSTRACT (decl)
11043 && !(TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL && DECL_REGISTER (decl)))
11044 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name,
11045 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl)));
11046 }
11047
11048 #ifdef VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
11049 /* Get the function's name, as described by its RTL. This may be different
11050 from the DECL_NAME name used in the source file. */
11051 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL && TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl))
11052 {
11053 add_AT_addr (die, DW_AT_VMS_rtnbeg_pd_address,
11054 XEXP (DECL_RTL (decl), 0));
11055 VEC_safe_push (tree, gc, used_rtx_array, XEXP (DECL_RTL (decl), 0));
11056 }
11057 #endif
11058 }
11059
11060 /* Push a new declaration scope. */
11061
11062 static void
push_decl_scope(tree scope)11063 push_decl_scope (tree scope)
11064 {
11065 VEC_safe_push (tree, gc, decl_scope_table, scope);
11066 }
11067
11068 /* Pop a declaration scope. */
11069
11070 static inline void
pop_decl_scope(void)11071 pop_decl_scope (void)
11072 {
11073 VEC_pop (tree, decl_scope_table);
11074 }
11075
11076 /* Return the DIE for the scope that immediately contains this type.
11077 Non-named types get global scope. Named types nested in other
11078 types get their containing scope if it's open, or global scope
11079 otherwise. All other types (i.e. function-local named types) get
11080 the current active scope. */
11081
11082 static dw_die_ref
scope_die_for(tree t,dw_die_ref context_die)11083 scope_die_for (tree t, dw_die_ref context_die)
11084 {
11085 dw_die_ref scope_die = NULL;
11086 tree containing_scope;
11087 int i;
11088
11089 /* Non-types always go in the current scope. */
11090 gcc_assert (TYPE_P (t));
11091
11092 containing_scope = TYPE_CONTEXT (t);
11093
11094 /* Use the containing namespace if it was passed in (for a declaration). */
11095 if (containing_scope && TREE_CODE (containing_scope) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
11096 {
11097 if (context_die == lookup_decl_die (containing_scope))
11098 /* OK */;
11099 else
11100 containing_scope = NULL_TREE;
11101 }
11102
11103 /* Ignore function type "scopes" from the C frontend. They mean that
11104 a tagged type is local to a parmlist of a function declarator, but
11105 that isn't useful to DWARF. */
11106 if (containing_scope && TREE_CODE (containing_scope) == FUNCTION_TYPE)
11107 containing_scope = NULL_TREE;
11108
11109 if (containing_scope == NULL_TREE)
11110 scope_die = comp_unit_die;
11111 else if (TYPE_P (containing_scope))
11112 {
11113 /* For types, we can just look up the appropriate DIE. But
11114 first we check to see if we're in the middle of emitting it
11115 so we know where the new DIE should go. */
11116 for (i = VEC_length (tree, decl_scope_table) - 1; i >= 0; --i)
11117 if (VEC_index (tree, decl_scope_table, i) == containing_scope)
11118 break;
11119
11120 if (i < 0)
11121 {
11122 gcc_assert (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE
11123 || TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (containing_scope));
11124
11125 /* If none of the current dies are suitable, we get file scope. */
11126 scope_die = comp_unit_die;
11127 }
11128 else
11129 scope_die = lookup_type_die (containing_scope);
11130 }
11131 else
11132 scope_die = context_die;
11133
11134 return scope_die;
11135 }
11136
11137 /* Returns nonzero if CONTEXT_DIE is internal to a function. */
11138
11139 static inline int
local_scope_p(dw_die_ref context_die)11140 local_scope_p (dw_die_ref context_die)
11141 {
11142 for (; context_die; context_die = context_die->die_parent)
11143 if (context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine
11144 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram)
11145 return 1;
11146
11147 return 0;
11148 }
11149
11150 /* Returns nonzero if CONTEXT_DIE is a class or namespace, for deciding
11151 whether or not to treat a DIE in this context as a declaration. */
11152
11153 static inline int
class_or_namespace_scope_p(dw_die_ref context_die)11154 class_or_namespace_scope_p (dw_die_ref context_die)
11155 {
11156 return (context_die
11157 && (context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_structure_type
11158 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_union_type
11159 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace));
11160 }
11161
11162 /* Many forms of DIEs require a "type description" attribute. This
11163 routine locates the proper "type descriptor" die for the type given
11164 by 'type', and adds a DW_AT_type attribute below the given die. */
11165
11166 static void
add_type_attribute(dw_die_ref object_die,tree type,int decl_const,int decl_volatile,dw_die_ref context_die)11167 add_type_attribute (dw_die_ref object_die, tree type, int decl_const,
11168 int decl_volatile, dw_die_ref context_die)
11169 {
11170 enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (type);
11171 dw_die_ref type_die = NULL;
11172
11173 /* ??? If this type is an unnamed subrange type of an integral or
11174 floating-point type, use the inner type. This is because we have no
11175 support for unnamed types in base_type_die. This can happen if this is
11176 an Ada subrange type. Correct solution is emit a subrange type die. */
11177 if ((code == INTEGER_TYPE || code == REAL_TYPE)
11178 && TREE_TYPE (type) != 0 && TYPE_NAME (type) == 0)
11179 type = TREE_TYPE (type), code = TREE_CODE (type);
11180
11181 if (code == ERROR_MARK
11182 /* Handle a special case. For functions whose return type is void, we
11183 generate *no* type attribute. (Note that no object may have type
11184 `void', so this only applies to function return types). */
11185 || code == VOID_TYPE)
11186 return;
11187
11188 type_die = modified_type_die (type,
11189 decl_const || TYPE_READONLY (type),
11190 decl_volatile || TYPE_VOLATILE (type),
11191 context_die);
11192
11193 if (type_die != NULL)
11194 add_AT_die_ref (object_die, DW_AT_type, type_die);
11195 }
11196
11197 /* Given an object die, add the calling convention attribute for the
11198 function call type. */
11199 static void
add_calling_convention_attribute(dw_die_ref subr_die,tree type)11200 add_calling_convention_attribute (dw_die_ref subr_die, tree type)
11201 {
11202 enum dwarf_calling_convention value = DW_CC_normal;
11203
11204 value = targetm.dwarf_calling_convention (type);
11205
11206 /* Only add the attribute if the backend requests it, and
11207 is not DW_CC_normal. */
11208 if (value && (value != DW_CC_normal))
11209 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_calling_convention, value);
11210 }
11211
11212 /* Given a tree pointer to a struct, class, union, or enum type node, return
11213 a pointer to the (string) tag name for the given type, or zero if the type
11214 was declared without a tag. */
11215
11216 static const char *
type_tag(tree type)11217 type_tag (tree type)
11218 {
11219 const char *name = 0;
11220
11221 if (TYPE_NAME (type) != 0)
11222 {
11223 tree t = 0;
11224
11225 /* Find the IDENTIFIER_NODE for the type name. */
11226 if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == IDENTIFIER_NODE)
11227 t = TYPE_NAME (type);
11228
11229 /* The g++ front end makes the TYPE_NAME of *each* tagged type point to
11230 a TYPE_DECL node, regardless of whether or not a `typedef' was
11231 involved. */
11232 else if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == TYPE_DECL
11233 && ! DECL_IGNORED_P (TYPE_NAME (type)))
11234 t = DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (type));
11235
11236 /* Now get the name as a string, or invent one. */
11237 if (t != 0)
11238 name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (t);
11239 }
11240
11241 return (name == 0 || *name == '\0') ? 0 : name;
11242 }
11243
11244 /* Return the type associated with a data member, make a special check
11245 for bit field types. */
11246
11247 static inline tree
member_declared_type(tree member)11248 member_declared_type (tree member)
11249 {
11250 return (DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (member)
11251 ? DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (member) : TREE_TYPE (member));
11252 }
11253
11254 /* Get the decl's label, as described by its RTL. This may be different
11255 from the DECL_NAME name used in the source file. */
11256
11257 #if 0
11258 static const char *
11259 decl_start_label (tree decl)
11260 {
11261 rtx x;
11262 const char *fnname;
11263
11264 x = DECL_RTL (decl);
11265 gcc_assert (MEM_P (x));
11266
11267 x = XEXP (x, 0);
11268 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (x) == SYMBOL_REF);
11269
11270 fnname = XSTR (x, 0);
11271 return fnname;
11272 }
11273 #endif
11274
11275 /* These routines generate the internal representation of the DIE's for
11276 the compilation unit. Debugging information is collected by walking
11277 the declaration trees passed in from dwarf2out_decl(). */
11278
11279 static void
gen_array_type_die(tree type,dw_die_ref context_die)11280 gen_array_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
11281 {
11282 dw_die_ref scope_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
11283 dw_die_ref array_die;
11284 tree element_type;
11285
11286 /* ??? The SGI dwarf reader fails for array of array of enum types unless
11287 the inner array type comes before the outer array type. Thus we must
11288 call gen_type_die before we call new_die. See below also. */
11289 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
11290 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die);
11291 #endif
11292
11293 array_die = new_die (DW_TAG_array_type, scope_die, type);
11294 add_name_attribute (array_die, type_tag (type));
11295 equate_type_number_to_die (type, array_die);
11296
11297 if (TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE)
11298 {
11299 /* The frontend feeds us a representation for the vector as a struct
11300 containing an array. Pull out the array type. */
11301 type = TREE_TYPE (TYPE_FIELDS (TYPE_DEBUG_REPRESENTATION_TYPE (type)));
11302 add_AT_flag (array_die, DW_AT_GNU_vector, 1);
11303 }
11304
11305 #if 0
11306 /* We default the array ordering. SDB will probably do
11307 the right things even if DW_AT_ordering is not present. It's not even
11308 an issue until we start to get into multidimensional arrays anyway. If
11309 SDB is ever caught doing the Wrong Thing for multi-dimensional arrays,
11310 then we'll have to put the DW_AT_ordering attribute back in. (But if
11311 and when we find out that we need to put these in, we will only do so
11312 for multidimensional arrays. */
11313 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_ordering, DW_ORD_row_major);
11314 #endif
11315
11316 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
11317 /* The SGI compilers handle arrays of unknown bound by setting
11318 AT_declaration and not emitting any subrange DIEs. */
11319 if (! TYPE_DOMAIN (type))
11320 add_AT_flag (array_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
11321 else
11322 #endif
11323 add_subscript_info (array_die, type);
11324
11325 /* Add representation of the type of the elements of this array type. */
11326 element_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
11327
11328 /* ??? The SGI dwarf reader fails for multidimensional arrays with a
11329 const enum type. E.g. const enum machine_mode insn_operand_mode[2][10].
11330 We work around this by disabling this feature. See also
11331 add_subscript_info. */
11332 #ifndef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
11333 while (TREE_CODE (element_type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
11334 element_type = TREE_TYPE (element_type);
11335
11336 gen_type_die (element_type, context_die);
11337 #endif
11338
11339 add_type_attribute (array_die, element_type, 0, 0, context_die);
11340
11341 if (get_AT (array_die, DW_AT_name))
11342 add_pubtype (type, array_die);
11343 }
11344
11345 #if 0
11346 static void
11347 gen_entry_point_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
11348 {
11349 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
11350 dw_die_ref decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_entry_point, context_die, decl);
11351
11352 if (origin != NULL)
11353 add_abstract_origin_attribute (decl_die, origin);
11354 else
11355 {
11356 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (decl_die, decl);
11357 add_type_attribute (decl_die, TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
11358 0, 0, context_die);
11359 }
11360
11361 if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
11362 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, decl_die);
11363 else
11364 add_AT_lbl_id (decl_die, DW_AT_low_pc, decl_start_label (decl));
11365 }
11366 #endif
11367
11368 /* Walk through the list of incomplete types again, trying once more to
11369 emit full debugging info for them. */
11370
11371 static void
retry_incomplete_types(void)11372 retry_incomplete_types (void)
11373 {
11374 int i;
11375
11376 for (i = VEC_length (tree, incomplete_types) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
11377 gen_type_die (VEC_index (tree, incomplete_types, i), comp_unit_die);
11378 }
11379
11380 /* Generate a DIE to represent an inlined instance of an enumeration type. */
11381
11382 static void
gen_inlined_enumeration_type_die(tree type,dw_die_ref context_die)11383 gen_inlined_enumeration_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
11384 {
11385 dw_die_ref type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_enumeration_type, context_die, type);
11386
11387 /* We do not check for TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) being set, as the type may
11388 be incomplete and such types are not marked. */
11389 add_abstract_origin_attribute (type_die, type);
11390 }
11391
11392 /* Generate a DIE to represent an inlined instance of a structure type. */
11393
11394 static void
gen_inlined_structure_type_die(tree type,dw_die_ref context_die)11395 gen_inlined_structure_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
11396 {
11397 dw_die_ref type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_structure_type, context_die, type);
11398
11399 /* We do not check for TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) being set, as the type may
11400 be incomplete and such types are not marked. */
11401 add_abstract_origin_attribute (type_die, type);
11402 }
11403
11404 /* Generate a DIE to represent an inlined instance of a union type. */
11405
11406 static void
gen_inlined_union_type_die(tree type,dw_die_ref context_die)11407 gen_inlined_union_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
11408 {
11409 dw_die_ref type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_union_type, context_die, type);
11410
11411 /* We do not check for TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) being set, as the type may
11412 be incomplete and such types are not marked. */
11413 add_abstract_origin_attribute (type_die, type);
11414 }
11415
11416 /* Generate a DIE to represent an enumeration type. Note that these DIEs
11417 include all of the information about the enumeration values also. Each
11418 enumerated type name/value is listed as a child of the enumerated type
11419 DIE. */
11420
11421 static dw_die_ref
gen_enumeration_type_die(tree type,dw_die_ref context_die)11422 gen_enumeration_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
11423 {
11424 dw_die_ref type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
11425
11426 if (type_die == NULL)
11427 {
11428 type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_enumeration_type,
11429 scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
11430 equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
11431 add_name_attribute (type_die, type_tag (type));
11432 }
11433 else if (! TYPE_SIZE (type))
11434 return type_die;
11435 else
11436 remove_AT (type_die, DW_AT_declaration);
11437
11438 /* Handle a GNU C/C++ extension, i.e. incomplete enum types. If the
11439 given enum type is incomplete, do not generate the DW_AT_byte_size
11440 attribute or the DW_AT_element_list attribute. */
11441 if (TYPE_SIZE (type))
11442 {
11443 tree link;
11444
11445 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
11446 add_byte_size_attribute (type_die, type);
11447 if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type) != NULL_TREE)
11448 add_src_coords_attributes (type_die, TYPE_STUB_DECL (type));
11449
11450 /* If the first reference to this type was as the return type of an
11451 inline function, then it may not have a parent. Fix this now. */
11452 if (type_die->die_parent == NULL)
11453 add_child_die (scope_die_for (type, context_die), type_die);
11454
11455 for (link = TYPE_VALUES (type);
11456 link != NULL; link = TREE_CHAIN (link))
11457 {
11458 dw_die_ref enum_die = new_die (DW_TAG_enumerator, type_die, link);
11459 tree value = TREE_VALUE (link);
11460
11461 add_name_attribute (enum_die,
11462 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (TREE_PURPOSE (link)));
11463
11464 if (host_integerp (value, TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (value))))
11465 /* DWARF2 does not provide a way of indicating whether or
11466 not enumeration constants are signed or unsigned. GDB
11467 always assumes the values are signed, so we output all
11468 values as if they were signed. That means that
11469 enumeration constants with very large unsigned values
11470 will appear to have negative values in the debugger. */
11471 add_AT_int (enum_die, DW_AT_const_value,
11472 tree_low_cst (value, tree_int_cst_sgn (value) > 0));
11473 }
11474 }
11475 else
11476 add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
11477
11478 if (get_AT (type_die, DW_AT_name))
11479 add_pubtype (type, type_die);
11480
11481 return type_die;
11482 }
11483
11484 /* Generate a DIE to represent either a real live formal parameter decl or to
11485 represent just the type of some formal parameter position in some function
11486 type.
11487
11488 Note that this routine is a bit unusual because its argument may be a
11489 ..._DECL node (i.e. either a PARM_DECL or perhaps a VAR_DECL which
11490 represents an inlining of some PARM_DECL) or else some sort of a ..._TYPE
11491 node. If it's the former then this function is being called to output a
11492 DIE to represent a formal parameter object (or some inlining thereof). If
11493 it's the latter, then this function is only being called to output a
11494 DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE to stand as a placeholder for some formal
11495 argument type of some subprogram type. */
11496
11497 static dw_die_ref
gen_formal_parameter_die(tree node,dw_die_ref context_die)11498 gen_formal_parameter_die (tree node, dw_die_ref context_die)
11499 {
11500 dw_die_ref parm_die
11501 = new_die (DW_TAG_formal_parameter, context_die, node);
11502 tree origin;
11503
11504 switch (TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (node)))
11505 {
11506 case tcc_declaration:
11507 origin = decl_ultimate_origin (node);
11508 if (origin != NULL)
11509 add_abstract_origin_attribute (parm_die, origin);
11510 else
11511 {
11512 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (parm_die, node);
11513 add_type_attribute (parm_die, TREE_TYPE (node),
11514 TREE_READONLY (node),
11515 TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (node),
11516 context_die);
11517 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (node))
11518 add_AT_flag (parm_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
11519 }
11520
11521 equate_decl_number_to_die (node, parm_die);
11522 if (! DECL_ABSTRACT (node))
11523 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (parm_die, node, DW_AT_location);
11524
11525 break;
11526
11527 case tcc_type:
11528 /* We were called with some kind of a ..._TYPE node. */
11529 add_type_attribute (parm_die, node, 0, 0, context_die);
11530 break;
11531
11532 default:
11533 gcc_unreachable ();
11534 }
11535
11536 return parm_die;
11537 }
11538
11539 /* Generate a special type of DIE used as a stand-in for a trailing ellipsis
11540 at the end of an (ANSI prototyped) formal parameters list. */
11541
11542 static void
gen_unspecified_parameters_die(tree decl_or_type,dw_die_ref context_die)11543 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (tree decl_or_type, dw_die_ref context_die)
11544 {
11545 new_die (DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters, context_die, decl_or_type);
11546 }
11547
11548 /* Generate a list of nameless DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIEs (and perhaps a
11549 DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters DIE) to represent the types of the formal
11550 parameters as specified in some function type specification (except for
11551 those which appear as part of a function *definition*). */
11552
11553 static void
gen_formal_types_die(tree function_or_method_type,dw_die_ref context_die)11554 gen_formal_types_die (tree function_or_method_type, dw_die_ref context_die)
11555 {
11556 tree link;
11557 tree formal_type = NULL;
11558 tree first_parm_type;
11559 tree arg;
11560
11561 if (TREE_CODE (function_or_method_type) == FUNCTION_DECL)
11562 {
11563 arg = DECL_ARGUMENTS (function_or_method_type);
11564 function_or_method_type = TREE_TYPE (function_or_method_type);
11565 }
11566 else
11567 arg = NULL_TREE;
11568
11569 first_parm_type = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (function_or_method_type);
11570
11571 /* Make our first pass over the list of formal parameter types and output a
11572 DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE for each one. */
11573 for (link = first_parm_type; link; )
11574 {
11575 dw_die_ref parm_die;
11576
11577 formal_type = TREE_VALUE (link);
11578 if (formal_type == void_type_node)
11579 break;
11580
11581 /* Output a (nameless) DIE to represent the formal parameter itself. */
11582 parm_die = gen_formal_parameter_die (formal_type, context_die);
11583 if ((TREE_CODE (function_or_method_type) == METHOD_TYPE
11584 && link == first_parm_type)
11585 || (arg && DECL_ARTIFICIAL (arg)))
11586 add_AT_flag (parm_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
11587
11588 link = TREE_CHAIN (link);
11589 if (arg)
11590 arg = TREE_CHAIN (arg);
11591 }
11592
11593 /* If this function type has an ellipsis, add a
11594 DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters DIE to the end of the parameter list. */
11595 if (formal_type != void_type_node)
11596 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (function_or_method_type, context_die);
11597
11598 /* Make our second (and final) pass over the list of formal parameter types
11599 and output DIEs to represent those types (as necessary). */
11600 for (link = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (function_or_method_type);
11601 link && TREE_VALUE (link);
11602 link = TREE_CHAIN (link))
11603 gen_type_die (TREE_VALUE (link), context_die);
11604 }
11605
11606 /* We want to generate the DIE for TYPE so that we can generate the
11607 die for MEMBER, which has been defined; we will need to refer back
11608 to the member declaration nested within TYPE. If we're trying to
11609 generate minimal debug info for TYPE, processing TYPE won't do the
11610 trick; we need to attach the member declaration by hand. */
11611
11612 static void
gen_type_die_for_member(tree type,tree member,dw_die_ref context_die)11613 gen_type_die_for_member (tree type, tree member, dw_die_ref context_die)
11614 {
11615 gen_type_die (type, context_die);
11616
11617 /* If we're trying to avoid duplicate debug info, we may not have
11618 emitted the member decl for this function. Emit it now. */
11619 if (TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type))
11620 && ! lookup_decl_die (member))
11621 {
11622 dw_die_ref type_die;
11623 gcc_assert (!decl_ultimate_origin (member));
11624
11625 push_decl_scope (type);
11626 type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
11627 if (TREE_CODE (member) == FUNCTION_DECL)
11628 gen_subprogram_die (member, type_die);
11629 else if (TREE_CODE (member) == FIELD_DECL)
11630 {
11631 /* Ignore the nameless fields that are used to skip bits but handle
11632 C++ anonymous unions and structs. */
11633 if (DECL_NAME (member) != NULL_TREE
11634 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (member)) == UNION_TYPE
11635 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (member)) == RECORD_TYPE)
11636 {
11637 gen_type_die (member_declared_type (member), type_die);
11638 gen_field_die (member, type_die);
11639 }
11640 }
11641 else
11642 gen_variable_die (member, type_die);
11643
11644 pop_decl_scope ();
11645 }
11646 }
11647
11648 /* Generate the DWARF2 info for the "abstract" instance of a function which we
11649 may later generate inlined and/or out-of-line instances of. */
11650
11651 static void
dwarf2out_abstract_function(tree decl)11652 dwarf2out_abstract_function (tree decl)
11653 {
11654 dw_die_ref old_die;
11655 tree save_fn;
11656 struct function *save_cfun;
11657 tree context;
11658 int was_abstract = DECL_ABSTRACT (decl);
11659
11660 /* Make sure we have the actual abstract inline, not a clone. */
11661 decl = DECL_ORIGIN (decl);
11662
11663 old_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
11664 if (old_die && get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
11665 /* We've already generated the abstract instance. */
11666 return;
11667
11668 /* Be sure we've emitted the in-class declaration DIE (if any) first, so
11669 we don't get confused by DECL_ABSTRACT. */
11670 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
11671 {
11672 context = decl_class_context (decl);
11673 if (context)
11674 gen_type_die_for_member
11675 (context, decl, decl_function_context (decl) ? NULL : comp_unit_die);
11676 }
11677
11678 /* Pretend we've just finished compiling this function. */
11679 save_fn = current_function_decl;
11680 save_cfun = cfun;
11681 current_function_decl = decl;
11682 cfun = DECL_STRUCT_FUNCTION (decl);
11683
11684 set_decl_abstract_flags (decl, 1);
11685 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
11686 if (! was_abstract)
11687 set_decl_abstract_flags (decl, 0);
11688
11689 current_function_decl = save_fn;
11690 cfun = save_cfun;
11691 }
11692
11693 /* Helper function of premark_used_types() which gets called through
11694 htab_traverse_resize().
11695
11696 Marks the DIE of a given type in *SLOT as perennial, so it never gets
11697 marked as unused by prune_unused_types. */
11698 static int
premark_used_types_helper(void ** slot,void * data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)11699 premark_used_types_helper (void **slot, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
11700 {
11701 tree type;
11702 dw_die_ref die;
11703
11704 type = *slot;
11705 die = lookup_type_die (type);
11706 if (die != NULL)
11707 die->die_perennial_p = 1;
11708 return 1;
11709 }
11710
11711 /* Mark all members of used_types_hash as perennial. */
11712 static void
premark_used_types(void)11713 premark_used_types (void)
11714 {
11715 if (cfun && cfun->used_types_hash)
11716 htab_traverse (cfun->used_types_hash, premark_used_types_helper, NULL);
11717 }
11718
11719 /* Generate a DIE to represent a declared function (either file-scope or
11720 block-local). */
11721
11722 static void
gen_subprogram_die(tree decl,dw_die_ref context_die)11723 gen_subprogram_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
11724 {
11725 char label_id[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
11726 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
11727 dw_die_ref subr_die;
11728 tree fn_arg_types;
11729 tree outer_scope;
11730 dw_die_ref old_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
11731 int declaration = (current_function_decl != decl
11732 || class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die));
11733
11734 premark_used_types ();
11735
11736 /* It is possible to have both DECL_ABSTRACT and DECLARATION be true if we
11737 started to generate the abstract instance of an inline, decided to output
11738 its containing class, and proceeded to emit the declaration of the inline
11739 from the member list for the class. If so, DECLARATION takes priority;
11740 we'll get back to the abstract instance when done with the class. */
11741
11742 /* The class-scope declaration DIE must be the primary DIE. */
11743 if (origin && declaration && class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die))
11744 {
11745 origin = NULL;
11746 gcc_assert (!old_die);
11747 }
11748
11749 /* Now that the C++ front end lazily declares artificial member fns, we
11750 might need to retrofit the declaration into its class. */
11751 if (!declaration && !origin && !old_die
11752 && DECL_CONTEXT (decl) && TYPE_P (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))
11753 && !class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die)
11754 && debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
11755 old_die = force_decl_die (decl);
11756
11757 if (origin != NULL)
11758 {
11759 gcc_assert (!declaration || local_scope_p (context_die));
11760
11761 /* Fixup die_parent for the abstract instance of a nested
11762 inline function. */
11763 if (old_die && old_die->die_parent == NULL)
11764 add_child_die (context_die, old_die);
11765
11766 subr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, context_die, decl);
11767 add_abstract_origin_attribute (subr_die, origin);
11768 }
11769 else if (old_die)
11770 {
11771 expanded_location s = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
11772 struct dwarf_file_data * file_index = lookup_filename (s.file);
11773
11774 if (!get_AT_flag (old_die, DW_AT_declaration)
11775 /* We can have a normal definition following an inline one in the
11776 case of redefinition of GNU C extern inlines.
11777 It seems reasonable to use AT_specification in this case. */
11778 && !get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
11779 {
11780 /* Detect and ignore this case, where we are trying to output
11781 something we have already output. */
11782 return;
11783 }
11784
11785 /* If the definition comes from the same place as the declaration,
11786 maybe use the old DIE. We always want the DIE for this function
11787 that has the *_pc attributes to be under comp_unit_die so the
11788 debugger can find it. We also need to do this for abstract
11789 instances of inlines, since the spec requires the out-of-line copy
11790 to have the same parent. For local class methods, this doesn't
11791 apply; we just use the old DIE. */
11792 if ((old_die->die_parent == comp_unit_die || context_die == NULL)
11793 && (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl)
11794 || (get_AT_file (old_die, DW_AT_decl_file) == file_index
11795 && (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_line)
11796 == (unsigned) s.line))))
11797 {
11798 subr_die = old_die;
11799
11800 /* Clear out the declaration attribute and the formal parameters.
11801 Do not remove all children, because it is possible that this
11802 declaration die was forced using force_decl_die(). In such
11803 cases die that forced declaration die (e.g. TAG_imported_module)
11804 is one of the children that we do not want to remove. */
11805 remove_AT (subr_die, DW_AT_declaration);
11806 remove_child_TAG (subr_die, DW_TAG_formal_parameter);
11807 }
11808 else
11809 {
11810 subr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, context_die, decl);
11811 add_AT_specification (subr_die, old_die);
11812 if (get_AT_file (old_die, DW_AT_decl_file) != file_index)
11813 add_AT_file (subr_die, DW_AT_decl_file, file_index);
11814 if (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_line) != (unsigned) s.line)
11815 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_decl_line, s.line);
11816 }
11817 }
11818 else
11819 {
11820 subr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, context_die, decl);
11821
11822 if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
11823 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
11824
11825 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (subr_die, decl);
11826 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
11827 {
11828 add_prototyped_attribute (subr_die, TREE_TYPE (decl));
11829 add_type_attribute (subr_die, TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
11830 0, 0, context_die);
11831 }
11832
11833 add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (subr_die, decl);
11834 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
11835 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
11836
11837 if (TREE_PROTECTED (decl))
11838 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
11839 else if (TREE_PRIVATE (decl))
11840 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_private);
11841 }
11842
11843 if (declaration)
11844 {
11845 if (!old_die || !get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
11846 {
11847 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
11848
11849 /* The first time we see a member function, it is in the context of
11850 the class to which it belongs. We make sure of this by emitting
11851 the class first. The next time is the definition, which is
11852 handled above. The two may come from the same source text.
11853
11854 Note that force_decl_die() forces function declaration die. It is
11855 later reused to represent definition. */
11856 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, subr_die);
11857 }
11858 }
11859 else if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
11860 {
11861 if (DECL_DECLARED_INLINE_P (decl))
11862 {
11863 if (cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl))
11864 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_declared_inlined);
11865 else
11866 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_declared_not_inlined);
11867 }
11868 else
11869 {
11870 if (cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl))
11871 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_inlined);
11872 else
11873 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_not_inlined);
11874 }
11875
11876 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, subr_die);
11877 }
11878 else if (!DECL_EXTERNAL (decl))
11879 {
11880 HOST_WIDE_INT cfa_fb_offset;
11881
11882 if (!old_die || !get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
11883 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, subr_die);
11884
11885 if (!flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition)
11886 {
11887 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_id, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL,
11888 current_function_funcdef_no);
11889 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_low_pc, label_id);
11890 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_id, FUNC_END_LABEL,
11891 current_function_funcdef_no);
11892 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_high_pc, label_id);
11893
11894 add_pubname (decl, subr_die);
11895 add_arange (decl, subr_die);
11896 }
11897 else
11898 { /* Do nothing for now; maybe need to duplicate die, one for
11899 hot section and ond for cold section, then use the hot/cold
11900 section begin/end labels to generate the aranges... */
11901 /*
11902 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_low_pc, hot_section_label);
11903 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_high_pc, hot_section_end_label);
11904 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_lo_user, unlikely_section_label);
11905 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_hi_user, cold_section_end_label);
11906
11907 add_pubname (decl, subr_die);
11908 add_arange (decl, subr_die);
11909 add_arange (decl, subr_die);
11910 */
11911 }
11912
11913 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
11914 /* Add a reference to the FDE for this routine. */
11915 add_AT_fde_ref (subr_die, DW_AT_MIPS_fde, current_funcdef_fde);
11916 #endif
11917
11918 cfa_fb_offset = CFA_FRAME_BASE_OFFSET (decl);
11919
11920 /* We define the "frame base" as the function's CFA. This is more
11921 convenient for several reasons: (1) It's stable across the prologue
11922 and epilogue, which makes it better than just a frame pointer,
11923 (2) With dwarf3, there exists a one-byte encoding that allows us
11924 to reference the .debug_frame data by proxy, but failing that,
11925 (3) We can at least reuse the code inspection and interpretation
11926 code that determines the CFA position at various points in the
11927 function. */
11928 /* ??? Use some command-line or configury switch to enable the use
11929 of dwarf3 DW_OP_call_frame_cfa. At present there are no dwarf
11930 consumers that understand it; fall back to "pure" dwarf2 and
11931 convert the CFA data into a location list. */
11932 {
11933 dw_loc_list_ref list = convert_cfa_to_fb_loc_list (cfa_fb_offset);
11934 if (list->dw_loc_next)
11935 add_AT_loc_list (subr_die, DW_AT_frame_base, list);
11936 else
11937 add_AT_loc (subr_die, DW_AT_frame_base, list->expr);
11938 }
11939
11940 /* Compute a displacement from the "steady-state frame pointer" to
11941 the CFA. The former is what all stack slots and argument slots
11942 will reference in the rtl; the later is what we've told the
11943 debugger about. We'll need to adjust all frame_base references
11944 by this displacement. */
11945 compute_frame_pointer_to_fb_displacement (cfa_fb_offset);
11946
11947 if (cfun->static_chain_decl)
11948 add_AT_location_description (subr_die, DW_AT_static_link,
11949 loc_descriptor_from_tree (cfun->static_chain_decl));
11950 }
11951
11952 /* Now output descriptions of the arguments for this function. This gets
11953 (unnecessarily?) complex because of the fact that the DECL_ARGUMENT list
11954 for a FUNCTION_DECL doesn't indicate cases where there was a trailing
11955 `...' at the end of the formal parameter list. In order to find out if
11956 there was a trailing ellipsis or not, we must instead look at the type
11957 associated with the FUNCTION_DECL. This will be a node of type
11958 FUNCTION_TYPE. If the chain of type nodes hanging off of this
11959 FUNCTION_TYPE node ends with a void_type_node then there should *not* be
11960 an ellipsis at the end. */
11961
11962 /* In the case where we are describing a mere function declaration, all we
11963 need to do here (and all we *can* do here) is to describe the *types* of
11964 its formal parameters. */
11965 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
11966 ;
11967 else if (declaration)
11968 gen_formal_types_die (decl, subr_die);
11969 else
11970 {
11971 /* Generate DIEs to represent all known formal parameters. */
11972 tree arg_decls = DECL_ARGUMENTS (decl);
11973 tree parm;
11974
11975 /* When generating DIEs, generate the unspecified_parameters DIE
11976 instead if we come across the arg "__builtin_va_alist" */
11977 for (parm = arg_decls; parm; parm = TREE_CHAIN (parm))
11978 if (TREE_CODE (parm) == PARM_DECL)
11979 {
11980 if (DECL_NAME (parm)
11981 && !strcmp (IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_NAME (parm)),
11982 "__builtin_va_alist"))
11983 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (parm, subr_die);
11984 else
11985 gen_decl_die (parm, subr_die);
11986 }
11987
11988 /* Decide whether we need an unspecified_parameters DIE at the end.
11989 There are 2 more cases to do this for: 1) the ansi ... declaration -
11990 this is detectable when the end of the arg list is not a
11991 void_type_node 2) an unprototyped function declaration (not a
11992 definition). This just means that we have no info about the
11993 parameters at all. */
11994 fn_arg_types = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (TREE_TYPE (decl));
11995 if (fn_arg_types != NULL)
11996 {
11997 /* This is the prototyped case, check for.... */
11998 if (TREE_VALUE (tree_last (fn_arg_types)) != void_type_node)
11999 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (decl, subr_die);
12000 }
12001 else if (DECL_INITIAL (decl) == NULL_TREE)
12002 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (decl, subr_die);
12003 }
12004
12005 /* Output Dwarf info for all of the stuff within the body of the function
12006 (if it has one - it may be just a declaration). */
12007 outer_scope = DECL_INITIAL (decl);
12008
12009 /* OUTER_SCOPE is a pointer to the outermost BLOCK node created to represent
12010 a function. This BLOCK actually represents the outermost binding contour
12011 for the function, i.e. the contour in which the function's formal
12012 parameters and labels get declared. Curiously, it appears that the front
12013 end doesn't actually put the PARM_DECL nodes for the current function onto
12014 the BLOCK_VARS list for this outer scope, but are strung off of the
12015 DECL_ARGUMENTS list for the function instead.
12016
12017 The BLOCK_VARS list for the `outer_scope' does provide us with a list of
12018 the LABEL_DECL nodes for the function however, and we output DWARF info
12019 for those in decls_for_scope. Just within the `outer_scope' there will be
12020 a BLOCK node representing the function's outermost pair of curly braces,
12021 and any blocks used for the base and member initializers of a C++
12022 constructor function. */
12023 if (! declaration && TREE_CODE (outer_scope) != ERROR_MARK)
12024 {
12025 /* Emit a DW_TAG_variable DIE for a named return value. */
12026 if (DECL_NAME (DECL_RESULT (decl)))
12027 gen_decl_die (DECL_RESULT (decl), subr_die);
12028
12029 current_function_has_inlines = 0;
12030 decls_for_scope (outer_scope, subr_die, 0);
12031
12032 #if 0 && defined (MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO)
12033 if (current_function_has_inlines)
12034 {
12035 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_MIPS_has_inlines, 1);
12036 if (! comp_unit_has_inlines)
12037 {
12038 add_AT_flag (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_MIPS_has_inlines, 1);
12039 comp_unit_has_inlines = 1;
12040 }
12041 }
12042 #endif
12043 }
12044 /* Add the calling convention attribute if requested. */
12045 add_calling_convention_attribute (subr_die, TREE_TYPE (decl));
12046
12047 }
12048
12049 /* Generate a DIE to represent a declared data object. */
12050
12051 static void
gen_variable_die(tree decl,dw_die_ref context_die)12052 gen_variable_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
12053 {
12054 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
12055 dw_die_ref var_die = new_die (DW_TAG_variable, context_die, decl);
12056
12057 dw_die_ref old_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
12058 int declaration = (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl)
12059 /* If DECL is COMDAT and has not actually been
12060 emitted, we cannot take its address; there
12061 might end up being no definition anywhere in
12062 the program. For example, consider the C++
12063 test case:
12064
12065 template <class T>
12066 struct S { static const int i = 7; };
12067
12068 template <class T>
12069 const int S<T>::i;
12070
12071 int f() { return S<int>::i; }
12072
12073 Here, S<int>::i is not DECL_EXTERNAL, but no
12074 definition is required, so the compiler will
12075 not emit a definition. */
12076 || (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL
12077 && DECL_COMDAT (decl) && !TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl))
12078 || class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die));
12079
12080 if (origin != NULL)
12081 add_abstract_origin_attribute (var_die, origin);
12082
12083 /* Loop unrolling can create multiple blocks that refer to the same
12084 static variable, so we must test for the DW_AT_declaration flag.
12085
12086 ??? Loop unrolling/reorder_blocks should perhaps be rewritten to
12087 copy decls and set the DECL_ABSTRACT flag on them instead of
12088 sharing them.
12089
12090 ??? Duplicated blocks have been rewritten to use .debug_ranges.
12091
12092 ??? The declare_in_namespace support causes us to get two DIEs for one
12093 variable, both of which are declarations. We want to avoid considering
12094 one to be a specification, so we must test that this DIE is not a
12095 declaration. */
12096 else if (old_die && TREE_STATIC (decl) && ! declaration
12097 && get_AT_flag (old_die, DW_AT_declaration) == 1)
12098 {
12099 /* This is a definition of a C++ class level static. */
12100 add_AT_specification (var_die, old_die);
12101 if (DECL_NAME (decl))
12102 {
12103 expanded_location s = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
12104 struct dwarf_file_data * file_index = lookup_filename (s.file);
12105
12106 if (get_AT_file (old_die, DW_AT_decl_file) != file_index)
12107 add_AT_file (var_die, DW_AT_decl_file, file_index);
12108
12109 if (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_line) != (unsigned) s.line)
12110
12111 add_AT_unsigned (var_die, DW_AT_decl_line, s.line);
12112 }
12113 }
12114 else
12115 {
12116 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (var_die, decl);
12117 add_type_attribute (var_die, TREE_TYPE (decl), TREE_READONLY (decl),
12118 TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl), context_die);
12119
12120 if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
12121 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
12122
12123 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
12124 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
12125
12126 if (TREE_PROTECTED (decl))
12127 add_AT_unsigned (var_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
12128 else if (TREE_PRIVATE (decl))
12129 add_AT_unsigned (var_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_private);
12130 }
12131
12132 if (declaration)
12133 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
12134
12135 if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl) || declaration)
12136 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, var_die);
12137
12138 if (! declaration && ! DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
12139 {
12140 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (var_die, decl, DW_AT_location);
12141 add_pubname (decl, var_die);
12142 }
12143 else
12144 tree_add_const_value_attribute (var_die, decl);
12145 }
12146
12147 /* Generate a DIE to represent a label identifier. */
12148
12149 static void
gen_label_die(tree decl,dw_die_ref context_die)12150 gen_label_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
12151 {
12152 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
12153 dw_die_ref lbl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_label, context_die, decl);
12154 rtx insn;
12155 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
12156
12157 if (origin != NULL)
12158 add_abstract_origin_attribute (lbl_die, origin);
12159 else
12160 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (lbl_die, decl);
12161
12162 if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
12163 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, lbl_die);
12164 else
12165 {
12166 insn = DECL_RTL_IF_SET (decl);
12167
12168 /* Deleted labels are programmer specified labels which have been
12169 eliminated because of various optimizations. We still emit them
12170 here so that it is possible to put breakpoints on them. */
12171 if (insn
12172 && (LABEL_P (insn)
12173 || ((NOTE_P (insn)
12174 && NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (insn) == NOTE_INSN_DELETED_LABEL))))
12175 {
12176 /* When optimization is enabled (via -O) some parts of the compiler
12177 (e.g. jump.c and cse.c) may try to delete CODE_LABEL insns which
12178 represent source-level labels which were explicitly declared by
12179 the user. This really shouldn't be happening though, so catch
12180 it if it ever does happen. */
12181 gcc_assert (!INSN_DELETED_P (insn));
12182
12183 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "L", CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (insn));
12184 add_AT_lbl_id (lbl_die, DW_AT_low_pc, label);
12185 }
12186 }
12187 }
12188
12189 /* A helper function for gen_inlined_subroutine_die. Add source coordinate
12190 attributes to the DIE for a block STMT, to describe where the inlined
12191 function was called from. This is similar to add_src_coords_attributes. */
12192
12193 static inline void
add_call_src_coords_attributes(tree stmt,dw_die_ref die)12194 add_call_src_coords_attributes (tree stmt, dw_die_ref die)
12195 {
12196 expanded_location s = expand_location (BLOCK_SOURCE_LOCATION (stmt));
12197
12198 add_AT_file (die, DW_AT_call_file, lookup_filename (s.file));
12199 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_call_line, s.line);
12200 }
12201
12202 /* A helper function for gen_lexical_block_die and gen_inlined_subroutine_die.
12203 Add low_pc and high_pc attributes to the DIE for a block STMT. */
12204
12205 static inline void
add_high_low_attributes(tree stmt,dw_die_ref die)12206 add_high_low_attributes (tree stmt, dw_die_ref die)
12207 {
12208 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
12209
12210 if (BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (stmt))
12211 {
12212 tree chain;
12213
12214 add_AT_range_list (die, DW_AT_ranges, add_ranges (stmt));
12215
12216 chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (stmt);
12217 do
12218 {
12219 add_ranges (chain);
12220 chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (chain);
12221 }
12222 while (chain);
12223 add_ranges (NULL);
12224 }
12225 else
12226 {
12227 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL,
12228 BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt));
12229 add_AT_lbl_id (die, DW_AT_low_pc, label);
12230 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, BLOCK_END_LABEL,
12231 BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt));
12232 add_AT_lbl_id (die, DW_AT_high_pc, label);
12233 }
12234 }
12235
12236 /* Generate a DIE for a lexical block. */
12237
12238 static void
gen_lexical_block_die(tree stmt,dw_die_ref context_die,int depth)12239 gen_lexical_block_die (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die, int depth)
12240 {
12241 dw_die_ref stmt_die = new_die (DW_TAG_lexical_block, context_die, stmt);
12242
12243 if (! BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt))
12244 add_high_low_attributes (stmt, stmt_die);
12245
12246 decls_for_scope (stmt, stmt_die, depth);
12247 }
12248
12249 /* Generate a DIE for an inlined subprogram. */
12250
12251 static void
gen_inlined_subroutine_die(tree stmt,dw_die_ref context_die,int depth)12252 gen_inlined_subroutine_die (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die, int depth)
12253 {
12254 tree decl = block_ultimate_origin (stmt);
12255
12256 /* Emit info for the abstract instance first, if we haven't yet. We
12257 must emit this even if the block is abstract, otherwise when we
12258 emit the block below (or elsewhere), we may end up trying to emit
12259 a die whose origin die hasn't been emitted, and crashing. */
12260 dwarf2out_abstract_function (decl);
12261
12262 if (! BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt))
12263 {
12264 dw_die_ref subr_die
12265 = new_die (DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine, context_die, stmt);
12266
12267 add_abstract_origin_attribute (subr_die, decl);
12268 add_high_low_attributes (stmt, subr_die);
12269 add_call_src_coords_attributes (stmt, subr_die);
12270
12271 decls_for_scope (stmt, subr_die, depth);
12272 current_function_has_inlines = 1;
12273 }
12274 else
12275 /* We may get here if we're the outer block of function A that was
12276 inlined into function B that was inlined into function C. When
12277 generating debugging info for C, dwarf2out_abstract_function(B)
12278 would mark all inlined blocks as abstract, including this one.
12279 So, we wouldn't (and shouldn't) expect labels to be generated
12280 for this one. Instead, just emit debugging info for
12281 declarations within the block. This is particularly important
12282 in the case of initializers of arguments passed from B to us:
12283 if they're statement expressions containing declarations, we
12284 wouldn't generate dies for their abstract variables, and then,
12285 when generating dies for the real variables, we'd die (pun
12286 intended :-) */
12287 gen_lexical_block_die (stmt, context_die, depth);
12288 }
12289
12290 /* Generate a DIE for a field in a record, or structure. */
12291
12292 static void
gen_field_die(tree decl,dw_die_ref context_die)12293 gen_field_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
12294 {
12295 dw_die_ref decl_die;
12296
12297 if (TREE_TYPE (decl) == error_mark_node)
12298 return;
12299
12300 decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_member, context_die, decl);
12301 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (decl_die, decl);
12302 add_type_attribute (decl_die, member_declared_type (decl),
12303 TREE_READONLY (decl), TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl),
12304 context_die);
12305
12306 if (DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl))
12307 {
12308 add_byte_size_attribute (decl_die, decl);
12309 add_bit_size_attribute (decl_die, decl);
12310 add_bit_offset_attribute (decl_die, decl);
12311 }
12312
12313 if (TREE_CODE (DECL_FIELD_CONTEXT (decl)) != UNION_TYPE)
12314 add_data_member_location_attribute (decl_die, decl);
12315
12316 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
12317 add_AT_flag (decl_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
12318
12319 if (TREE_PROTECTED (decl))
12320 add_AT_unsigned (decl_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
12321 else if (TREE_PRIVATE (decl))
12322 add_AT_unsigned (decl_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_private);
12323
12324 /* Equate decl number to die, so that we can look up this decl later on. */
12325 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, decl_die);
12326 }
12327
12328 #if 0
12329 /* Don't generate either pointer_type DIEs or reference_type DIEs here.
12330 Use modified_type_die instead.
12331 We keep this code here just in case these types of DIEs may be needed to
12332 represent certain things in other languages (e.g. Pascal) someday. */
12333
12334 static void
12335 gen_pointer_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
12336 {
12337 dw_die_ref ptr_die
12338 = new_die (DW_TAG_pointer_type, scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
12339
12340 equate_type_number_to_die (type, ptr_die);
12341 add_type_attribute (ptr_die, TREE_TYPE (type), 0, 0, context_die);
12342 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size, PTR_SIZE);
12343 }
12344
12345 /* Don't generate either pointer_type DIEs or reference_type DIEs here.
12346 Use modified_type_die instead.
12347 We keep this code here just in case these types of DIEs may be needed to
12348 represent certain things in other languages (e.g. Pascal) someday. */
12349
12350 static void
12351 gen_reference_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
12352 {
12353 dw_die_ref ref_die
12354 = new_die (DW_TAG_reference_type, scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
12355
12356 equate_type_number_to_die (type, ref_die);
12357 add_type_attribute (ref_die, TREE_TYPE (type), 0, 0, context_die);
12358 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size, PTR_SIZE);
12359 }
12360 #endif
12361
12362 /* Generate a DIE for a pointer to a member type. */
12363
12364 static void
gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die(tree type,dw_die_ref context_die)12365 gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
12366 {
12367 dw_die_ref ptr_die
12368 = new_die (DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type,
12369 scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
12370
12371 equate_type_number_to_die (type, ptr_die);
12372 add_AT_die_ref (ptr_die, DW_AT_containing_type,
12373 lookup_type_die (TYPE_OFFSET_BASETYPE (type)));
12374 add_type_attribute (ptr_die, TREE_TYPE (type), 0, 0, context_die);
12375 }
12376
12377 /* Generate the DIE for the compilation unit. */
12378
12379 static dw_die_ref
gen_compile_unit_die(const char * filename)12380 gen_compile_unit_die (const char *filename)
12381 {
12382 dw_die_ref die;
12383 char producer[250];
12384 const char *language_string = lang_hooks.name;
12385 int language;
12386
12387 die = new_die (DW_TAG_compile_unit, NULL, NULL);
12388
12389 if (filename)
12390 {
12391 add_name_attribute (die, filename);
12392 /* Don't add cwd for <built-in>. */
12393 if (filename[0] != DIR_SEPARATOR && filename[0] != '<')
12394 add_comp_dir_attribute (die);
12395 }
12396
12397 sprintf (producer, "%s %s", language_string, version_string);
12398
12399 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
12400 /* The MIPS/SGI compilers place the 'cc' command line options in the producer
12401 string. The SGI debugger looks for -g, -g1, -g2, or -g3; if they do
12402 not appear in the producer string, the debugger reaches the conclusion
12403 that the object file is stripped and has no debugging information.
12404 To get the MIPS/SGI debugger to believe that there is debugging
12405 information in the object file, we add a -g to the producer string. */
12406 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
12407 strcat (producer, " -g");
12408 #endif
12409
12410 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_producer, producer);
12411
12412 if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU C++") == 0)
12413 language = DW_LANG_C_plus_plus;
12414 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Ada") == 0)
12415 language = DW_LANG_Ada95;
12416 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU F77") == 0)
12417 language = DW_LANG_Fortran77;
12418 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU F95") == 0)
12419 language = DW_LANG_Fortran95;
12420 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Pascal") == 0)
12421 language = DW_LANG_Pascal83;
12422 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Java") == 0)
12423 language = DW_LANG_Java;
12424 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Objective-C") == 0)
12425 language = DW_LANG_ObjC;
12426 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Objective-C++") == 0)
12427 language = DW_LANG_ObjC_plus_plus;
12428 else
12429 language = DW_LANG_C89;
12430
12431 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_language, language);
12432 return die;
12433 }
12434
12435 /* Generate the DIE for a base class. */
12436
12437 static void
gen_inheritance_die(tree binfo,tree access,dw_die_ref context_die)12438 gen_inheritance_die (tree binfo, tree access, dw_die_ref context_die)
12439 {
12440 dw_die_ref die = new_die (DW_TAG_inheritance, context_die, binfo);
12441
12442 add_type_attribute (die, BINFO_TYPE (binfo), 0, 0, context_die);
12443 add_data_member_location_attribute (die, binfo);
12444
12445 if (BINFO_VIRTUAL_P (binfo))
12446 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_virtuality, DW_VIRTUALITY_virtual);
12447
12448 if (access == access_public_node)
12449 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_public);
12450 else if (access == access_protected_node)
12451 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
12452 }
12453
12454 /* Generate a DIE for a class member. */
12455
12456 static void
gen_member_die(tree type,dw_die_ref context_die)12457 gen_member_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
12458 {
12459 tree member;
12460 tree binfo = TYPE_BINFO (type);
12461 dw_die_ref child;
12462
12463 /* If this is not an incomplete type, output descriptions of each of its
12464 members. Note that as we output the DIEs necessary to represent the
12465 members of this record or union type, we will also be trying to output
12466 DIEs to represent the *types* of those members. However the `type'
12467 function (above) will specifically avoid generating type DIEs for member
12468 types *within* the list of member DIEs for this (containing) type except
12469 for those types (of members) which are explicitly marked as also being
12470 members of this (containing) type themselves. The g++ front- end can
12471 force any given type to be treated as a member of some other (containing)
12472 type by setting the TYPE_CONTEXT of the given (member) type to point to
12473 the TREE node representing the appropriate (containing) type. */
12474
12475 /* First output info about the base classes. */
12476 if (binfo)
12477 {
12478 VEC(tree,gc) *accesses = BINFO_BASE_ACCESSES (binfo);
12479 int i;
12480 tree base;
12481
12482 for (i = 0; BINFO_BASE_ITERATE (binfo, i, base); i++)
12483 gen_inheritance_die (base,
12484 (accesses ? VEC_index (tree, accesses, i)
12485 : access_public_node), context_die);
12486 }
12487
12488 /* Now output info about the data members and type members. */
12489 for (member = TYPE_FIELDS (type); member; member = TREE_CHAIN (member))
12490 {
12491 /* If we thought we were generating minimal debug info for TYPE
12492 and then changed our minds, some of the member declarations
12493 may have already been defined. Don't define them again, but
12494 do put them in the right order. */
12495
12496 child = lookup_decl_die (member);
12497 if (child)
12498 splice_child_die (context_die, child);
12499 else
12500 gen_decl_die (member, context_die);
12501 }
12502
12503 /* Now output info about the function members (if any). */
12504 for (member = TYPE_METHODS (type); member; member = TREE_CHAIN (member))
12505 {
12506 /* Don't include clones in the member list. */
12507 if (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (member))
12508 continue;
12509
12510 child = lookup_decl_die (member);
12511 if (child)
12512 splice_child_die (context_die, child);
12513 else
12514 gen_decl_die (member, context_die);
12515 }
12516 }
12517
12518 /* Generate a DIE for a structure or union type. If TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG
12519 is set, we pretend that the type was never defined, so we only get the
12520 member DIEs needed by later specification DIEs. */
12521
12522 static void
gen_struct_or_union_type_die(tree type,dw_die_ref context_die,enum debug_info_usage usage)12523 gen_struct_or_union_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die,
12524 enum debug_info_usage usage)
12525 {
12526 dw_die_ref type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
12527 dw_die_ref scope_die = 0;
12528 int nested = 0;
12529 int complete = (TYPE_SIZE (type)
12530 && (! TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)
12531 || ! TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type))));
12532 int ns_decl = (context_die && context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace);
12533 complete = complete && should_emit_struct_debug (type, usage);
12534
12535 if (type_die && ! complete)
12536 return;
12537
12538 if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type) != NULL_TREE
12539 && (AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
12540 || TREE_CODE (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)) == NAMESPACE_DECL))
12541 nested = 1;
12542
12543 scope_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
12544
12545 if (! type_die || (nested && scope_die == comp_unit_die))
12546 /* First occurrence of type or toplevel definition of nested class. */
12547 {
12548 dw_die_ref old_die = type_die;
12549
12550 type_die = new_die (TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE
12551 ? DW_TAG_structure_type : DW_TAG_union_type,
12552 scope_die, type);
12553 equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
12554 if (old_die)
12555 add_AT_specification (type_die, old_die);
12556 else
12557 add_name_attribute (type_die, type_tag (type));
12558 }
12559 else
12560 remove_AT (type_die, DW_AT_declaration);
12561
12562 /* If this type has been completed, then give it a byte_size attribute and
12563 then give a list of members. */
12564 if (complete && !ns_decl)
12565 {
12566 /* Prevent infinite recursion in cases where the type of some member of
12567 this type is expressed in terms of this type itself. */
12568 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
12569 add_byte_size_attribute (type_die, type);
12570 if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type) != NULL_TREE)
12571 add_src_coords_attributes (type_die, TYPE_STUB_DECL (type));
12572
12573 /* If the first reference to this type was as the return type of an
12574 inline function, then it may not have a parent. Fix this now. */
12575 if (type_die->die_parent == NULL)
12576 add_child_die (scope_die, type_die);
12577
12578 push_decl_scope (type);
12579 gen_member_die (type, type_die);
12580 pop_decl_scope ();
12581
12582 /* GNU extension: Record what type our vtable lives in. */
12583 if (TYPE_VFIELD (type))
12584 {
12585 tree vtype = DECL_FCONTEXT (TYPE_VFIELD (type));
12586
12587 gen_type_die (vtype, context_die);
12588 add_AT_die_ref (type_die, DW_AT_containing_type,
12589 lookup_type_die (vtype));
12590 }
12591 }
12592 else
12593 {
12594 add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
12595
12596 /* We don't need to do this for function-local types. */
12597 if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)
12598 && ! decl_function_context (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)))
12599 VEC_safe_push (tree, gc, incomplete_types, type);
12600 }
12601
12602 if (get_AT (type_die, DW_AT_name))
12603 add_pubtype (type, type_die);
12604 }
12605
12606 /* Generate a DIE for a subroutine _type_. */
12607
12608 static void
gen_subroutine_type_die(tree type,dw_die_ref context_die)12609 gen_subroutine_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
12610 {
12611 tree return_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
12612 dw_die_ref subr_die
12613 = new_die (DW_TAG_subroutine_type,
12614 scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
12615
12616 equate_type_number_to_die (type, subr_die);
12617 add_prototyped_attribute (subr_die, type);
12618 add_type_attribute (subr_die, return_type, 0, 0, context_die);
12619 gen_formal_types_die (type, subr_die);
12620
12621 if (get_AT (subr_die, DW_AT_name))
12622 add_pubtype (type, subr_die);
12623 }
12624
12625 /* Generate a DIE for a type definition. */
12626
12627 static void
gen_typedef_die(tree decl,dw_die_ref context_die)12628 gen_typedef_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
12629 {
12630 dw_die_ref type_die;
12631 tree origin;
12632
12633 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl))
12634 return;
12635
12636 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl) = 1;
12637 type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_typedef, context_die, decl);
12638 origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
12639 if (origin != NULL)
12640 add_abstract_origin_attribute (type_die, origin);
12641 else
12642 {
12643 tree type;
12644
12645 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (type_die, decl);
12646 if (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (decl))
12647 {
12648 type = DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (decl);
12649
12650 gcc_assert (type != TREE_TYPE (decl));
12651 equate_type_number_to_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), type_die);
12652 }
12653 else
12654 type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
12655
12656 add_type_attribute (type_die, type, TREE_READONLY (decl),
12657 TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl), context_die);
12658 }
12659
12660 if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
12661 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, type_die);
12662
12663 if (get_AT (type_die, DW_AT_name))
12664 add_pubtype (decl, type_die);
12665 }
12666
12667 /* Generate a type description DIE. */
12668
12669 static void
gen_type_die_with_usage(tree type,dw_die_ref context_die,enum debug_info_usage usage)12670 gen_type_die_with_usage (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die,
12671 enum debug_info_usage usage)
12672 {
12673 int need_pop;
12674
12675 if (type == NULL_TREE || type == error_mark_node)
12676 return;
12677
12678 if (TYPE_NAME (type) && TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == TYPE_DECL
12679 && DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (TYPE_NAME (type)))
12680 {
12681 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
12682 return;
12683
12684 /* Prevent broken recursion; we can't hand off to the same type. */
12685 gcc_assert (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (TYPE_NAME (type)) != type);
12686
12687 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
12688 gen_decl_die (TYPE_NAME (type), context_die);
12689 return;
12690 }
12691
12692 /* We are going to output a DIE to represent the unqualified version
12693 of this type (i.e. without any const or volatile qualifiers) so
12694 get the main variant (i.e. the unqualified version) of this type
12695 now. (Vectors are special because the debugging info is in the
12696 cloned type itself). */
12697 if (TREE_CODE (type) != VECTOR_TYPE)
12698 type = type_main_variant (type);
12699
12700 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
12701 return;
12702
12703 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
12704 {
12705 case ERROR_MARK:
12706 break;
12707
12708 case POINTER_TYPE:
12709 case REFERENCE_TYPE:
12710 /* We must set TREE_ASM_WRITTEN in case this is a recursive type. This
12711 ensures that the gen_type_die recursion will terminate even if the
12712 type is recursive. Recursive types are possible in Ada. */
12713 /* ??? We could perhaps do this for all types before the switch
12714 statement. */
12715 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
12716
12717 /* For these types, all that is required is that we output a DIE (or a
12718 set of DIEs) to represent the "basis" type. */
12719 gen_type_die_with_usage (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die,
12720 DINFO_USAGE_IND_USE);
12721 break;
12722
12723 case OFFSET_TYPE:
12724 /* This code is used for C++ pointer-to-data-member types.
12725 Output a description of the relevant class type. */
12726 gen_type_die_with_usage (TYPE_OFFSET_BASETYPE (type), context_die,
12727 DINFO_USAGE_IND_USE);
12728
12729 /* Output a description of the type of the object pointed to. */
12730 gen_type_die_with_usage (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die,
12731 DINFO_USAGE_IND_USE);
12732
12733 /* Now output a DIE to represent this pointer-to-data-member type
12734 itself. */
12735 gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die (type, context_die);
12736 break;
12737
12738 case FUNCTION_TYPE:
12739 /* Force out return type (in case it wasn't forced out already). */
12740 gen_type_die_with_usage (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die,
12741 DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE);
12742 gen_subroutine_type_die (type, context_die);
12743 break;
12744
12745 case METHOD_TYPE:
12746 /* Force out return type (in case it wasn't forced out already). */
12747 gen_type_die_with_usage (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die,
12748 DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE);
12749 gen_subroutine_type_die (type, context_die);
12750 break;
12751
12752 case ARRAY_TYPE:
12753 gen_array_type_die (type, context_die);
12754 break;
12755
12756 case VECTOR_TYPE:
12757 gen_array_type_die (type, context_die);
12758 break;
12759
12760 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
12761 case RECORD_TYPE:
12762 case UNION_TYPE:
12763 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
12764 /* If this is a nested type whose containing class hasn't been written
12765 out yet, writing it out will cover this one, too. This does not apply
12766 to instantiations of member class templates; they need to be added to
12767 the containing class as they are generated. FIXME: This hurts the
12768 idea of combining type decls from multiple TUs, since we can't predict
12769 what set of template instantiations we'll get. */
12770 if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)
12771 && AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
12772 && ! TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)))
12773 {
12774 gen_type_die_with_usage (TYPE_CONTEXT (type), context_die, usage);
12775
12776 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
12777 return;
12778
12779 /* If that failed, attach ourselves to the stub. */
12780 push_decl_scope (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
12781 context_die = lookup_type_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
12782 need_pop = 1;
12783 }
12784 else
12785 {
12786 declare_in_namespace (type, context_die);
12787 need_pop = 0;
12788 }
12789
12790 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ENUMERAL_TYPE)
12791 {
12792 /* This might have been written out by the call to
12793 declare_in_namespace. */
12794 if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
12795 gen_enumeration_type_die (type, context_die);
12796 }
12797 else
12798 gen_struct_or_union_type_die (type, context_die, usage);
12799
12800 if (need_pop)
12801 pop_decl_scope ();
12802
12803 /* Don't set TREE_ASM_WRITTEN on an incomplete struct; we want to fix
12804 it up if it is ever completed. gen_*_type_die will set it for us
12805 when appropriate. */
12806 return;
12807
12808 case VOID_TYPE:
12809 case INTEGER_TYPE:
12810 case REAL_TYPE:
12811 case COMPLEX_TYPE:
12812 case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
12813 /* No DIEs needed for fundamental types. */
12814 break;
12815
12816 case LANG_TYPE:
12817 /* No Dwarf representation currently defined. */
12818 break;
12819
12820 default:
12821 gcc_unreachable ();
12822 }
12823
12824 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
12825 }
12826
12827 static void
gen_type_die(tree type,dw_die_ref context_die)12828 gen_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
12829 {
12830 gen_type_die_with_usage (type, context_die, DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE);
12831 }
12832
12833 /* Generate a DIE for a tagged type instantiation. */
12834
12835 static void
gen_tagged_type_instantiation_die(tree type,dw_die_ref context_die)12836 gen_tagged_type_instantiation_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
12837 {
12838 if (type == NULL_TREE || type == error_mark_node)
12839 return;
12840
12841 /* We are going to output a DIE to represent the unqualified version of
12842 this type (i.e. without any const or volatile qualifiers) so make sure
12843 that we have the main variant (i.e. the unqualified version) of this
12844 type now. */
12845 gcc_assert (type == type_main_variant (type));
12846
12847 /* Do not check TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) as it may not be set if this is
12848 an instance of an unresolved type. */
12849
12850 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
12851 {
12852 case ERROR_MARK:
12853 break;
12854
12855 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
12856 gen_inlined_enumeration_type_die (type, context_die);
12857 break;
12858
12859 case RECORD_TYPE:
12860 gen_inlined_structure_type_die (type, context_die);
12861 break;
12862
12863 case UNION_TYPE:
12864 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
12865 gen_inlined_union_type_die (type, context_die);
12866 break;
12867
12868 default:
12869 gcc_unreachable ();
12870 }
12871 }
12872
12873 /* Generate a DW_TAG_lexical_block DIE followed by DIEs to represent all of the
12874 things which are local to the given block. */
12875
12876 static void
gen_block_die(tree stmt,dw_die_ref context_die,int depth)12877 gen_block_die (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die, int depth)
12878 {
12879 int must_output_die = 0;
12880 tree origin;
12881 tree decl;
12882 enum tree_code origin_code;
12883
12884 /* Ignore blocks that are NULL. */
12885 if (stmt == NULL_TREE)
12886 return;
12887
12888 /* If the block is one fragment of a non-contiguous block, do not
12889 process the variables, since they will have been done by the
12890 origin block. Do process subblocks. */
12891 if (BLOCK_FRAGMENT_ORIGIN (stmt))
12892 {
12893 tree sub;
12894
12895 for (sub = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (stmt); sub; sub = BLOCK_CHAIN (sub))
12896 gen_block_die (sub, context_die, depth + 1);
12897
12898 return;
12899 }
12900
12901 /* Determine the "ultimate origin" of this block. This block may be an
12902 inlined instance of an inlined instance of inline function, so we have
12903 to trace all of the way back through the origin chain to find out what
12904 sort of node actually served as the original seed for the creation of
12905 the current block. */
12906 origin = block_ultimate_origin (stmt);
12907 origin_code = (origin != NULL) ? TREE_CODE (origin) : ERROR_MARK;
12908
12909 /* Determine if we need to output any Dwarf DIEs at all to represent this
12910 block. */
12911 if (origin_code == FUNCTION_DECL)
12912 /* The outer scopes for inlinings *must* always be represented. We
12913 generate DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine DIEs for them. (See below.) */
12914 must_output_die = 1;
12915 else
12916 {
12917 /* In the case where the current block represents an inlining of the
12918 "body block" of an inline function, we must *NOT* output any DIE for
12919 this block because we have already output a DIE to represent the whole
12920 inlined function scope and the "body block" of any function doesn't
12921 really represent a different scope according to ANSI C rules. So we
12922 check here to make sure that this block does not represent a "body
12923 block inlining" before trying to set the MUST_OUTPUT_DIE flag. */
12924 if (! is_body_block (origin ? origin : stmt))
12925 {
12926 /* Determine if this block directly contains any "significant"
12927 local declarations which we will need to output DIEs for. */
12928 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
12929 /* We are not in terse mode so *any* local declaration counts
12930 as being a "significant" one. */
12931 must_output_die = (BLOCK_VARS (stmt) != NULL
12932 && (TREE_USED (stmt)
12933 || TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (stmt)
12934 || BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt)));
12935 else
12936 /* We are in terse mode, so only local (nested) function
12937 definitions count as "significant" local declarations. */
12938 for (decl = BLOCK_VARS (stmt);
12939 decl != NULL; decl = TREE_CHAIN (decl))
12940 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL
12941 && DECL_INITIAL (decl))
12942 {
12943 must_output_die = 1;
12944 break;
12945 }
12946 }
12947 }
12948
12949 /* It would be a waste of space to generate a Dwarf DW_TAG_lexical_block
12950 DIE for any block which contains no significant local declarations at
12951 all. Rather, in such cases we just call `decls_for_scope' so that any
12952 needed Dwarf info for any sub-blocks will get properly generated. Note
12953 that in terse mode, our definition of what constitutes a "significant"
12954 local declaration gets restricted to include only inlined function
12955 instances and local (nested) function definitions. */
12956 if (must_output_die)
12957 {
12958 if (origin_code == FUNCTION_DECL)
12959 gen_inlined_subroutine_die (stmt, context_die, depth);
12960 else
12961 gen_lexical_block_die (stmt, context_die, depth);
12962 }
12963 else
12964 decls_for_scope (stmt, context_die, depth);
12965 }
12966
12967 /* Generate all of the decls declared within a given scope and (recursively)
12968 all of its sub-blocks. */
12969
12970 static void
decls_for_scope(tree stmt,dw_die_ref context_die,int depth)12971 decls_for_scope (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die, int depth)
12972 {
12973 tree decl;
12974 tree subblocks;
12975
12976 /* Ignore NULL blocks. */
12977 if (stmt == NULL_TREE)
12978 return;
12979
12980 if (TREE_USED (stmt))
12981 {
12982 /* Output the DIEs to represent all of the data objects and typedefs
12983 declared directly within this block but not within any nested
12984 sub-blocks. Also, nested function and tag DIEs have been
12985 generated with a parent of NULL; fix that up now. */
12986 for (decl = BLOCK_VARS (stmt); decl != NULL; decl = TREE_CHAIN (decl))
12987 {
12988 dw_die_ref die;
12989
12990 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL)
12991 die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
12992 else if (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL && TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl))
12993 die = lookup_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl));
12994 else
12995 die = NULL;
12996
12997 if (die != NULL && die->die_parent == NULL)
12998 add_child_die (context_die, die);
12999 /* Do not produce debug information for static variables since
13000 these might be optimized out. We are called for these later
13001 in cgraph_varpool_analyze_pending_decls. */
13002 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL && TREE_STATIC (decl))
13003 ;
13004 else
13005 gen_decl_die (decl, context_die);
13006 }
13007 }
13008
13009 /* If we're at -g1, we're not interested in subblocks. */
13010 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
13011 return;
13012
13013 /* Output the DIEs to represent all sub-blocks (and the items declared
13014 therein) of this block. */
13015 for (subblocks = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (stmt);
13016 subblocks != NULL;
13017 subblocks = BLOCK_CHAIN (subblocks))
13018 gen_block_die (subblocks, context_die, depth + 1);
13019 }
13020
13021 /* Is this a typedef we can avoid emitting? */
13022
13023 static inline int
is_redundant_typedef(tree decl)13024 is_redundant_typedef (tree decl)
13025 {
13026 if (TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl))
13027 return 1;
13028
13029 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl)
13030 && DECL_CONTEXT (decl)
13031 && is_tagged_type (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))
13032 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))) == TYPE_DECL
13033 && DECL_NAME (decl) == DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))))
13034 /* Also ignore the artificial member typedef for the class name. */
13035 return 1;
13036
13037 return 0;
13038 }
13039
13040 /* Returns the DIE for decl. A DIE will always be returned. */
13041
13042 static dw_die_ref
force_decl_die(tree decl)13043 force_decl_die (tree decl)
13044 {
13045 dw_die_ref decl_die;
13046 unsigned saved_external_flag;
13047 tree save_fn = NULL_TREE;
13048 decl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
13049 if (!decl_die)
13050 {
13051 dw_die_ref context_die;
13052 tree decl_context = DECL_CONTEXT (decl);
13053 if (decl_context)
13054 {
13055 /* Find die that represents this context. */
13056 if (TYPE_P (decl_context))
13057 context_die = force_type_die (decl_context);
13058 else
13059 context_die = force_decl_die (decl_context);
13060 }
13061 else
13062 context_die = comp_unit_die;
13063
13064 decl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
13065 if (decl_die)
13066 return decl_die;
13067
13068 switch (TREE_CODE (decl))
13069 {
13070 case FUNCTION_DECL:
13071 /* Clear current_function_decl, so that gen_subprogram_die thinks
13072 that this is a declaration. At this point, we just want to force
13073 declaration die. */
13074 save_fn = current_function_decl;
13075 current_function_decl = NULL_TREE;
13076 gen_subprogram_die (decl, context_die);
13077 current_function_decl = save_fn;
13078 break;
13079
13080 case VAR_DECL:
13081 /* Set external flag to force declaration die. Restore it after
13082 gen_decl_die() call. */
13083 saved_external_flag = DECL_EXTERNAL (decl);
13084 DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) = 1;
13085 gen_decl_die (decl, context_die);
13086 DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) = saved_external_flag;
13087 break;
13088
13089 case NAMESPACE_DECL:
13090 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
13091 break;
13092
13093 default:
13094 gcc_unreachable ();
13095 }
13096
13097 /* We should be able to find the DIE now. */
13098 if (!decl_die)
13099 decl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
13100 gcc_assert (decl_die);
13101 }
13102
13103 return decl_die;
13104 }
13105
13106 /* Returns the DIE for TYPE, that must not be a base type. A DIE is
13107 always returned. */
13108
13109 static dw_die_ref
force_type_die(tree type)13110 force_type_die (tree type)
13111 {
13112 dw_die_ref type_die;
13113
13114 type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
13115 if (!type_die)
13116 {
13117 dw_die_ref context_die;
13118 if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
13119 {
13120 if (TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)))
13121 context_die = force_type_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
13122 else
13123 context_die = force_decl_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
13124 }
13125 else
13126 context_die = comp_unit_die;
13127
13128 type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
13129 if (type_die)
13130 return type_die;
13131 gen_type_die (type, context_die);
13132 type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
13133 gcc_assert (type_die);
13134 }
13135 return type_die;
13136 }
13137
13138 /* Force out any required namespaces to be able to output DECL,
13139 and return the new context_die for it, if it's changed. */
13140
13141 static dw_die_ref
setup_namespace_context(tree thing,dw_die_ref context_die)13142 setup_namespace_context (tree thing, dw_die_ref context_die)
13143 {
13144 tree context = (DECL_P (thing)
13145 ? DECL_CONTEXT (thing) : TYPE_CONTEXT (thing));
13146 if (context && TREE_CODE (context) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
13147 /* Force out the namespace. */
13148 context_die = force_decl_die (context);
13149
13150 return context_die;
13151 }
13152
13153 /* Emit a declaration DIE for THING (which is either a DECL or a tagged
13154 type) within its namespace, if appropriate.
13155
13156 For compatibility with older debuggers, namespace DIEs only contain
13157 declarations; all definitions are emitted at CU scope. */
13158
13159 static void
declare_in_namespace(tree thing,dw_die_ref context_die)13160 declare_in_namespace (tree thing, dw_die_ref context_die)
13161 {
13162 dw_die_ref ns_context;
13163
13164 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
13165 return;
13166
13167 /* If this decl is from an inlined function, then don't try to emit it in its
13168 namespace, as we will get confused. It would have already been emitted
13169 when the abstract instance of the inline function was emitted anyways. */
13170 if (DECL_P (thing) && DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (thing))
13171 return;
13172
13173 ns_context = setup_namespace_context (thing, context_die);
13174
13175 if (ns_context != context_die)
13176 {
13177 if (DECL_P (thing))
13178 gen_decl_die (thing, ns_context);
13179 else
13180 gen_type_die (thing, ns_context);
13181 }
13182 }
13183
13184 /* Generate a DIE for a namespace or namespace alias. */
13185
13186 static void
gen_namespace_die(tree decl)13187 gen_namespace_die (tree decl)
13188 {
13189 dw_die_ref context_die = setup_namespace_context (decl, comp_unit_die);
13190
13191 /* Namespace aliases have a DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN of the namespace
13192 they are an alias of. */
13193 if (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) == NULL)
13194 {
13195 /* Output a real namespace. */
13196 dw_die_ref namespace_die
13197 = new_die (DW_TAG_namespace, context_die, decl);
13198 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (namespace_die, decl);
13199 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, namespace_die);
13200 }
13201 else
13202 {
13203 /* Output a namespace alias. */
13204
13205 /* Force out the namespace we are an alias of, if necessary. */
13206 dw_die_ref origin_die
13207 = force_decl_die (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl));
13208
13209 /* Now create the namespace alias DIE. */
13210 dw_die_ref namespace_die
13211 = new_die (DW_TAG_imported_declaration, context_die, decl);
13212 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (namespace_die, decl);
13213 add_AT_die_ref (namespace_die, DW_AT_import, origin_die);
13214 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, namespace_die);
13215 }
13216 }
13217
13218 /* Generate Dwarf debug information for a decl described by DECL. */
13219
13220 static void
gen_decl_die(tree decl,dw_die_ref context_die)13221 gen_decl_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
13222 {
13223 tree origin;
13224
13225 if (DECL_P (decl) && DECL_IGNORED_P (decl))
13226 return;
13227
13228 switch (TREE_CODE (decl))
13229 {
13230 case ERROR_MARK:
13231 break;
13232
13233 case CONST_DECL:
13234 /* The individual enumerators of an enum type get output when we output
13235 the Dwarf representation of the relevant enum type itself. */
13236 break;
13237
13238 case FUNCTION_DECL:
13239 /* Don't output any DIEs to represent mere function declarations,
13240 unless they are class members or explicit block externs. */
13241 if (DECL_INITIAL (decl) == NULL_TREE && DECL_CONTEXT (decl) == NULL_TREE
13242 && (current_function_decl == NULL_TREE || DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl)))
13243 break;
13244
13245 #if 0
13246 /* FIXME */
13247 /* This doesn't work because the C frontend sets DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN
13248 on local redeclarations of global functions. That seems broken. */
13249 if (current_function_decl != decl)
13250 /* This is only a declaration. */;
13251 #endif
13252
13253 /* If we're emitting a clone, emit info for the abstract instance. */
13254 if (DECL_ORIGIN (decl) != decl)
13255 dwarf2out_abstract_function (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl));
13256
13257 /* If we're emitting an out-of-line copy of an inline function,
13258 emit info for the abstract instance and set up to refer to it. */
13259 else if (cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl)
13260 && ! DECL_ABSTRACT (decl)
13261 && ! class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die)
13262 /* dwarf2out_abstract_function won't emit a die if this is just
13263 a declaration. We must avoid setting DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN in
13264 that case, because that works only if we have a die. */
13265 && DECL_INITIAL (decl) != NULL_TREE)
13266 {
13267 dwarf2out_abstract_function (decl);
13268 set_decl_origin_self (decl);
13269 }
13270
13271 /* Otherwise we're emitting the primary DIE for this decl. */
13272 else if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
13273 {
13274 /* Before we describe the FUNCTION_DECL itself, make sure that we
13275 have described its return type. */
13276 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)), context_die);
13277
13278 /* And its virtual context. */
13279 if (DECL_VINDEX (decl) != NULL_TREE)
13280 gen_type_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl), context_die);
13281
13282 /* And its containing type. */
13283 origin = decl_class_context (decl);
13284 if (origin != NULL_TREE)
13285 gen_type_die_for_member (origin, decl, context_die);
13286
13287 /* And its containing namespace. */
13288 declare_in_namespace (decl, context_die);
13289 }
13290
13291 /* Now output a DIE to represent the function itself. */
13292 gen_subprogram_die (decl, context_die);
13293 break;
13294
13295 case TYPE_DECL:
13296 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
13297 actual typedefs. */
13298 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
13299 break;
13300
13301 /* In the special case of a TYPE_DECL node representing the declaration
13302 of some type tag, if the given TYPE_DECL is marked as having been
13303 instantiated from some other (original) TYPE_DECL node (e.g. one which
13304 was generated within the original definition of an inline function) we
13305 have to generate a special (abbreviated) DW_TAG_structure_type,
13306 DW_TAG_union_type, or DW_TAG_enumeration_type DIE here. */
13307 if (TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl) && decl_ultimate_origin (decl) != NULL_TREE
13308 && is_tagged_type (TREE_TYPE (decl)))
13309 {
13310 gen_tagged_type_instantiation_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), context_die);
13311 break;
13312 }
13313
13314 if (is_redundant_typedef (decl))
13315 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), context_die);
13316 else
13317 /* Output a DIE to represent the typedef itself. */
13318 gen_typedef_die (decl, context_die);
13319 break;
13320
13321 case LABEL_DECL:
13322 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_NORMAL)
13323 gen_label_die (decl, context_die);
13324 break;
13325
13326 case VAR_DECL:
13327 case RESULT_DECL:
13328 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
13329 variable declarations or definitions. */
13330 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
13331 break;
13332
13333 /* Output any DIEs that are needed to specify the type of this data
13334 object. */
13335 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), context_die);
13336
13337 /* And its containing type. */
13338 origin = decl_class_context (decl);
13339 if (origin != NULL_TREE)
13340 gen_type_die_for_member (origin, decl, context_die);
13341
13342 /* And its containing namespace. */
13343 declare_in_namespace (decl, context_die);
13344
13345 /* Now output the DIE to represent the data object itself. This gets
13346 complicated because of the possibility that the VAR_DECL really
13347 represents an inlined instance of a formal parameter for an inline
13348 function. */
13349 origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
13350 if (origin != NULL_TREE && TREE_CODE (origin) == PARM_DECL)
13351 gen_formal_parameter_die (decl, context_die);
13352 else
13353 gen_variable_die (decl, context_die);
13354 break;
13355
13356 case FIELD_DECL:
13357 /* Ignore the nameless fields that are used to skip bits but handle C++
13358 anonymous unions and structs. */
13359 if (DECL_NAME (decl) != NULL_TREE
13360 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == UNION_TYPE
13361 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == RECORD_TYPE)
13362 {
13363 gen_type_die (member_declared_type (decl), context_die);
13364 gen_field_die (decl, context_die);
13365 }
13366 break;
13367
13368 case PARM_DECL:
13369 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), context_die);
13370 gen_formal_parameter_die (decl, context_die);
13371 break;
13372
13373 case NAMESPACE_DECL:
13374 gen_namespace_die (decl);
13375 break;
13376
13377 default:
13378 /* Probably some frontend-internal decl. Assume we don't care. */
13379 gcc_assert ((int)TREE_CODE (decl) > NUM_TREE_CODES);
13380 break;
13381 }
13382 }
13383
13384 /* Output debug information for global decl DECL. Called from toplev.c after
13385 compilation proper has finished. */
13386
13387 static void
dwarf2out_global_decl(tree decl)13388 dwarf2out_global_decl (tree decl)
13389 {
13390 /* Output DWARF2 information for file-scope tentative data object
13391 declarations, file-scope (extern) function declarations (which had no
13392 corresponding body) and file-scope tagged type declarations and
13393 definitions which have not yet been forced out. */
13394 if (TREE_CODE (decl) != FUNCTION_DECL || !DECL_INITIAL (decl))
13395 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
13396 }
13397
13398 /* Output debug information for type decl DECL. Called from toplev.c
13399 and from language front ends (to record built-in types). */
13400 static void
dwarf2out_type_decl(tree decl,int local)13401 dwarf2out_type_decl (tree decl, int local)
13402 {
13403 if (!local)
13404 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
13405 }
13406
13407 /* Output debug information for imported module or decl. */
13408
13409 static void
dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl(tree decl,tree context)13410 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl (tree decl, tree context)
13411 {
13412 dw_die_ref imported_die, at_import_die;
13413 dw_die_ref scope_die;
13414 expanded_location xloc;
13415
13416 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
13417 return;
13418
13419 gcc_assert (decl);
13420
13421 /* To emit DW_TAG_imported_module or DW_TAG_imported_decl, we need two DIEs.
13422 We need decl DIE for reference and scope die. First, get DIE for the decl
13423 itself. */
13424
13425 /* Get the scope die for decl context. Use comp_unit_die for global module
13426 or decl. If die is not found for non globals, force new die. */
13427 if (!context)
13428 scope_die = comp_unit_die;
13429 else if (TYPE_P (context))
13430 {
13431 if (!should_emit_struct_debug (context, DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE))
13432 return;
13433 scope_die = force_type_die (context);
13434 }
13435 else
13436 scope_die = force_decl_die (context);
13437
13438 /* For TYPE_DECL or CONST_DECL, lookup TREE_TYPE. */
13439 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL || TREE_CODE (decl) == CONST_DECL)
13440 {
13441 if (is_base_type (TREE_TYPE (decl)))
13442 at_import_die = base_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl));
13443 else
13444 at_import_die = force_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl));
13445 }
13446 else
13447 {
13448 at_import_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
13449 if (!at_import_die)
13450 {
13451 /* If we're trying to avoid duplicate debug info, we may not have
13452 emitted the member decl for this field. Emit it now. */
13453 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL)
13454 {
13455 tree type = DECL_CONTEXT (decl);
13456 dw_die_ref type_context_die;
13457
13458 if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
13459 if (TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)))
13460 {
13461 if (!should_emit_struct_debug (TYPE_CONTEXT (type),
13462 DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE))
13463 return;
13464 type_context_die = force_type_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
13465 }
13466 else
13467 type_context_die = force_decl_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
13468 else
13469 type_context_die = comp_unit_die;
13470 gen_type_die_for_member (type, decl, type_context_die);
13471 }
13472 at_import_die = force_decl_die (decl);
13473 }
13474 }
13475
13476 /* OK, now we have DIEs for decl as well as scope. Emit imported die. */
13477 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
13478 imported_die = new_die (DW_TAG_imported_module, scope_die, context);
13479 else
13480 imported_die = new_die (DW_TAG_imported_declaration, scope_die, context);
13481
13482 xloc = expand_location (input_location);
13483 add_AT_file (imported_die, DW_AT_decl_file, lookup_filename (xloc.file));
13484 add_AT_unsigned (imported_die, DW_AT_decl_line, xloc.line);
13485 add_AT_die_ref (imported_die, DW_AT_import, at_import_die);
13486 }
13487
13488 /* Write the debugging output for DECL. */
13489
13490 void
dwarf2out_decl(tree decl)13491 dwarf2out_decl (tree decl)
13492 {
13493 dw_die_ref context_die = comp_unit_die;
13494
13495 switch (TREE_CODE (decl))
13496 {
13497 case ERROR_MARK:
13498 return;
13499
13500 case FUNCTION_DECL:
13501 /* What we would really like to do here is to filter out all mere
13502 file-scope declarations of file-scope functions which are never
13503 referenced later within this translation unit (and keep all of ones
13504 that *are* referenced later on) but we aren't clairvoyant, so we have
13505 no idea which functions will be referenced in the future (i.e. later
13506 on within the current translation unit). So here we just ignore all
13507 file-scope function declarations which are not also definitions. If
13508 and when the debugger needs to know something about these functions,
13509 it will have to hunt around and find the DWARF information associated
13510 with the definition of the function.
13511
13512 We can't just check DECL_EXTERNAL to find out which FUNCTION_DECL
13513 nodes represent definitions and which ones represent mere
13514 declarations. We have to check DECL_INITIAL instead. That's because
13515 the C front-end supports some weird semantics for "extern inline"
13516 function definitions. These can get inlined within the current
13517 translation unit (and thus, we need to generate Dwarf info for their
13518 abstract instances so that the Dwarf info for the concrete inlined
13519 instances can have something to refer to) but the compiler never
13520 generates any out-of-lines instances of such things (despite the fact
13521 that they *are* definitions).
13522
13523 The important point is that the C front-end marks these "extern
13524 inline" functions as DECL_EXTERNAL, but we need to generate DWARF for
13525 them anyway. Note that the C++ front-end also plays some similar games
13526 for inline function definitions appearing within include files which
13527 also contain `#pragma interface' pragmas. */
13528 if (DECL_INITIAL (decl) == NULL_TREE)
13529 return;
13530
13531 /* If we're a nested function, initially use a parent of NULL; if we're
13532 a plain function, this will be fixed up in decls_for_scope. If
13533 we're a method, it will be ignored, since we already have a DIE. */
13534 if (decl_function_context (decl)
13535 /* But if we're in terse mode, we don't care about scope. */
13536 && debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
13537 context_die = NULL;
13538 break;
13539
13540 case VAR_DECL:
13541 /* Ignore this VAR_DECL if it refers to a file-scope extern data object
13542 declaration and if the declaration was never even referenced from
13543 within this entire compilation unit. We suppress these DIEs in
13544 order to save space in the .debug section (by eliminating entries
13545 which are probably useless). Note that we must not suppress
13546 block-local extern declarations (whether used or not) because that
13547 would screw-up the debugger's name lookup mechanism and cause it to
13548 miss things which really ought to be in scope at a given point. */
13549 if (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) && !TREE_USED (decl))
13550 return;
13551
13552 /* For local statics lookup proper context die. */
13553 if (TREE_STATIC (decl) && decl_function_context (decl))
13554 context_die = lookup_decl_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl));
13555
13556 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
13557 variable declarations or definitions. */
13558 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
13559 return;
13560 break;
13561
13562 case NAMESPACE_DECL:
13563 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
13564 return;
13565 if (lookup_decl_die (decl) != NULL)
13566 return;
13567 break;
13568
13569 case TYPE_DECL:
13570 /* Don't emit stubs for types unless they are needed by other DIEs. */
13571 if (TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (decl))
13572 return;
13573
13574 /* Don't bother trying to generate any DIEs to represent any of the
13575 normal built-in types for the language we are compiling. */
13576 if (DECL_IS_BUILTIN (decl))
13577 {
13578 /* OK, we need to generate one for `bool' so GDB knows what type
13579 comparisons have. */
13580 if (is_cxx ()
13581 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == BOOLEAN_TYPE
13582 && ! DECL_IGNORED_P (decl))
13583 modified_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), 0, 0, NULL);
13584
13585 return;
13586 }
13587
13588 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs for types. */
13589 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
13590 return;
13591
13592 /* If we're a function-scope tag, initially use a parent of NULL;
13593 this will be fixed up in decls_for_scope. */
13594 if (decl_function_context (decl))
13595 context_die = NULL;
13596
13597 break;
13598
13599 default:
13600 return;
13601 }
13602
13603 gen_decl_die (decl, context_die);
13604 }
13605
13606 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the beginning of the generated code for
13607 a lexical block. */
13608
13609 static void
dwarf2out_begin_block(unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,unsigned int blocknum)13610 dwarf2out_begin_block (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
13611 unsigned int blocknum)
13612 {
13613 switch_to_section (current_function_section ());
13614 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL, blocknum);
13615 }
13616
13617 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the end of the generated code for a
13618 lexical block. */
13619
13620 static void
dwarf2out_end_block(unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,unsigned int blocknum)13621 dwarf2out_end_block (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, unsigned int blocknum)
13622 {
13623 switch_to_section (current_function_section ());
13624 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, BLOCK_END_LABEL, blocknum);
13625 }
13626
13627 /* Returns nonzero if it is appropriate not to emit any debugging
13628 information for BLOCK, because it doesn't contain any instructions.
13629
13630 Don't allow this for blocks with nested functions or local classes
13631 as we would end up with orphans, and in the presence of scheduling
13632 we may end up calling them anyway. */
13633
13634 static bool
dwarf2out_ignore_block(tree block)13635 dwarf2out_ignore_block (tree block)
13636 {
13637 tree decl;
13638
13639 for (decl = BLOCK_VARS (block); decl; decl = TREE_CHAIN (decl))
13640 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL
13641 || (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL && TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl)))
13642 return 0;
13643
13644 return 1;
13645 }
13646
13647 /* Hash table routines for file_hash. */
13648
13649 static int
file_table_eq(const void * p1_p,const void * p2_p)13650 file_table_eq (const void *p1_p, const void *p2_p)
13651 {
13652 const struct dwarf_file_data * p1 = p1_p;
13653 const char * p2 = p2_p;
13654 return strcmp (p1->filename, p2) == 0;
13655 }
13656
13657 static hashval_t
file_table_hash(const void * p_p)13658 file_table_hash (const void *p_p)
13659 {
13660 const struct dwarf_file_data * p = p_p;
13661 return htab_hash_string (p->filename);
13662 }
13663
13664 /* Lookup FILE_NAME (in the list of filenames that we know about here in
13665 dwarf2out.c) and return its "index". The index of each (known) filename is
13666 just a unique number which is associated with only that one filename. We
13667 need such numbers for the sake of generating labels (in the .debug_sfnames
13668 section) and references to those files numbers (in the .debug_srcinfo
13669 and.debug_macinfo sections). If the filename given as an argument is not
13670 found in our current list, add it to the list and assign it the next
13671 available unique index number. In order to speed up searches, we remember
13672 the index of the filename was looked up last. This handles the majority of
13673 all searches. */
13674
13675 static struct dwarf_file_data *
lookup_filename(const char * file_name)13676 lookup_filename (const char *file_name)
13677 {
13678 void ** slot;
13679 struct dwarf_file_data * created;
13680
13681 /* Check to see if the file name that was searched on the previous
13682 call matches this file name. If so, return the index. */
13683 if (file_table_last_lookup
13684 && (file_name == file_table_last_lookup->filename
13685 || strcmp (file_table_last_lookup->filename, file_name) == 0))
13686 return file_table_last_lookup;
13687
13688 /* Didn't match the previous lookup, search the table. */
13689 slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (file_table, file_name,
13690 htab_hash_string (file_name), INSERT);
13691 if (*slot)
13692 return *slot;
13693
13694 created = ggc_alloc (sizeof (struct dwarf_file_data));
13695 created->filename = file_name;
13696 created->emitted_number = 0;
13697 *slot = created;
13698 return created;
13699 }
13700
13701 /* If the assembler will construct the file table, then translate the compiler
13702 internal file table number into the assembler file table number, and emit
13703 a .file directive if we haven't already emitted one yet. The file table
13704 numbers are different because we prune debug info for unused variables and
13705 types, which may include filenames. */
13706
13707 static int
maybe_emit_file(struct dwarf_file_data * fd)13708 maybe_emit_file (struct dwarf_file_data * fd)
13709 {
13710 if (! fd->emitted_number)
13711 {
13712 if (last_emitted_file)
13713 fd->emitted_number = last_emitted_file->emitted_number + 1;
13714 else
13715 fd->emitted_number = 1;
13716 last_emitted_file = fd;
13717
13718 if (DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
13719 {
13720 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.file %u ", fd->emitted_number);
13721 output_quoted_string (asm_out_file, fd->filename);
13722 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
13723 }
13724 }
13725
13726 return fd->emitted_number;
13727 }
13728
13729 /* Called by the final INSN scan whenever we see a var location. We
13730 use it to drop labels in the right places, and throw the location in
13731 our lookup table. */
13732
13733 static void
dwarf2out_var_location(rtx loc_note)13734 dwarf2out_var_location (rtx loc_note)
13735 {
13736 char loclabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
13737 struct var_loc_node *newloc;
13738 rtx prev_insn;
13739 static rtx last_insn;
13740 static const char *last_label;
13741 tree decl;
13742
13743 if (!DECL_P (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (loc_note)))
13744 return;
13745 prev_insn = PREV_INSN (loc_note);
13746
13747 newloc = ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (struct var_loc_node));
13748 /* If the insn we processed last time is the previous insn
13749 and it is also a var location note, use the label we emitted
13750 last time. */
13751 if (last_insn != NULL_RTX
13752 && last_insn == prev_insn
13753 && NOTE_P (prev_insn)
13754 && NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (prev_insn) == NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION)
13755 {
13756 newloc->label = last_label;
13757 }
13758 else
13759 {
13760 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (loclabel, "LVL", loclabel_num);
13761 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, "LVL", loclabel_num);
13762 loclabel_num++;
13763 newloc->label = ggc_strdup (loclabel);
13764 }
13765 newloc->var_loc_note = loc_note;
13766 newloc->next = NULL;
13767
13768 if (cfun && in_cold_section_p)
13769 newloc->section_label = cfun->cold_section_label;
13770 else
13771 newloc->section_label = text_section_label;
13772
13773 last_insn = loc_note;
13774 last_label = newloc->label;
13775 decl = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (loc_note);
13776 add_var_loc_to_decl (decl, newloc);
13777 }
13778
13779 /* We need to reset the locations at the beginning of each
13780 function. We can't do this in the end_function hook, because the
13781 declarations that use the locations won't have been output when
13782 that hook is called. Also compute have_multiple_function_sections here. */
13783
13784 static void
dwarf2out_begin_function(tree fun)13785 dwarf2out_begin_function (tree fun)
13786 {
13787 htab_empty (decl_loc_table);
13788
13789 if (function_section (fun) != text_section)
13790 have_multiple_function_sections = true;
13791 }
13792
13793 /* Output a label to mark the beginning of a source code line entry
13794 and record information relating to this source line, in
13795 'line_info_table' for later output of the .debug_line section. */
13796
13797 static void
dwarf2out_source_line(unsigned int line,const char * filename)13798 dwarf2out_source_line (unsigned int line, const char *filename)
13799 {
13800 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_NORMAL
13801 && line != 0)
13802 {
13803 int file_num = maybe_emit_file (lookup_filename (filename));
13804
13805 switch_to_section (current_function_section ());
13806
13807 /* If requested, emit something human-readable. */
13808 if (flag_debug_asm)
13809 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t%s %s:%d\n", ASM_COMMENT_START,
13810 filename, line);
13811
13812 if (DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
13813 {
13814 /* Emit the .loc directive understood by GNU as. */
13815 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.loc %d %d 0\n", file_num, line);
13816
13817 /* Indicate that line number info exists. */
13818 line_info_table_in_use++;
13819 }
13820 else if (function_section (current_function_decl) != text_section)
13821 {
13822 dw_separate_line_info_ref line_info;
13823 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file,
13824 SEPARATE_LINE_CODE_LABEL,
13825 separate_line_info_table_in_use);
13826
13827 /* Expand the line info table if necessary. */
13828 if (separate_line_info_table_in_use
13829 == separate_line_info_table_allocated)
13830 {
13831 separate_line_info_table_allocated += LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT;
13832 separate_line_info_table
13833 = ggc_realloc (separate_line_info_table,
13834 separate_line_info_table_allocated
13835 * sizeof (dw_separate_line_info_entry));
13836 memset (separate_line_info_table
13837 + separate_line_info_table_in_use,
13838 0,
13839 (LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT
13840 * sizeof (dw_separate_line_info_entry)));
13841 }
13842
13843 /* Add the new entry at the end of the line_info_table. */
13844 line_info
13845 = &separate_line_info_table[separate_line_info_table_in_use++];
13846 line_info->dw_file_num = file_num;
13847 line_info->dw_line_num = line;
13848 line_info->function = current_function_funcdef_no;
13849 }
13850 else
13851 {
13852 dw_line_info_ref line_info;
13853
13854 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, LINE_CODE_LABEL,
13855 line_info_table_in_use);
13856
13857 /* Expand the line info table if necessary. */
13858 if (line_info_table_in_use == line_info_table_allocated)
13859 {
13860 line_info_table_allocated += LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT;
13861 line_info_table
13862 = ggc_realloc (line_info_table,
13863 (line_info_table_allocated
13864 * sizeof (dw_line_info_entry)));
13865 memset (line_info_table + line_info_table_in_use, 0,
13866 LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (dw_line_info_entry));
13867 }
13868
13869 /* Add the new entry at the end of the line_info_table. */
13870 line_info = &line_info_table[line_info_table_in_use++];
13871 line_info->dw_file_num = file_num;
13872 line_info->dw_line_num = line;
13873 }
13874 }
13875 }
13876
13877 /* Record the beginning of a new source file. */
13878
13879 static void
dwarf2out_start_source_file(unsigned int lineno,const char * filename)13880 dwarf2out_start_source_file (unsigned int lineno, const char *filename)
13881 {
13882 if (flag_eliminate_dwarf2_dups)
13883 {
13884 /* Record the beginning of the file for break_out_includes. */
13885 dw_die_ref bincl_die;
13886
13887 bincl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL, comp_unit_die, NULL);
13888 add_AT_string (bincl_die, DW_AT_name, filename);
13889 }
13890
13891 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
13892 {
13893 int file_num = maybe_emit_file (lookup_filename (filename));
13894
13895 switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
13896 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_start_file, "Start new file");
13897 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (lineno, "Included from line number %d",
13898 lineno);
13899
13900 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (file_num, "file %s", filename);
13901 }
13902 }
13903
13904 /* Record the end of a source file. */
13905
13906 static void
dwarf2out_end_source_file(unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)13907 dwarf2out_end_source_file (unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
13908 {
13909 if (flag_eliminate_dwarf2_dups)
13910 /* Record the end of the file for break_out_includes. */
13911 new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL, comp_unit_die, NULL);
13912
13913 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
13914 {
13915 switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
13916 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_end_file, "End file");
13917 }
13918 }
13919
13920 /* Called from debug_define in toplev.c. The `buffer' parameter contains
13921 the tail part of the directive line, i.e. the part which is past the
13922 initial whitespace, #, whitespace, directive-name, whitespace part. */
13923
13924 static void
dwarf2out_define(unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,const char * buffer ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)13925 dwarf2out_define (unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
13926 const char *buffer ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
13927 {
13928 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
13929 {
13930 switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
13931 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_define, "Define macro");
13932 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (lineno, "At line number %d", lineno);
13933 dw2_asm_output_nstring (buffer, -1, "The macro");
13934 }
13935 }
13936
13937 /* Called from debug_undef in toplev.c. The `buffer' parameter contains
13938 the tail part of the directive line, i.e. the part which is past the
13939 initial whitespace, #, whitespace, directive-name, whitespace part. */
13940
13941 static void
dwarf2out_undef(unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,const char * buffer ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)13942 dwarf2out_undef (unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
13943 const char *buffer ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
13944 {
13945 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
13946 {
13947 switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
13948 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_undef, "Undefine macro");
13949 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (lineno, "At line number %d", lineno);
13950 dw2_asm_output_nstring (buffer, -1, "The macro");
13951 }
13952 }
13953
13954 /* Set up for Dwarf output at the start of compilation. */
13955
13956 static void
dwarf2out_init(const char * filename ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)13957 dwarf2out_init (const char *filename ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
13958 {
13959 /* Allocate the file_table. */
13960 file_table = htab_create_ggc (50, file_table_hash,
13961 file_table_eq, NULL);
13962
13963 /* Allocate the decl_die_table. */
13964 decl_die_table = htab_create_ggc (10, decl_die_table_hash,
13965 decl_die_table_eq, NULL);
13966
13967 /* Allocate the decl_loc_table. */
13968 decl_loc_table = htab_create_ggc (10, decl_loc_table_hash,
13969 decl_loc_table_eq, NULL);
13970
13971 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the decl_scope_table. */
13972 decl_scope_table = VEC_alloc (tree, gc, 256);
13973
13974 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the abbrev_die_table. */
13975 abbrev_die_table = ggc_alloc_cleared (ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT
13976 * sizeof (dw_die_ref));
13977 abbrev_die_table_allocated = ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
13978 /* Zero-th entry is allocated, but unused. */
13979 abbrev_die_table_in_use = 1;
13980
13981 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the line_info_table. */
13982 line_info_table = ggc_alloc_cleared (LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT
13983 * sizeof (dw_line_info_entry));
13984 line_info_table_allocated = LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT;
13985
13986 /* Zero-th entry is allocated, but unused. */
13987 line_info_table_in_use = 1;
13988
13989 /* Allocate the pubtypes and pubnames vectors. */
13990 pubname_table = VEC_alloc (pubname_entry, gc, 32);
13991 pubtype_table = VEC_alloc (pubname_entry, gc, 32);
13992
13993 /* Generate the initial DIE for the .debug section. Note that the (string)
13994 value given in the DW_AT_name attribute of the DW_TAG_compile_unit DIE
13995 will (typically) be a relative pathname and that this pathname should be
13996 taken as being relative to the directory from which the compiler was
13997 invoked when the given (base) source file was compiled. We will fill
13998 in this value in dwarf2out_finish. */
13999 comp_unit_die = gen_compile_unit_die (NULL);
14000
14001 incomplete_types = VEC_alloc (tree, gc, 64);
14002
14003 used_rtx_array = VEC_alloc (rtx, gc, 32);
14004
14005 debug_info_section = get_section (DEBUG_INFO_SECTION,
14006 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
14007 debug_abbrev_section = get_section (DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION,
14008 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
14009 debug_aranges_section = get_section (DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION,
14010 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
14011 debug_macinfo_section = get_section (DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION,
14012 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
14013 debug_line_section = get_section (DEBUG_LINE_SECTION,
14014 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
14015 debug_loc_section = get_section (DEBUG_LOC_SECTION,
14016 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
14017 debug_pubnames_section = get_section (DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION,
14018 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
14019 #ifdef DEBUG_PUBTYPES_SECTION
14020 debug_pubtypes_section = get_section (DEBUG_PUBTYPES_SECTION,
14021 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
14022 #endif
14023 debug_str_section = get_section (DEBUG_STR_SECTION,
14024 DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS, NULL);
14025 debug_ranges_section = get_section (DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION,
14026 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
14027 debug_frame_section = get_section (DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION,
14028 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
14029
14030 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (text_end_label, TEXT_END_LABEL, 0);
14031 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (abbrev_section_label,
14032 DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
14033 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (text_section_label, TEXT_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
14034 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (cold_text_section_label,
14035 COLD_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
14036 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (cold_end_label, COLD_END_LABEL, 0);
14037
14038 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_info_section_label,
14039 DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
14040 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_line_section_label,
14041 DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
14042 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (ranges_section_label,
14043 DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
14044 switch_to_section (debug_abbrev_section);
14045 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, abbrev_section_label);
14046 switch_to_section (debug_info_section);
14047 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_info_section_label);
14048 switch_to_section (debug_line_section);
14049 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_line_section_label);
14050
14051 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
14052 {
14053 switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
14054 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (macinfo_section_label,
14055 DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
14056 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, macinfo_section_label);
14057 }
14058
14059 switch_to_section (text_section);
14060 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, text_section_label);
14061 if (flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition)
14062 {
14063 switch_to_section (unlikely_text_section ());
14064 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, cold_text_section_label);
14065 }
14066 }
14067
14068 /* A helper function for dwarf2out_finish called through
14069 ht_forall. Emit one queued .debug_str string. */
14070
14071 static int
output_indirect_string(void ** h,void * v ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)14072 output_indirect_string (void **h, void *v ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
14073 {
14074 struct indirect_string_node *node = (struct indirect_string_node *) *h;
14075
14076 if (node->form == DW_FORM_strp)
14077 {
14078 switch_to_section (debug_str_section);
14079 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, node->label);
14080 assemble_string (node->str, strlen (node->str) + 1);
14081 }
14082
14083 return 1;
14084 }
14085
14086 #if ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING
14087 /* Verify that all marks are clear. */
14088
14089 static void
verify_marks_clear(dw_die_ref die)14090 verify_marks_clear (dw_die_ref die)
14091 {
14092 dw_die_ref c;
14093
14094 gcc_assert (! die->die_mark);
14095 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, verify_marks_clear (c));
14096 }
14097 #endif /* ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING */
14098
14099 /* Clear the marks for a die and its children.
14100 Be cool if the mark isn't set. */
14101
14102 static void
prune_unmark_dies(dw_die_ref die)14103 prune_unmark_dies (dw_die_ref die)
14104 {
14105 dw_die_ref c;
14106
14107 if (die->die_mark)
14108 die->die_mark = 0;
14109 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unmark_dies (c));
14110 }
14111
14112 /* Given DIE that we're marking as used, find any other dies
14113 it references as attributes and mark them as used. */
14114
14115 static void
prune_unused_types_walk_attribs(dw_die_ref die)14116 prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (dw_die_ref die)
14117 {
14118 dw_attr_ref a;
14119 unsigned ix;
14120
14121 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
14122 {
14123 if (a->dw_attr_val.val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref)
14124 {
14125 /* A reference to another DIE.
14126 Make sure that it will get emitted. */
14127 prune_unused_types_mark (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die, 1);
14128 }
14129 /* Set the string's refcount to 0 so that prune_unused_types_mark
14130 accounts properly for it. */
14131 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str)
14132 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount = 0;
14133 }
14134 }
14135
14136
14137 /* Mark DIE as being used. If DOKIDS is true, then walk down
14138 to DIE's children. */
14139
14140 static void
prune_unused_types_mark(dw_die_ref die,int dokids)14141 prune_unused_types_mark (dw_die_ref die, int dokids)
14142 {
14143 dw_die_ref c;
14144
14145 if (die->die_mark == 0)
14146 {
14147 /* We haven't done this node yet. Mark it as used. */
14148 die->die_mark = 1;
14149
14150 /* We also have to mark its parents as used.
14151 (But we don't want to mark our parents' kids due to this.) */
14152 if (die->die_parent)
14153 prune_unused_types_mark (die->die_parent, 0);
14154
14155 /* Mark any referenced nodes. */
14156 prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (die);
14157
14158 /* If this node is a specification,
14159 also mark the definition, if it exists. */
14160 if (get_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_declaration) && die->die_definition)
14161 prune_unused_types_mark (die->die_definition, 1);
14162 }
14163
14164 if (dokids && die->die_mark != 2)
14165 {
14166 /* We need to walk the children, but haven't done so yet.
14167 Remember that we've walked the kids. */
14168 die->die_mark = 2;
14169
14170 /* If this is an array type, we need to make sure our
14171 kids get marked, even if they're types. */
14172 if (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_array_type)
14173 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unused_types_mark (c, 1));
14174 else
14175 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unused_types_walk (c));
14176 }
14177 }
14178
14179
14180 /* Walk the tree DIE and mark types that we actually use. */
14181
14182 static void
prune_unused_types_walk(dw_die_ref die)14183 prune_unused_types_walk (dw_die_ref die)
14184 {
14185 dw_die_ref c;
14186
14187 /* Don't do anything if this node is already marked. */
14188 if (die->die_mark)
14189 return;
14190
14191 switch (die->die_tag) {
14192 case DW_TAG_const_type:
14193 case DW_TAG_packed_type:
14194 case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
14195 case DW_TAG_reference_type:
14196 case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
14197 case DW_TAG_typedef:
14198 case DW_TAG_array_type:
14199 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
14200 case DW_TAG_union_type:
14201 case DW_TAG_class_type:
14202 case DW_TAG_friend:
14203 case DW_TAG_variant_part:
14204 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
14205 case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
14206 case DW_TAG_string_type:
14207 case DW_TAG_set_type:
14208 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
14209 case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
14210 case DW_TAG_file_type:
14211 if (die->die_perennial_p)
14212 break;
14213
14214 /* It's a type node --- don't mark it. */
14215 return;
14216
14217 default:
14218 /* Mark everything else. */
14219 break;
14220 }
14221
14222 die->die_mark = 1;
14223
14224 /* Now, mark any dies referenced from here. */
14225 prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (die);
14226
14227 /* Mark children. */
14228 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unused_types_walk (c));
14229 }
14230
14231 /* Increment the string counts on strings referred to from DIE's
14232 attributes. */
14233
14234 static void
prune_unused_types_update_strings(dw_die_ref die)14235 prune_unused_types_update_strings (dw_die_ref die)
14236 {
14237 dw_attr_ref a;
14238 unsigned ix;
14239
14240 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
14241 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str)
14242 {
14243 struct indirect_string_node *s = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str;
14244 s->refcount++;
14245 /* Avoid unnecessarily putting strings that are used less than
14246 twice in the hash table. */
14247 if (s->refcount
14248 == ((DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS & SECTION_MERGE) ? 1 : 2))
14249 {
14250 void ** slot;
14251 slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (debug_str_hash, s->str,
14252 htab_hash_string (s->str),
14253 INSERT);
14254 gcc_assert (*slot == NULL);
14255 *slot = s;
14256 }
14257 }
14258 }
14259
14260 /* Remove from the tree DIE any dies that aren't marked. */
14261
14262 static void
prune_unused_types_prune(dw_die_ref die)14263 prune_unused_types_prune (dw_die_ref die)
14264 {
14265 dw_die_ref c;
14266
14267 gcc_assert (die->die_mark);
14268 prune_unused_types_update_strings (die);
14269
14270 if (! die->die_child)
14271 return;
14272
14273 c = die->die_child;
14274 do {
14275 dw_die_ref prev = c;
14276 for (c = c->die_sib; ! c->die_mark; c = c->die_sib)
14277 if (c == die->die_child)
14278 {
14279 /* No marked children between 'prev' and the end of the list. */
14280 if (prev == c)
14281 /* No marked children at all. */
14282 die->die_child = NULL;
14283 else
14284 {
14285 prev->die_sib = c->die_sib;
14286 die->die_child = prev;
14287 }
14288 return;
14289 }
14290
14291 if (c != prev->die_sib)
14292 prev->die_sib = c;
14293 prune_unused_types_prune (c);
14294 } while (c != die->die_child);
14295 }
14296
14297
14298 /* Remove dies representing declarations that we never use. */
14299
14300 static void
prune_unused_types(void)14301 prune_unused_types (void)
14302 {
14303 unsigned int i;
14304 limbo_die_node *node;
14305 pubname_ref pub;
14306
14307 #if ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING
14308 /* All the marks should already be clear. */
14309 verify_marks_clear (comp_unit_die);
14310 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
14311 verify_marks_clear (node->die);
14312 #endif /* ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING */
14313
14314 /* Set the mark on nodes that are actually used. */
14315 prune_unused_types_walk (comp_unit_die);
14316 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
14317 prune_unused_types_walk (node->die);
14318
14319 /* Also set the mark on nodes referenced from the
14320 pubname_table or arange_table. */
14321 for (i = 0; VEC_iterate (pubname_entry, pubname_table, i, pub); i++)
14322 prune_unused_types_mark (pub->die, 1);
14323 for (i = 0; i < arange_table_in_use; i++)
14324 prune_unused_types_mark (arange_table[i], 1);
14325
14326 /* Get rid of nodes that aren't marked; and update the string counts. */
14327 if (debug_str_hash)
14328 htab_empty (debug_str_hash);
14329 prune_unused_types_prune (comp_unit_die);
14330 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
14331 prune_unused_types_prune (node->die);
14332
14333 /* Leave the marks clear. */
14334 prune_unmark_dies (comp_unit_die);
14335 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
14336 prune_unmark_dies (node->die);
14337 }
14338
14339 /* Set the parameter to true if there are any relative pathnames in
14340 the file table. */
14341 static int
file_table_relative_p(void ** slot,void * param)14342 file_table_relative_p (void ** slot, void *param)
14343 {
14344 bool *p = param;
14345 struct dwarf_file_data *d = *slot;
14346 if (d->emitted_number && d->filename[0] != DIR_SEPARATOR)
14347 {
14348 *p = true;
14349 return 0;
14350 }
14351 return 1;
14352 }
14353
14354 /* Output stuff that dwarf requires at the end of every file,
14355 and generate the DWARF-2 debugging info. */
14356
14357 static void
dwarf2out_finish(const char * filename)14358 dwarf2out_finish (const char *filename)
14359 {
14360 limbo_die_node *node, *next_node;
14361 dw_die_ref die = 0;
14362
14363 /* Add the name for the main input file now. We delayed this from
14364 dwarf2out_init to avoid complications with PCH. */
14365 add_name_attribute (comp_unit_die, filename);
14366 if (filename[0] != DIR_SEPARATOR)
14367 add_comp_dir_attribute (comp_unit_die);
14368 else if (get_AT (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_comp_dir) == NULL)
14369 {
14370 bool p = false;
14371 htab_traverse (file_table, file_table_relative_p, &p);
14372 if (p)
14373 add_comp_dir_attribute (comp_unit_die);
14374 }
14375
14376 /* Traverse the limbo die list, and add parent/child links. The only
14377 dies without parents that should be here are concrete instances of
14378 inline functions, and the comp_unit_die. We can ignore the comp_unit_die.
14379 For concrete instances, we can get the parent die from the abstract
14380 instance. */
14381 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = next_node)
14382 {
14383 next_node = node->next;
14384 die = node->die;
14385
14386 if (die->die_parent == NULL)
14387 {
14388 dw_die_ref origin = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin);
14389
14390 if (origin)
14391 add_child_die (origin->die_parent, die);
14392 else if (die == comp_unit_die)
14393 ;
14394 else if (errorcount > 0 || sorrycount > 0)
14395 /* It's OK to be confused by errors in the input. */
14396 add_child_die (comp_unit_die, die);
14397 else
14398 {
14399 /* In certain situations, the lexical block containing a
14400 nested function can be optimized away, which results
14401 in the nested function die being orphaned. Likewise
14402 with the return type of that nested function. Force
14403 this to be a child of the containing function.
14404
14405 It may happen that even the containing function got fully
14406 inlined and optimized out. In that case we are lost and
14407 assign the empty child. This should not be big issue as
14408 the function is likely unreachable too. */
14409 tree context = NULL_TREE;
14410
14411 gcc_assert (node->created_for);
14412
14413 if (DECL_P (node->created_for))
14414 context = DECL_CONTEXT (node->created_for);
14415 else if (TYPE_P (node->created_for))
14416 context = TYPE_CONTEXT (node->created_for);
14417
14418 gcc_assert (context
14419 && (TREE_CODE (context) == FUNCTION_DECL
14420 || TREE_CODE (context) == NAMESPACE_DECL));
14421
14422 origin = lookup_decl_die (context);
14423 if (origin)
14424 add_child_die (origin, die);
14425 else
14426 add_child_die (comp_unit_die, die);
14427 }
14428 }
14429 }
14430
14431 limbo_die_list = NULL;
14432
14433 /* Walk through the list of incomplete types again, trying once more to
14434 emit full debugging info for them. */
14435 retry_incomplete_types ();
14436
14437 if (flag_eliminate_unused_debug_types)
14438 prune_unused_types ();
14439
14440 /* Generate separate CUs for each of the include files we've seen.
14441 They will go into limbo_die_list. */
14442 if (flag_eliminate_dwarf2_dups)
14443 break_out_includes (comp_unit_die);
14444
14445 /* Traverse the DIE's and add add sibling attributes to those DIE's
14446 that have children. */
14447 add_sibling_attributes (comp_unit_die);
14448 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
14449 add_sibling_attributes (node->die);
14450
14451 /* Output a terminator label for the .text section. */
14452 switch_to_section (text_section);
14453 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, TEXT_END_LABEL, 0);
14454 if (flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition)
14455 {
14456 switch_to_section (unlikely_text_section ());
14457 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, COLD_END_LABEL, 0);
14458 }
14459
14460 /* We can only use the low/high_pc attributes if all of the code was
14461 in .text. */
14462 if (!have_multiple_function_sections)
14463 {
14464 add_AT_lbl_id (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_low_pc, text_section_label);
14465 add_AT_lbl_id (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_high_pc, text_end_label);
14466 }
14467
14468 /* If it wasn't, we need to give .debug_loc and .debug_ranges an appropriate
14469 "base address". Use zero so that these addresses become absolute. */
14470 else if (have_location_lists || ranges_table_in_use)
14471 add_AT_addr (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_entry_pc, const0_rtx);
14472
14473 /* Output location list section if necessary. */
14474 if (have_location_lists)
14475 {
14476 /* Output the location lists info. */
14477 switch_to_section (debug_loc_section);
14478 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (loc_section_label,
14479 DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
14480 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, loc_section_label);
14481 output_location_lists (die);
14482 }
14483
14484 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_NORMAL)
14485 add_AT_lineptr (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_stmt_list,
14486 debug_line_section_label);
14487
14488 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
14489 add_AT_macptr (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_macro_info, macinfo_section_label);
14490
14491 /* Output all of the compilation units. We put the main one last so that
14492 the offsets are available to output_pubnames. */
14493 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
14494 output_comp_unit (node->die, 0);
14495
14496 output_comp_unit (comp_unit_die, 0);
14497
14498 /* Output the abbreviation table. */
14499 switch_to_section (debug_abbrev_section);
14500 output_abbrev_section ();
14501
14502 /* Output public names table if necessary. */
14503 if (!VEC_empty (pubname_entry, pubname_table))
14504 {
14505 switch_to_section (debug_pubnames_section);
14506 output_pubnames (pubname_table);
14507 }
14508
14509 #ifdef DEBUG_PUBTYPES_SECTION
14510 /* Output public types table if necessary. */
14511 if (!VEC_empty (pubname_entry, pubtype_table))
14512 {
14513 switch_to_section (debug_pubtypes_section);
14514 output_pubnames (pubtype_table);
14515 }
14516 #endif
14517
14518 /* Output the address range information. We only put functions in the arange
14519 table, so don't write it out if we don't have any. */
14520 if (fde_table_in_use)
14521 {
14522 switch_to_section (debug_aranges_section);
14523 output_aranges ();
14524 }
14525
14526 /* Output ranges section if necessary. */
14527 if (ranges_table_in_use)
14528 {
14529 switch_to_section (debug_ranges_section);
14530 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, ranges_section_label);
14531 output_ranges ();
14532 }
14533
14534 /* Output the source line correspondence table. We must do this
14535 even if there is no line information. Otherwise, on an empty
14536 translation unit, we will generate a present, but empty,
14537 .debug_info section. IRIX 6.5 `nm' will then complain when
14538 examining the file. This is done late so that any filenames
14539 used by the debug_info section are marked as 'used'. */
14540 if (! DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
14541 {
14542 switch_to_section (debug_line_section);
14543 output_line_info ();
14544 }
14545
14546 /* Have to end the macro section. */
14547 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
14548 {
14549 switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
14550 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End compilation unit");
14551 }
14552
14553 /* If we emitted any DW_FORM_strp form attribute, output the string
14554 table too. */
14555 if (debug_str_hash)
14556 htab_traverse (debug_str_hash, output_indirect_string, NULL);
14557 }
14558 #else
14559
14560 /* This should never be used, but its address is needed for comparisons. */
14561 const struct gcc_debug_hooks dwarf2_debug_hooks;
14562
14563 #endif /* DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO */
14564
14565 #include "gt-dwarf2out.h"
14566